Quarterlytics / Technology / Software - Application / MiX Telematics Limited

MiX Telematics Limited

mixt · NYSE Technology
Claim this profile
Ticker mixt
Exchange NYSE
Sector Technology
Industry Software - Application
Employees 1001-5000
← All annual reports
FY2022 Annual Report · MiX Telematics Limited
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
 ANNUAL
REPORT
ON FORM 10-K
www.mixtelematics.co.za


Financial results at a glance
Consolidated results
(in thousands, except percentages, per share data and number of subscribers)
Year Ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Number of subscribers
 
818,487 
 
744,677 
 
815,165 
Revenue
$ 
145,650 
$ 
126,894 
$ 
143,294 
Subscription revenue
 
127,570 
 
113,351 
 
123,573 
Hardware and other revenue
 
18,080 
 
13,543 
 
19,721 
Operating income
 
21,048 
 
18,198 
 
14,449 
Operating income margin
 14.5 %
 14.3 %
 10.1 %
Adjusted net income (1)
$ 
15,625 
$ 
11,897 
$ 
9,032 
Earnings per ordinary share
 Basic
 
0.02 
 
0.03 
 
0.02 
 Diluted
 
0.02 
 
0.03 
 
0.02 
Earnings per American Depository Share
 Basic
 
0.50 
 
0.66 
 
0.41 
 Diluted
 
0.48 
 
0.65 
 
0.40 
Adjusted net income per ordinary share - Diluted  (1)
 
0.03 
 
0.02 
 
0.02 
Adjusted net income per American Depository Share 
- Diluted (1)
 
0.69 
 
0.53 
 
0.40 
Adjusted EBITDA (1)
 
41,726 
 
37,168 
 
31,565 
Cash flow from operating activities
 
28,178 
 
38,572 
 
19,402 
Free cash flow (1)
 
7,806 
 
29,918 
 
(6,815) 
Cash and cash equivalents
$ 
17,953 
$ 
45,489 
$ 
33,738 
(1)  Adjusted net income, adjusted net income per diluted ordinary share, adjusted net income per diluted American Depository 
Share, adjusted EBITDA and free cash flow are non-GAAP measures.  Refer to “Forward looking statements and use of non-
GAAP measures - Use of non-GAAP measures in this Annual Report” for further information regarding these non-GAAP 
measures.
1

Segment information
(in thousands)
Year Ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Subscription revenue
Africa
$ 
70,886 
$ 
62,453 
$ 
74,778 
Europe
 
11,682 
 
12,138 
 
13,509 
Americas
 
22,322 
 
18,211 
 
14,036 
Middle East and Australasia
 
17,389 
 
16,558 
 
16,950 
Brazil
 
5,181 
 
3,922 
 
4,253 
Total Regional Sales Offices
 
127,460 
 
113,282 
 
123,526 
Central Services Organization
 
110 
 
69 
 
47 
Total Segment Results
$ 
127,570 
$ 
113,351 
$ 
123,573 
Hardware and other revenue
Africa
$ 
5,870 
$ 
5,495 
$ 
8,398 
Europe
 
3,345 
 
2,441 
 
3,745 
Americas
 
2,207 
 
770 
 
1,538 
Middle East and Australasia
 
5,741 
 
4,679 
 
5,604 
Brazil
 
614 
 
142 
 
401 
Total Regional Sales Offices
 
17,777 
 
13,527 
 
19,686 
Central Services Organization
 
303 
 
16 
 
35 
Total Segment Results
$ 
18,080 
$ 
13,543 
$ 
19,721 
Total revenue
Africa
$ 
76,756 
$ 
67,948 
$ 
83,176 
Europe
 
15,027 
 
14,579 
 
17,254 
Americas
 
24,529 
 
18,981 
 
15,574 
Middle East and Australasia
 
23,130 
 
21,237 
 
22,554 
Brazil
 
5,795 
 
4,064 
 
4,654 
Total Regional Sales Offices
 
145,237 
 
126,809 
 
143,212 
Central Services Organization
 
413 
 
85 
 
82 
Total Segment Results
$ 
145,650 
$ 
126,894 
$ 
143,294 
Segment Adjusted EBITDA
Africa
$ 
33,103 
$ 
31,781 
$ 
36,467 
Europe
 
5,603 
 
6,260 
 
6,337 
Americas
 
10,370 
 
7,077 
 
842 
Middle East and Australasia
 
11,031 
 
9,751 
 
10,034 
Brazil
 
2,366 
 
1,495 
 
1,260 
Total Regional Sales Offices
 
62,473 
 
56,364 
 
54,940 
Central Services Organization
 
(9,175) 
 
(7,553) 
 
(10,168) 
Total Segment Results
$ 
53,298 
$ 
48,811 
$ 
44,772 
2

The following table (shown in thousands) reconciles total Segment Adjusted EBITDA to income before income tax 
expense for the periods shown:
Year Ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Segment Adjusted EBITDA
$ 
53,298 
$ 
48,811 
$ 
44,772 
Corporate and consolidation entries
 
(8,366) 
 
(8,879) 
 
(10,243) 
Loss contingency (1)
 
(233) 
 
— 
 
— 
Operating lease costs (2)
 
(1,610) 
 
(1,652) 
 
(1,611) 
Product development costs (3)
 
(1,363) 
 
(1,112) 
 
(1,353) 
Depreciation and amortization
 
(19,972) 
 
(16,559) 
 
(14,951) 
Impairment of long-lived assets
 
(6) 
 
(8) 
 
(47) 
Stock-based compensation costs
 
(660) 
 
(1,273) 
 
(1,325) 
Restructuring costs (4)
 
1 
 
(1,055) 
 
(164) 
Net profit/(loss) on sale of property, plant and 
equipment
 
270 
 
(13) 
 
36 
Net foreign exchange losses
 
(610) 
 
(959) 
 
(648) 
Net interest income/(expense)
 
67 
 
(72) 
 
(510) 
Legal costs associated with patent infringement
 
— 
 
— 
 
(591) 
Income before income tax expense
$ 
20,816 
$ 
17,229 
$ 
13,365 
Description of reconciling items:
(1) For segment reporting purposes, a loss contingency (51% probability), had been raised prior to fiscal year 2019. As of March 
31, 2020, the loss contingency was no longer needed because an outflow was considered remote. In order to reconcile Segment 
Adjusted EBITDA to income before income tax expense, the increases/decreases to the loss contingency, recognized for 
segment reporting purposes, needed to be added/deducted.
(2) For the purposes of calculating Segment Adjusted EBITDA, operating leases have been capitalized, except for leases with a 
term of no more than 12 months or leases of low value assets. Where operating leases are capitalized for segment reporting 
purposes, the amortization of the right-of-use asset and the interest on the operating lease liability are excluded from the 
Segment Adjusted EBITDA. Therefore, in order to reconcile Segment Adjusted EBITDA to income before income tax expense, 
the total lease expense in respect of operating leases needs to be deducted.
(3) For segment reporting purposes, product development costs, which do not meet the capitalization requirements under ASC 
730 Research and Development or under ASC 985 Software, are capitalized and amortized. The amortization is excluded from 
Segment Adjusted EBITDA. In order to reconcile Segment Adjusted EBITDA to income before income tax expense, product 
development costs capitalized for segment reporting purposes need to be deducted.
(4) During fiscal year 2021, the Company incurred $1.1 million of restructuring costs which comprise of employee termination 
benefits, as a result of measures to minimize the adverse economic and business effect of the COVID-19 pandemic and to re-
align resources with the Company’s current business outlook and cost structure. $0.7 million, $0.2 million, $0.1 million and 
$0.1 million of the restructuring costs related to the CSO, Africa, North America and Middle East and Australasia reporting 
segments, respectively. As of March 31, 2022, all of the restructuring costs had been paid. Restructuring costs are included in 
Administration and other expenses in the consolidated statements of income.
3

Corporate Citizenship Report
MiX Telematics Limited and our subsidiaries’ (hereinafter referred to as “we”, “our”, “us”, “MiX”, or the “Company”) 
strategies, general conduct and responsibilities as a good corporate citizen are underpinned and guided by our Code of Ethics 
and Conduct and a set of core values. These values dictate that MiX delivers value to a wide group of stakeholders, including 
our employees, customers, business partners, shareholders, communities and broader society.
Sustainability initiatives form part of our global business strategy and MiX finds itself in the privileged position where 
many of the drivers of the commercial success of MiX also contribute to and support social, environmental and broader 
economic sustainability.
Through out this report we illustrate how many of the drivers of MiX’s commercial success support the environmental, 
health and safety, and employee wellness objectives of our worldwide customer base. Refer to our Code of Ethics and Conduct 
and other relevant policies at www.mixtelematics.com.
Key statistics
2020
2021
2022
Economic
Number of people employed
 
1,103 
 
1,031 
 
1,083 
Total salaries, wages and other
R631m
R604m
R669m
Value of vehicles recovered
R957m
R847m
R1,323m
Social
Training spend
R12.1m
R9.9m
R13.2m
Enterprise development spend*
R4.9m
R3.8m
R3.9m
Supplier development spend#
R4.3m
R4.5m
R4.7m
Socio-economic development spend
R2.7m
R2.6m
R2.7m
* Enterprise development: means monetary and non-monetary contributions carried out for the benefit of beneficiaries with the 
objective of contributing to the development, sustainability and financial and operational independence of those beneficiaries 
which are exempt micro-enterprises or qualifying small enterprises which are at least 51% black-owned or 51% black women-
owned.
# Supplier development: means monetary and non-monetary contributions carried out for the benefit of suppliers to a company 
with the objective of contributing to the development, sustainability and financial and operational independence of those 
beneficiaries that are exempt micro-enterprises or qualifying small enterprises which are at least 51% black-owned or 51% 
black women-owned.
Economic
As at March 31, 2022, MiX provided direct employment to 1,083 employees across eleven countries around the world, 
a 5.0% increase since fiscal year 2021. 
Asset tracking
MiX Telematics Africa, which provides asset tracking and stolen or hijacked vehicle recovery services for the 
Company, increased direct savings to the South African economy by returning vehicles with an asset value of R1,323 million to 
their rightful owners during the period under review. This represented a 56.2% increase from the previous fiscal year (R847 
million). This increase can directly be attributed to the increase of number of reported incidents.
4

The indirect costs resulting from the theft or hijacking of a vehicle are significant, these include the cost of replacing a 
vehicle, the loss of productivity and, in the case of a commercial fleet, the lost revenue from not having these vehicles available 
- in some instances for an extended period of time.
MiX’s new-generation asset tracking technology, continued cooperation with the South African Police Service and 
smarter crime intelligence, coupled with analytics of incident patterns has contributed significantly to the division’s continued 
success during the reporting period. This success has positive effects on the South African economy and also contributes to our 
customers’ personal safety
Fleet operation
MiX’s comprehensive range of Fleet Management products and services provides actionable intelligence suitable for 
the management of commercially utilized vehicles in both small and large fleets and across numerous industries.
Information regarding driving hours, driver identity, fuel usage, distance traveled, locations visited, routes taken, trip 
duration and driving performance is delivered to our customers in a format and manner that enables them to improve the return 
on their investment by actively managing and improving driver behavior and safety, fuel efficiency, operating and maintenance 
costs and carbon emissions.
Environmental, health and safety
Environment
All entities within MiX have to comply with the Group Environmental Policy, which requires compliance with all 
relevant statutory and regulatory environmental provisions and established standards of good practice in the country in which 
that entity operates.
In recent years, MiX has demonstrated a commitment to improved environmental management for both the Company 
and our customers alike.
The true measure of our commitment and contribution to environmental sustainability is illustrated by the value which 
fleet customers and their drivers derive from utilizing MiX technology and actionable intelligence to improve fuel efficiency 
and fleet utilization, which in turn has a direct and positive impact on their carbon emissions and leads to a healthier and cleaner 
environment. Some examples include a customer who reduced its carbon emissions by approximately 600 tons in the first year 
of MiX’s solution deployment within its fleet, while another customer who provides waste removal and management services to 
municipalities, reduced its carbon emissions by 400 tons per annum, a number that is expected to grow as its MiX partnership 
continues.
Health and safety
All entities within MiX comply with the Group Health and Safety Policy, which requires entities to comply with all 
relevant statutory and regulatory provisions and established standards of good practice in the country in which they operate. 
Each regional operation must also have an approved health and safety program that supports this policy.
In addition, MiX understands the vital role that our solutions can play in improving road and driver safety all over 
the world. Some of the regional operations have therefore decided to support road safety initiatives in their specific 
geographical regions.
In the Middle East, MiX teams up with RoadSafetyUAE, and has done since 2015. This initiative serves as a 
communication, improvement and educational platform for all traffic participants and safety professionals in the UAE. Overall, 
it aims at creating a positive driving culture in the UAE. Among other activities, MiX has worked with RoadSafetyUAE to host 
a number of webinars and meetings and MiX also shares regular road safety content with their members through their online 
newsletter.
5

In Australasia, MiX continues to partner with Brake, a not-for-profit charity that promotes road risk management 
and helps organizations manage their transport requirements in ways that are safe, sustainable, healthy, and fair. In addition, 
MiX provides support to Safer Australian Roads And Highways, and their National Road Safety Week initiative, working in 
collaboration with government and NGOs to aid in the communication of the initiative into the private sector. The annual event 
includes the option for all road users to make a pledge to safer driving.
In Europe, MiX has also been a Brake partner for many years. MiX supports their events and works with Brake to 
develop resources aimed at improving safety across fleets.  MiX has been awarded the “Fleet Safety Partnership” award (1st 
and 2nd place), with two separate customers.
In North America, MiX has partnered with Texas A&M Transportation Institute (TTI) to help improve highway 
safety in the Permian Basin. By sharing anonymous data for events such as harsh braking and acceleration on Permian Basin 
roadways, MiX hopes to help reduce traffic incidents and save lives.
MiX in South Africa has been supporting the Brake & Tyre Watch road safety initiative by Fleetwatch for numerous 
years. This program is designed to raise transport operators’ awareness around the subject of efficient braking and tyre 
checking, which is linked to preventative maintenance on trucks, including all safety critical items such as lighting, reflectives, 
etc. The project, which is run four times a year, is also intended to empower traffic officials with specialized knowledge, 
enabling them to perform better in their profession and intervene more frequently in taking un-roadworthy heavy vehicles off 
South Africa’s roads.
Consumer Relationships
Data privacy and protection
Due to the nature of MiX’s business, we have to comply with new or existing domestic and international laws and 
regulations relating to issues such as user privacy and data protection, marketing, advertising, inadvertent disclosure and 
consumer protection. MiX continuously updates and will continue to evaluate our Group data protection and security policies, 
charters, and procedures to assist in maintaining data privacy and data security in line with international practices.
The Protection of Personal Information Act, No. 4 of 2013 (the “POPI Act”) was promulgated into law in South 
Africa in November 2013 and came into full effect on July 1, 2021. Any failure to comply with the POPI Act may result in a 
fine not exceeding R10 million and/or imprisonment of up to 10 years, depending on the severity of such failure.
Social
Human capital
Our employees are one of our most important stakeholder groups as they are the interface with our customers, 
suppliers, business partners and other stakeholders and, as such, have a significant influence on the performance and reputation 
of MiX. As at March 31, 2022, we employed 1,083 people in our various offices around the world. At MiX, we take care to 
recruit people who share our values. Our focus after recruitment is to continuously develop, train and retain quality people and 
encourage our employees to utilize opportunities for training and development in line with their personal development plan. 
Regular employee reviews ensure that employees and leaders in our business remain aligned to our values and promote these 
while they execute MiX’s strategy. At MiX we give preference to promoting from within the Company, before recruiting 
externally. We therefore focus on the identification, development and retention of employees with potential.
During the reporting period, neither MiX Enterprise, MiX Africa nor MiX International made any payments, nor have 
they been instructed to make any payments by the South African Commission for Conciliation, Mediation and Arbitration.
6

Labor practices
All companies within MiX comply with the local labor legislation, employment and taxation laws related to 
employment in the countries in which the employees are employed.
MiX’s employment policies and processes focus on the promotion of diversity in the workplace across the Group. 
MiX promotes equal opportunities and fair treatment.
We have recently implemented a global automated Digital Recruitment and Applicant Tracking System. The new 
Careers tab on our www.mixtelematics.com website encourages candidate registration across the globe and creates visibility for 
opportunities within all operating entities of MiX.
We have formal grievance mechanisms in place for employees in all the operating entities. The use of the Whistleblowing 
Hotline is also encouraged with our employees and other stakeholders.
Employee wellness
Employee health, wellness and morale are important to MiX. Each business in the Company manages its own 
initiatives to suit its demographics and align with the realities of the region they operate within and these initiatives continue 
throughout the year.
MiX recognizes that a happy and healthy workforce is more productive and efficient as they deal with the increasing 
demands for innovation, high performance and superior customer service. Furthermore, given the external environmental 
influences of today, our employees need even greater care, health and wellness support from us, especially given the 
unprecedented impact the COVID-19 pandemic has had globally. The Midrand office in South Africa, comprising the single 
largest number of employees, subscribes to the Life Health Solutions Wellness Program (Life EWP). The Life EWP service is a 
wellness program that assists employees, their immediate family members and dependents, with access to psycho social 
counselling and financial, legal, and health and well-being advice.
Communication across the MiX Group has increased with the access to virtual meetings and global interactions have 
grown. These interactions include regular regional monthly group sessions and team building across the entities. MiX has 
worked tirelessly to create awareness around both physical and mental health during the COVID-19 pandemic, with access to 
professional support as and when required.
The MiX offices in South Africa continue to host various wellness days and initiatives, which included health- 
screening checks, eye testing, flu injections and blood donations. Similar initiatives will continue in the new fiscal year.
The MiX offices have also informed and educated employees on COVID-19 as it continues to spread around the 
world. All regional operations continue to comply with in country COVID-19 health and safety regulations, rules and 
guidelines. Mix employees have completed the compulsory COVID-19 online training through our MiX Learning Centre 
platform. Employees in the MiX offices in South Africa were re-issued with hand sanitizers, facial masks, hand gloves and the 
entire office environment continues to be kept clean, disinfected and sanitized in line with the global occupational health and 
safety guidelines and standards. Where possible, MiX continues to implement t a policy that supports flexible working hours 
and remote working arrangements. This policy has applied to offices and global functions, including those in the Middle East, 
United Kingdom, Brazil and North America, where there has been a high number of infections and employees are sufficiently 
enabled to work productively from home. This Policy is to be reviewed by the Company and/or Line Manager every three 
months. 
MiX Europe is proud to have made a commitment to Disability Confident. The organization works with employers to 
ensure that disabled people and those with long-term health conditions have the opportunities and resources which they need to 
fulfill their potential. Disability Confident offers advice to companies committed to more inclusive employment.
Training and development
MiX believes that employees need a supportive environment that enables and fosters continuous growth and 
development. We therefore strive to ensure that employees have holistic views, and that they know and understand how they 
7

contribute to the purpose and objectives of the Company. MiX aims to empower employees, through tools and skills, to grow 
and better their contributions to the Company and society at large.
As a means of developing our employees further, MiX has invested in formal skills and competency development 
initiatives by focusing on providing technical, leadership and interactive courses throughout the year. MiX furthermore assists 
with the realization of the objectives specified in the National Development Plan for Skills Development through a number of 
additional initiatives. 
During fiscal year 2022, our employees were able to participate in various upskilling opportunities, which included 
Skills Education Training Authority (SETA) accredited short courses, various types of learnerships, and e-learning modules.
A total of 273 MiX employees were enrolled in various skills development activities. This is an increase from last year  
due to fact that more employees could be trained even with the current COVID-19 pandemic and the associated challenges it 
presented. MiX Africa and MiX Enterprise’s spend has also shifted in line with the requirement that 2.5% of the total salary or 
wages and related costs of a company be invested in Higher Education bursary expenditure for Black people. As this 2.5% 
requirement is only applicable to the MiX Africa and MiX Enterprise businesses, they collectively invested an amount of just 
over R6.2 million at the University of Pretoria, Stellenbosch University and North-West University. Although MiX 
International does not have to adhere to the 2.5% requirement, the above-mentioned invested amount includes bursaries which 
MiX International awarded to Stellenbosch University as part of the Skills Development spend. Furthermore, 52 of our 
employees aspiring to further their qualifications, received study assistance from the Company.
MiX welcomed the sixth group of unemployed learners in the fiscal year under review, following a very successful 
intake of learners in the previous fiscal year. We offered various learnerships including: business administration, generic 
management, bookkeeping, autotronics, project management, contact centre and sales and marketing. We offered information 
technology related qualifications as well, including: end user and system development. MiX also focused on leadership 
development in alignment to the transformation objectives. A total cohort of 6 senior managers enrolled for an Executive 
Development and Coaching Program to enhance their leadership qualities and improve team effectiveness within the business 
operations. 
MiX spent R13.2 million on the training of employees and unemployed learners during the fiscal year under review, 
compared to the R9.9 million spent during the previous fiscal year.
The online MiX Learning Centre (“MLC”) platform remained an important pillar in offering our skills development 
and compulsory online compliance training execution. The MLC platform allows for ongoing facilitation and training of 
learners and ensures that uniform training and work standards can be maintained across the Company. It also allows the 
facilitator and/or assessor to update the material and to request the completion of refresher courses and compliance related 
matters.
In line with the Skills Development requirements, MiX continues to invest in the development of black people and in 
particular, MiX black employees. MiX aims to empower black employees to aide their growth and promotional prospects 
within the Company to reflect the diversity of the is competent workforce at all management levels. This fiscal year, the two 
skills development initiatives that were of particular relevance were, Project Management, Marketing and Generic Management 
Broad-Based Black Economic Empowerment (“B-BBEE”)
Given the economic turmoil and devastating impact of the COVID-19 on the lives and livelihood of so many of South 
Africa’s citizens, Broad-Based Black Economic Empowerment more than ever before is seen as an important lever and 
mechanism to ensure the transformation of the economy and empowerment of not only our employees but as many citizens as 
possible. We embrace our role as a responsible and active corporate citizen and have during the past fiscal year under review, 
implemented many innovative projects to ensure we don’t only fulfill the mandate but exceed the expectations of our various 
stakeholders and make a fundamental and lasting impact, moreover in regard to the creation of new business ventures, job 
creation and skills transfer. 
Following the sale  of the Stellenbosch and Midrand properties to the Black Industrialist Group Property Management 
Company Proprietary Limited (“BIG”) MiX Enterprise can now not only recognize this transaction under the ownership pillar 
as per the B-BBEE Revised Codes of Good Practice, but the black ownership has been locked in at 34.8%.  
8

Our B-BBEE annual compliance certificate is available on our website at www.mixtelematics.com. In accordance with 
the Amended B-BBEE Codes of Good Practice, issued in terms of section 9(1) of the Broad-Based Black Economic 
Empowerment Amendment Act No. 46 of 2013, the South African primary trading entities currently rate as follows which is a 
big improvement in comparison to the previous year:
MiX Telematics Enterprise SA Proprietary Limited
Valid until 11 May 2023
Level 1
MiX Telematics Africa Proprietary Limited
Valid until 13 June 2022
Level 5
MiX Telematics International Proprietary Limited
Valid until 22 June 2022
Level 6
MiX Telematics Enterprise BEE Trust (Enterprise Trust) (the “Trust”)
The Trust holds a 14.9% stake in MiX Enterprise. The Trust has accumulated R26.1 million in dividends since it was 
established.
Enterprise and supplier development
 MiX firmly believes that small and medium enterprises play a key role in South Africa’s economy. The worldwide 
economic realities of the past two years have however stifled their income generation opportunities and contribution to job 
creation. In order to address these challenges and make a significant contribution to address the unemployment especially 
amongst the youth MiX launched the Ithuba Excelerator Program. The MiX Ithuba Excelerator Program represents a number of 
key concepts and words, including excellence, exceptional, exceeder, accelerator, incubator, generator, administrator, 
invigorator, collaborator, liberator and integrator, hence the blended word ‘Excelerator’ in the name of the program. 
The program presented opportunities for young black entrepreneurs with a technical qualification to set up their own business 
in the vehicle tracking industry. Aspiring entrepreneurs could apply online and having made the first round of selection went 
through a second set of assessments and checks whereafter they were enrolled upon fulfilling the requirements. A 
comprehensive and holistic approach has been followed in their development, which consists of theoretical training on MiX 
products coupled with practical exposure and assessments in the field. They were also provided with support and mentoring in 
registering their businesses, complying with governance matters and ensuring basic requirements are in place to run an effective 
business. MiX strongly beliefs that in order to ensure sustainability, a support structure and firm processes needed to be put in 
place. The participants were therefore provided with the services of a life and business coach and a community of practice has 
been established where the participants meet weekly to share their learning experiences, exchange ideas and solutions and 
address elements around aspects such as operational and financial management. The feedback of the participants has been very 
positive and MiX is planning to run similar programs in the future. 
In the fiscal year under review, MiX made a significant contribution, evidenced by our employees’ time and effort 
and the financial resources that were dedicated to the equipping, training, upskilling, coaching and mentoring of not only the 
Ithuba Program participants but a number of other small black current and future business suppliers.
The majority of these suppliers were 51% black-owned, exempt micro-enterprises (with an annual turnover of less 
than R10 million) and many had significant black female ownership and, in some instances, even a component of ownership by 
black youth and black rural based presence. Part of MiX’s onboarding exercise is taking hands with these beneficiaries to 
ensure their adherence to good corporate governance supplemented by stringent due diligence process, and followed by a 
detailed needs analysis, the drafting of development plans, and the entering into of formal agreements with the beneficiaries. 
MiX contributed R8.6 million in total to enterprise development and supplier development in the form of monetary 
contributions during fiscal year 2022. We provided non-monetary assistance through formal and informal training, visits to and 
meetings with the beneficiaries in order to provide guidance on various business challenges.
Socio-economic development spend
In this section we report only on the South African initiatives, as this is where we focus our socio-economic 
development resources and efforts. During the fiscal year under review, we invested approximately R2.7 million into various 
community-based organizations. MiX believes in establishing and nurturing long-term partnerships with these organizations in 
order to ensure a lasting and sustainable impact in the communities where these organizations operate. In addition, MiX also 
collaborated with a few fleet customers, in order to collectively pool resources for a more meaningful impact and contribution 
toward the targeted beneficiaries.
MiX targets issues relating to women and children. Matters associated with education, literacy, food security, the 
disabled and critically ill, fatherlessness and gender-based violence were amongst the issues of great importance to us.
9

Some of the biggest beneficiaries we are proud to be associated with are:
•
iSchoolAfrica - It is a comprehensive, secure, proven and cost-effective solution for creating Fourth Industrial 
Revolution-ready learners. iSchoolAfrica has been addressing the challenges facing schools in South Africa since 
2009. Through the iSchoolAfrica iPad program, students from rural and township areas are exposed to technology that 
will assist them in becoming digitally literate, acquire 21st-century skills, increase motivation, enthusiasm and 
excitement around learning, and level the playing fields between resourced and under-resourced schools. The donation 
made to iSchoolAfrica was earmarked for the Apple Distinguished Schools Program and more specifically, towards 
establishing the program in a special needs school, which is  a world first.
•
SAME Foundation - The S.A Medical & Education Foundation is a South African NPO-PBO that undertakes high 
impact, community development projects. The Foundation boasts a record of accomplishment of completing well over 
60 projects in the last 18 years, positively influencing millions of South Africans. Their sole aim is to improve 
healthcare and educational facilities in poverty-stricken communities. They supply their schools, hospitals & clinics 
with the equipment and infrastructure they desperately need to service the larger communities using the facilities. They 
also facilitate teacher and doctor training to improve skills. They are committed to helping these communities and 
firmly believe that wealth should not be a prerequisite for access to quality education and healthcare.
•
Social Upliftment Services (“SUS”) - SUS was established in 2009. The Company’s main objective is to “raise funds 
and utilise the funds to uplift and enhance socially disadvantaged people through social development and poverty 
relief”. MiX contributed to a number of their projects also those aimed at disaster relief and assistance.
•
Missio Dei Education was formed in 2018. Their vision is to assist as many schools as possible with their learners in 
Grade 3, help children to have a strong foundation in Mathematics and English before they progress to Grade 4, give 
individual attention to learners and help them holistically and provide opportunities for members of the community to 
develop skills, dignity and self-worth.
•
Berea Hillbrow Home of Hope - Home of Hope for Girls is an NGO that was established 21 years ago by Mam 
Khanyisile Motsa in response to the crisis of child trafficking that was witnessed in Berea and Hillbrow in 
Johannesburg. Home of Hope provides a safe residence for children and teens facing abusive situations predominantly 
linked to child sex trafficking and by offering care, compassion and acceptance, and facilitates their re-integration back 
into society. They have to facilities in suburban Johannesburg where the girls live and are supported by their 
caregivers. In addition, they offer a comprehensive rehabilitation programme that incorporates the principles of 
restoring human dignity.
Other projects that we assisted with include, but are not limited to: a Click Foundation, Clover Mama Afrika; 
Ithemba Projects, Matla a Bana, Growing up without a father; Headstart Kids; Kids Haven; Little Eden; Rise Against Hunger; 
Girls and Boys Town; SOS Children’s Villages; Community Development Initiatives International; Remme Los; MD 
Foundation Missio and Symphonia for South Africa.
Anti-Corruption and Bribery
MiX is committed to conducting its business with honesty and integrity and in compliance with the laws and 
regulations of all the countries in which the Company is active. MiX’s Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy, the Code of Ethics
and Conduct, and the Whistleblowing Policy support and clarify our commitment to facilitating the observance of all relevant 
anti-bribery and anti-corruption laws and regulations including, but not limited to, the South African Prevention and Combating 
of Corrupt Activities Act 2004 (as amended), UK Bribery Act 2010 (as amended), the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act 1977 (as 
amended), the United Nations Global Compact Business Principles and the Organization for Economic Co-operation and 
Development Recommendations regarding Corruption.
Our standards of conduct for the prevention of corruption are well communicated to our employees, business 
partners and other stakeholders, and procedures have been implemented to manage our corruption risk. It is compulsory for all 
employees, prescribed officers and directors to complete the anti-bribery and corruption, and ethical conduct training courses on 
an annual basis. On an ad hoc basis, as part of our risk-based assurance process, all employees, prescribed officers and directors 
are requested to complete an anonymous online fraud and ethics perception survey, managed by an independent external 
organization. Results from this survey are used to assess the effectiveness of training on the various topics and also to ascertain 
any specific risk areas in the business. Future training and internal controls are then adapted to deal with areas of concern.
MiX does, in certain instances, supply into geographic areas which, according to the Corruption Perceptions Index, 
are at higher risk for corrupt activities. This includes supply into certain African, Middle Eastern and South American countries. 
This risk is further increased by the fact that MiX makes extensive use of third-party distributors/dealers (business partners) to 
distribute to and service customers in various countries. MiX works to mitigate this increased risk through requiring third-party 
distributors/dealers (business partners) of our products and services to formally agree to abide by the Value Added Reseller 
(“VAR”) Code of Conduct, which is an adapted version of the MiX Code of Ethics and Conduct. As part of the Anti-Bribery 
10

and Corruption Program, these business partners complete the VAR compliance due diligence document as part of their initial 
partner application process, which serves to monitor their adherence to the 10 principles set out in the United Nations Global 
Compact Principles as well as the OECD Recommendations regarding Corruption. Another element of MiX’s business partner 
due diligence comprises screening. Screening is done against a comprehensive intelligence database consisting of sanction lists, 
watch lists, government records and media searches. The result of the compliance questionnaire together with the output from 
the screening activities are used to assess risk and the need for further training or other intervention. MiX requires the business 
partners to re-sign the VAR Code of Conduct every two years. Failure by business partners to comply with the VAR Code of 
Conduct can lead to termination of the business relationship.
To further mitigate our risks, MiX plans to expand the requirement where third-party distributors/dealers have to 
comply with the VAR Code of Conduct to all its business partners, including suppliers, service providers, sub-contractors and 
the like, in the near future. The VAR compliance due diligence document will then have to be completed by all new business 
partners (as per the expanded list mentioned above) going forward.
Measures taken to monitor corporate citizenship and how the outcomes were addressed are discussed in the Social 
and Ethics Committee Report, contained in our Proxy Statement, under “monitoring approach”.
Report Assurance
We have not obtained independent third party assurance of this Corporate Citizenship report for the fiscal year 2022 
reporting period.
11

Forward-Looking Statements and Use Of Non-GAAP Financial Measures
Forward-looking statements
This Annual Report on Form 10-K includes certain “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the 
Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995, including without limitation, statements regarding our position to 
execute on our growth strategy, and our ability to expand our leadership position. These forward-looking statements 
include, but are not limited to, the Company’s beliefs, plans, goals, objectives, expectations, assumptions, estimates, 
intentions, future performance, other statements that are not historical facts and statements identified by words such as 
“expects”, “anticipates”, “intends”, “plans”, “believes”, “seeks”, “estimates” or words of similar meaning. These forward-
looking statements reflect our current views about our plans, intentions, expectations, strategies and prospects, which are 
based on the information currently available to us and on assumptions we have made. Although we believe that our plans, 
intentions, expectations, strategies and prospects as reflected in, or suggested by, these forward-looking statements are 
reasonable, we can give no assurance that the plans, intentions, expectations or strategies will be attained or achieved.
Furthermore, actual results may differ materially from those described in the forward-looking statements and will 
be affected by a variety of known and unknown risks and uncertainties, some of which are beyond our control. We believe 
that these risks and uncertainties include, but are not limited to, those described in Part I, Item 1A. “Risk Factors”.  These 
risk factors should not be considered as an exhaustive list and should be read in conjunction with the other cautionary 
statements and information in this report.
We assume no obligation to update any forward-looking statements contained in this Annual Report and 
expressly disclaim any obligation to do so, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise, except as 
required by law.
Non-GAAP financial measures
Use of non-GAAP financial measures in this Annual Report
U.S. securities laws require that when we publish any non-GAAP measures, we disclose the reason for using the 
non-GAAP measure and provide a reconciliation to the directly comparable GAAP measure. The presentation of adjusted 
net income, adjusted net income per share, adjusted EBITDA. adjusted EBITDA margin and free cash flow are non-
GAAP measures.
Why we use non-GAAP measures
Management believes that the adjusted net income, adjusted net income per share diluted metric, adjusted 
EBITDA and the free cash flow enhances its own evaluation, as well as an investor’s understanding, of our financial 
performance.
Adjusted EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA margin
To provide investors with additional information regarding its financial results, the Company has disclosed 
within this Annual Report, adjusted EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA margin. Adjusted EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA 
margin are non-GAAP financial measures, and they do not represent cash flows from operations for the periods indicated, 
and should not be considered an alternative to net income as an indicator of the Company’s results of operations, or as an 
alternative to cash flows from operations as an indicator of liquidity. Adjusted EBITDA is defined as the income before 
income taxes, net interest income/expense, net foreign exchange gains/losses, depreciation of property, plant and 
equipment including capitalized customer in-vehicle devices, amortization of intangible assets including capitalized 
internal-use software development costs and intangible assets identified as part of a business combination, stock-based 
compensation costs, restructuring costs, legal costs associated with patent infringement and profits/losses on the disposal 
or impairments of assets or subsidiaries. The adjusted EBITDA definition has been updated also to exclude legal costs 
relating to a patent infringement matter that arose during fiscal year 2022. We define adjusted EBITDA margin as 
adjusted EBITDA divided by total revenue.
We have included adjusted EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA margin in this Annual Report because they are key 
measures that the Company’s management and Board of Directors use to understand and evaluate its core operating 
performance and trends; to prepare and approve its annual budget; and to develop short and long-term operational plans. 
12

In particular, the exclusion of certain expenses in calculating adjusted EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA margin can provide 
a useful measure for period-to-period comparisons of the Company’s core business. Accordingly, the Company believes 
that adjusted EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA margin provide useful information to investors and others in understanding 
and evaluating its operating results.
Our use of adjusted EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA margin have limitations as an analytical tool, and you 
should not consider this performance measure in isolation from or as a substitute for analysis of our results as reported 
under GAAP.
Some of these limitations are:
•
although depreciation and amortization are non-cash charges, the assets being depreciated and amortized may 
have to be replaced in the future, and adjusted EBITDA does not reflect cash capital expenditure requirements 
for such replacements or for new capital expenditure requirements;
•
Adjusted EBITDA does not reflect changes in, or cash requirements for, our working capital needs;
•
Adjusted EBITDA does not consider the potentially dilutive impact of equity-based compensation;
•
Adjusted EBITDA does not reflect tax payments that may represent a reduction in cash available to the 
Company; 
•
other companies, including companies in our industry, may calculate adjusted EBITDA differently, which 
reduces its usefulness as a comparative measure; and
•
certain of the adjustments (such as restructuring costs, impairment of long-lived assets and others) made in 
calculating adjusted EBITDA are those that management believes are not representative of our underlying 
operations and, therefore, are subjective in nature.
Because of these limitations, you should consider adjusted EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA margin alongside 
other financial performance measures, including income from operations, net income and our other results.
Adjusted net income per share
Adjusted net income per share is defined as net income, excluding net foreign exchange gains/losses net of tax, 
divided by the weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue during the period.
We have included adjusted net income per share in this Annual Report release because it provides a useful 
measure for period-to-period comparisons of our core business by excluding net foreign exchange gains/losses net of tax 
and associated tax consequences from earnings. Accordingly, we believe that adjusted net income per share provides 
useful information to investors and others in understanding and evaluating our operating results.
Free cash flow
Free cash flow is determined as net cash provided by operating activities less capital expenditure for investing 
activities. We believe that free cash flow provides useful information to investors and others in understanding and 
evaluating the Company’s cash flows as it provides detail of the amount of cash the Company generates or utilizes after 
accounting for all capital expenditures including investments in in-vehicle devices.
13

Reconciliation of GAAP net income to adjusted EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA margin
The table below (in thousands) presents the reconciliation between GAAP net income to adjusted EBITDA and 
adjusted EBITDA margin for our last three fiscal years:
Year Ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Net income
$ 
10,987 
$ 
14,595 
$ 
8,947 
Plus: Income tax expense
 
9,829 
 
2,634 
 
4,418 
(Less)/plus: Net interest (income)/expense
 
(67) 
 
72 
 
510 
Plus: Foreign exchange losses
 
610 
 
959 
 
648 
Plus: Depreciation (1)
 
16,149 
 
12,878 
 
10,693 
Plus: Amortization (2)
 
3,823 
 
3,681 
 
4,258 
Plus: Impairment of long-lived assets
 
6 
 
8 
 
47 
Plus: Stock-based compensation costs
 
660 
 
1,273 
 
1,325 
(Less)/plus: Net (profit)/loss on sale of property, 
plant and equipment
 
(270) 
 
13 
 
(36) 
(Less)/plus: Restructuring costs
 
(1) 
 
1,055 
 
164 
Plus: Legal costs associated with patent 
infringement
 
— 
 
— 
 
591 
Adjusted EBITDA
$ 
41,726 
$ 
37,168 
$ 
31,565 
Adjusted EBITDA margin
 28.6 %
 29.3 %
 22.0 %
(1) Includes depreciation of owned property and equipment (including in-vehicle devices).
(2) Includes amortization of intangible assets (including intangible assets identified as part of a business combination).
Reconciliation of GAAP net income to adjusted net income and adjusted net income per share
The following tables (in thousands, except per share data) reconcile net income to adjusted net income and 
diluted net income per ordinary share or ADS to adjusted net income per ordinary share or ADS for the periods shown:
Year Ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Net income
$ 
10,987 
$ 
14,595 
$ 
8,947 
Net foreign exchange losses
 
610 
959
 
648 
Income tax effect of net foreign exchange losses
 
4,028 
 
(3,657) 
 
(563) 
Adjusted net income
$ 
15,625 
$ 
11,897 
$ 
9,032 
Net income per ordinary share - diluted
$ 
0.019 
$ 
0.026 
$ 
0.016 
Effect of net foreign exchange losses to net 
income
0.001
0.002
 
0.001 
Income tax effect of net foreign exchange losses
0.007
 
(0.007) 
 
(0.001) 
Adjusted net income per ordinary share - 
diluted
$ 
0.027 
$ 
0.021 
$ 
0.016 
Net income per ADS - diluted
$ 
0.48 
$ 
0.65 
$ 
0.40 
Effect of net foreign exchange losses to net 
income
 
0.03 
 
0.04 
 
0.03 
Income tax effect of net foreign exchange losses
 
0.18 
 
(0.16) 
 
(0.03) 
Adjusted net income per ADS - diluted
$ 
0.69 
$ 
0.53 
$ 
0.40 
14

Reconciliation of cash provided by operating activities to free cash flow
The following table (in thousands) reconciles net cash provided by operating activities to free cash flow for the 
periods shown:
Year Ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Net cash provided by operating activities
$ 
28,178 
$ 
38,572 
$ 
19,402 
Less: Capital expenditure payments
 
(20,372) 
 
(8,654) 
 
(26,217) 
Free cash flow
$ 
7,806 
$ 
29,918 
$ 
(6,815) 
15

UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
—————————
FORM 10-K
—————————
☒ ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended March 31, 2022
OR
☐ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from     to 
Commission file number: 001-36027
MIX TELEMATICS LIMITED
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)
 REPUBLIC OF SOUTH AFRICA                                                                                   
 
NOT APPLICABLE
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)                                                          
 
 
              (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
750 Park of Commerce Blvd
Suite 100, Boca Raton, Florida 33487
(Address of principal executive offices)
1-877-585-1088
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)
                                          
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of each class
Trading Symbol(s)
Name of each exchange on which registered
American Depositary Shares (“ADSs”), each 
representing 25 
ordinary shares, no par value
MIXT
New York Stock Exchange
Ordinary Shares, no par value
New York Stock Exchange (for listing purposes only)
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act.
None
(Title of Class)
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. 
 
 
 ☐Yes xNo
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Act. 
 
 
                                          ☐Yes xNo 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 
months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. 
 xYes ☐No  
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and  pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 
of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files).   
 
 
 xYes ☐No
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company, or an emerging growth company. 
See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
Large accelerated filer o
Accelerated filer ☒
Non-accelerated filer ☐
Smaller reporting company ☒
Emerging growth company ☐
If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial 
accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. o
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting 
under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that prepared or issued its audit report. 
 
  ☒
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).  
 
 
 
   ☐Yes xNo
The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates of the registrant on September 30, 2021, the last business day of the registrant’s most 
recent completed second fiscal quarter, was approximately $208,352,646.  
As of May 27, 2022, 551,359,733 of the registrant’s ordinary shares were outstanding, including 375,198,700 ordinary shares represented by American Depository Shares.
DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
Portions of the registrant’s Proxy Statement for the 2022 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders are incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K.

TABLE OF CONTENTS 
 
Page
Part I 
Item 1. Business
2
Item 1A. Risk Factors
19
Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments
48
Item 2. Properties
49
Item 3. Legal Proceedings
49
Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures
50
Part II 
Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of 
Equity Securities
50
Item 6. Reserved
55
Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
56
Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risks
78
Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
93
Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
80
Item 9A. Controls and Procedures
81
Item 9B. Other Information
84
Item 9C. Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent Inspections
84
Part III 
Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
85
Item 11. Executive Compensation
85
Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder 
Matters
86
Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
86
Item 14. Principal Accountant Fees and Services
86
Part IV
Item 15. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules
87
Item 16. Form 10-K Summary
91
SIGNATURES
91
 

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
This Annual Report on Form 10-K includes certain “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the 
Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995, including without limitation, statements regarding our position to 
execute on our growth strategy, and our ability to expand our leadership position. These forward-looking statements 
include, but are not limited to, the Company’s beliefs, plans, goals, objectives, expectations, assumptions, estimates, 
intentions, future performance, other statements that are not historical facts and statements identified by words such as 
“expects”, “anticipates”, “intends”, “plans”, “believes”, “seeks”, “estimates” or words of similar meaning. These forward-
looking statements reflect our current views about our plans, intentions, expectations, strategies and prospects, which are 
based on the information currently available to us and on assumptions we have made. Although we believe that our plans, 
intentions, expectations, strategies and prospects as reflected in, or suggested by, these forward-looking statements are 
reasonable, we can give no assurance that the plans, intentions, expectations or strategies will be attained or achieved.
Furthermore, actual results may differ materially from those described in the forward-looking statements and will 
be affected by a variety of known and unknown risks and uncertainties, some of which are beyond our control. We believe 
that these risks and uncertainties include, but are not limited to, those described in Part I, Item 1A. “Risk Factors”. These 
risk factors should not be considered as an exhaustive list and should be read in conjunction with the other cautionary 
statements and information in this report. 
We assume no obligation to update any forward-looking statements contained in this Annual Report and 
expressly disclaim any obligation to do so, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise, except as 
required by law.
PRESENTATION OF FINANCIAL AND OTHER INFORMATION 
The consolidated financial statements contained in this Annual Report on Form 10-K have been prepared in 
accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“GAAP”). 
Unless the context requires otherwise, the terms “MiX”, the “Company”, “we”, “our” or “us” refer to MiX 
Telematics Limited and its consolidated subsidiaries.
Our fiscal year ends on March 31 and all references to a fiscal year, refer to the fiscal year ended March 31.  
References to “U.S. Dollars” and “$” are to United States Dollars. 
1

PART I
ITEM 1. BUSINESS
Overview
We are a leading global provider of connected fleet and mobile asset solutions delivered as Software as a Service 
(“SaaS”). Our solutions deliver a measurable return by enabling our customers to manage, optimize and protect their 
investments in commercial fleets or personal vehicles. We generate actionable insights that enable a wide range of customers, 
from large enterprise fleets to small fleet operators and consumers, to reduce fuel and other operating costs, improve efficiency, 
enhance regulatory compliance, enhance driver safety, manage risk and mitigate theft. Our solutions mostly rely on our 
proprietary, highly scalable technology platforms, which allow us to collect, analyze and deliver information based on data 
from our customers’ vehicles. Using an intuitive, web-based interface, dashboards or mobile apps, our fleet customers can 
access large volumes of real-time and historical data, monitor the location and status of their drivers and vehicles and analyze a 
wide number of key metrics across their fleet operations.
We have a large global presence, with vehicle subscriptions in over 120 countries across six continents. We currently 
serve a highly diverse customer base, including 4,900 fleet operators, which represented 68% of our subscription revenue for 
fiscal year 2022. We target sales of our enterprise fleet management solutions to customers who desire a premium solution, 
generally for large fleets, which we define as fleets of 50 or more vehicles. Large fleets accounted for over 86% of our fleet 
subscriptions at March 31, 2022. We believe we have a satisfied customer base and, among our more than 1,000 large fleet 
operator customers, we experienced an annual customer retention rate of 93% in fiscal year 2022. In addition, for large fleets 
with 500 or more vehicles, we experienced an annual customer retention rate in excess of 98% in fiscal year 2022. We have 
multinational enterprise fleet customer deployments with companies such as Baker Hughes, BP, Chevron, DHL, G4S, 
Halliburton, Nestlé, PepsiCo, Schlumberger, Shell, The Linde Group, Total and Weatherford. We also offer a range of 
subscription-based fleet and vehicle management solutions to meet the needs and price points of small fleet operators and 
consumers. Our safety and security features, including driver performance and vehicle monitoring, are important attributes of 
our solutions for these customers.
With the exception of fiscal year 2021, we have consistently grown our customer base. As evidence of this growth, 
subscribers, one of our key operating metrics and a factor influencing our rate of subscription revenue growth, increased at a 
compound annual growth rate of 7.7% from April 1, 2014 to March 31, 2022, and as of March 31, 2022, we tracked and 
managed over 815,000 subscribers. As a result of the COVID-19 pandemic, fiscal year 2021 represented the only year of net 
subscriber contraction over this period of 73,800 subscribers, resulting in a 6.1% reduction in subscription revenue for the 
period, on a constant currency basis. As a further indicator of our scale, in fiscal year 2022, we collected data on approximately 
155 million trips per month and recorded approximately 9.7 billion vehicle positions per month. The monthly price charged per 
subscriber varies among our customers depending on the services and features they require, hardware options, customer size, 
route to market and geographic location of the customer. Consequently, our rate of subscription revenue growth is influenced 
by not only the rate of growth in the number of subscribers but also by the evolving mix of our subscriber base.
Industry Overview
Challenges Facing Fleet Operators Worldwide
Fleet managers operate in an increasingly competitive and highly regulated global environment. Timely and accurate 
decision-making enabled by solutions that provide real-time visibility into vehicle location and driver performance is critical to 
managing a safe, efficient fleet. In some developing areas of the world, ensuring driver and vehicle safety and security is also 
particularly challenging given high crime rates, which have resulted in automotive insurance mandates and regulatory 
requirements for vehicle tracking. Consequently, fleet managers and consumers demand solutions that promote driver and 
passenger safety, mitigate risk, drive operational efficiencies, improve security and reduce automotive insurance costs. The 
business environment for fleet managers is further complicated by the large number of transportation-related regulatory and 
compliance requirements worldwide, and the frequency with which rules and regulations change.
Legacy fleet management solutions inadequately address industry needs as many businesses use discrete manual 
processes, such as spreadsheet and paper-based systems and telephones, to monitor vehicle and driver activity. These 
approaches are labor intensive, prone to error, do not provide continuous monitoring of fleets, make it difficult to optimize fleet 
utilization, manage operating costs and generate minimal business intelligence. Additionally, legacy fleet management 
technology frequently provides limited functionality beyond basic location-based tracking and makes it difficult for fleet 
2

operators to fully benefit from the cost savings and efficiency improvements associated with more robust fleet management 
offerings.
Fleet operators face many significant challenges, which can include:
•
Significant operating costs. According to the American Transport Research Institute’s 2020 data, fuel represents 34%, 
repair & maintenance 16%, truck insurance premiums 10% and tires 4% of vehicle-based trucking operational costs 
per mile. Combined, these factors account for 64% of vehicle-based operational costs per mile, all of which can be 
reduced through connected fleet solutions and the process of positively impacting driving behaviors, including by 
reducing behaviors like speeding, harsh acceleration, harsh braking and excessive idling.
•
Poor visibility into fleet operations. Fleet operators frequently maintain vehicles across multiple geographic regions 
and often lack visibility into their fleets and oversight of their drivers. Poor fleet visibility makes it challenging to 
optimize fleet utilization, vehicle fleet size and miles driven while still meeting core business and customer servicing 
requirements. Poor driver oversight makes it difficult for operators to validate hours worked or customers visited, 
incentivize greater efficiency and discourage unproductive, undesirable or dangerous worker behavior.
•
Challenges in maintaining regulatory compliance. Internal compliance and reporting is driven by legislative and 
regulatory requirements, which are often subject to change, from regulatory authorities in nearly every jurisdiction 
globally. This can be particularly burdensome for fleet operators managing large vehicle fleets in multiple 
jurisdictions. For example, in the United States, fleet operators can face numerous complex regulatory requirements, 
including mandatory hours of service compliance and fuel tax reporting and more recently electronic logging devices 
(“ELD”) legislation that requires truck drivers to log their hours of service electronically.
•
Challenges in managing risk. Fleet operators are responsible for hiring, training and identifying risks associated with 
their drivers. Vehicle crashes are a leading cause of workplace injury and lead to significant costs for fleet operators, 
including financial liability and increased insurance premiums. Fleet operators need visibility into driving behavior to 
proactively identify and remediate drivers with poor driving habits.
•
Inefficient data management. Fleet operators receive operational information from many disparate sources, including 
communications from their technicians and customers, paper-based reports, third-party receipts for items such as fuel 
purchases, vehicle maintenance logs and customer invoices. While simply collecting this unstructured data is 
burdensome, organizing and analyzing the data to identify trends and other actionable business intelligence can be 
even more challenging.
Challenges Facing Fleet Operators and Consumers in Developing Markets
In certain developing regions of the world, driver safety and vehicle security are significant concerns given high crime 
rates and the impact these higher crime rates have on consumers, insurance costs and regulatory requirements. More 
specifically, fleet operators and consumers often need to address challenges including:
•
Managing the impact of crime. Vehicle crime rates in developing regions of the world often far exceed those in the 
United States and Western Europe, resulting in potentially significant costs for fleet operators and consumers. For 
example, we estimate that the rate of vehicle theft in South Africa is approximately double that in the United States.
•
Reducing insurance costs. In developed and developing regions, insurers often provide incentives for fleet operators 
and consumers who subscribe to a safety and security mobile asset management solution. Some insurance providers 
will not insure vehicles that lack a tracking solution, or will make the insurance premium cost prohibitive without one. 
Furthermore, insurance provider interest in safety and security solutions has increased following the introduction of 
driver performance monitoring solutions, which can enable innovative usage-based insurance and claims management 
initiatives.
•
Complying with regulatory mandates. The growing introduction of stringent occupational health and safety legislation 
in developing markets is adding pressure to fleet operators, who need to fulfill their duty of care while also complying 
with laws regulating driving hours, rest time, fuel taxes, etc.
3

Industry Trends
There have been substantial advances in the capabilities, reliability and affordability of technologies that can be used 
to cost-effectively collect and disseminate large amounts of vehicle data and video footage. GPS positioning and advanced on-
board systems generate valuable, objective real-time information, which provides the basis for driver and vehicle management 
solutions. Similarly, significant advances in the performance, reliability and affordability of fixed and wireless networks, 
computing power and data storage capabilities have supported the rise of cloud computing that enables the delivery of SaaS. 
These technological advances and market shifts have helped to foster demand for subscription-based fleet and mobile asset 
management solutions like ours.
While fleet and mobile asset management solutions can offer a wide range of features and benefits, the reasons for 
adopting these solutions often vary by customer type and geography. In developed regions, including North America and 
Western Europe, many fleet operators adopt fleet management software solutions in order to obtain greater visibility over their 
vehicles and mobile workforces, to achieve cost savings through efficiency improvements, including reduced fuel consumption, 
and to reduce regulatory compliance burdens. In many developing regions, including Eastern Europe, Latin America, Africa, 
the Middle East and parts of Asia, the security of personnel and asset protection features afforded by vehicle tracking and 
monitoring, resulting in greater asset visibility and a lower impact of theft, are also important reasons for the adoption of fleet 
and mobile asset management solutions. In Australia and parts of Africa, Asia, Europe and the Middle East, compliance with 
health and safety standards and policies are a key reason for adoption of these systems. Recognizing the variety of motivations 
influencing our existing and potential customers is an important aspect of developing and marketing our solutions.
Global and multinational companies are increasingly looking to consolidate their fleet management systems by moving 
to providers that have global reach. This is primarily driven by the desire to have a secure centralized view across their fleets 
and impose set global standards specifically relating to driver management and safety. These companies also recognize the 
advantages of gathering vast quantities of data to draw new insights into their global fleet operations.
A research publication by Berg Insight says the integration of cameras to enable various video-based solutions in 
commercial vehicle environments is one of the most apparent trends in the fleet telematics sector today. Growing at a 
compound annual growth rate (“CAGR”) of 16.5% they forecast that the active installed base of video telematics systems will 
reach almost 6.3 million units in North America by 2026. In Europe, the active installed base is forecasted to grow at a CAGR 
of 17.9% to reach 2.1 million video telematics systems by 2026. The video telematics market is served by many companies 
including video specialists, fleet telematics players and hardware-focused suppliers. With MiX Vision AI which was launched 
in fiscal year 2022 we will better be able to serve the video telematics market.
Market Opportunity
We believe that the addressable market for our fleet management solutions is large, growing and under-penetrated. 
According to a report by ABI Research (“ABI”), there were approximately 225 million commercial vehicles registered globally 
by the end of December 2020. Global fleet management penetration was estimated to be around 18.6%. ABI forecasts that by 
2026, the number of registered commercial vehicles will be approximately 304 million.
In addition to the growing market opportunity in commercial fleet vehicles, we believe there is a large and under-
penetrated market to provide a tailored set of safety and security solutions to non-commercial passenger vehicles. Worldwide, 
the pool of motor vehicles is large and growing, particularly in developing markets. We estimate that there are approximately 
7.8 million non-commercial passenger vehicles in operation in South Africa, as of August 2020, utilizing latest vehicle 
population information available from the National Traffic Information Systems. We believe the potential rate of consumer 
adoption of mobile asset management solutions is highest in developing regions where vehicle tracking and monitoring features 
can help to improve driver and passenger safety, reduce the impact of theft by improving stolen vehicle recovery rates and 
reduce consumer automotive insurance rates.
Our Solutions
Our subscription-based solutions enable our customers to manage, optimize and protect their investments in their 
commercial fleets and personal vehicles efficiently. Our highly scalable multi-tenant architecture leverages GPS and other data 
transmitted from in-vehicle devices, primarily over cellular networks. In fiscal year 2022, we collected data on approximately 
155 million trips per month and recorded approximately 9.7 billion vehicle positions per month.
4

The key attributes of our solutions include:
•
Highly scalable solutions. Our software solutions are built to scale and support geographically distributed fleets of any 
size. As of March 31, 2022 we provided services to more than 815,000 vehicles under subscription, with customers 
ranging from small fleet operators and consumers to large enterprise fleets with more than 10,000 assets.
•
Robust portfolio of features addressing a full range of customer needs. We believe that we offer one of the broadest 
ranges of features for fleet and mobile asset management available. For example, for fleet efficiency, we offer vehicle 
tracking and analysis, fuel consumption and mileage analysis; for regulatory compliance, we offer compliance 
monitoring, hours of service tracking and fuel tax reporting; for driver improvement, we offer in-vehicle video 
monitoring and in-cab real-time driver feedback; for risk management, we offer driver scoring and analysis and 
journey management; and for safety and security, we offer vehicle and asset tracking, crash notifications and vehicle 
theft recovery.
•
Insightful business intelligence and reporting. Our fleet management software is designed to provide our customers 
with insightful, actionable business intelligence on demand. For example, our premium fleet solution, MiX Fleet 
Manager, includes data reporting and analysis tools with more than 110 standard reports and the ability for customers 
to request custom fleet, vehicle and driver reports. We also offer a premium web-based business intelligence engine 
with enhanced analytics, reporting and data visualization tools for those customers seeking to perform highly granular 
analyses of large quantities of historical and real-time data and make the data available to customers in the format of 
their choice.
•
Easily accessible, intuitive applications. Our web-based solutions are accessible from fixed and mobile computing 
devices, and provide vehicle and fleet information, dashboard views and alerts and the ability to generate analytical 
reports from an office or a remote location. Our customers can choose to access our solution via an intuitive web-based 
interface or through our custom mobile applications developed for the Android and iOS mobile platforms. Fleet 
operators can also use our software development kits and application program interfaces to integrate our solution 
directly with their software systems, such as transportation management software, route planning systems and 
enterprise resource management software.
•
Software-as-a-service powered by a proven, reliable infrastructure. Our use of a multi-tenant SaaS architecture allows 
us to deliver fleet management applications that are highly functional, flexible and fast while reducing the cost and 
complexity associated with customer adoption. We support our SaaS delivered solutions with a proven infrastructure 
of redundant servers and other hardware located in secure third-party data centers. We have continued to maintain an 
overall system uptime of over 99.5%, measured quarterly.
Our Offerings
We offer a range of solutions to address the needs of diverse customer segments. Our primary subscription-based 
offerings are:
•
MiX Fleet Manager. MiX Fleet Manager is our premier commercial fleet management solution. It is built on a modern, 
scalable software platform for managing vehicle fleets of all sizes. Our fleet management systems provide a wide 
variety of complex data pertaining to driver behavior and the location, status and operational activity of vehicles and 
fleets. MiX Fleet Manager is an interactive, web-based application providing secure access to this complex data in a 
simple, intuitive manner. MiX Fleet Manager gives users live and historical views of driver and vehicle performance 
information, including vehicle tracking and status information as well as alerts and notifications. Together with our 
integrated MiX Insight Reports and MiX Mobile, the solution provides fleet managers with actionable business 
intelligence in the form of reports and fleet analytics. Customers can also subscribe to premium subscription-based 
applications supported on MiX Fleet Manager, such as:
◦
MiX Insight Agility, an extension to the MiX Insight Reports suite that allows for dynamic data interaction in 
Microsoft Excel. Unlike static reports, users have the power to create and shape customized dashboards in the 
format they prefer.
◦
MyMiX, an innovative driver engagement platform that provides professional drivers with easy 24-hour 
access, via the web or a mobile device, to key information about their performance. Driver scoring, a module 
available on MyMiX, boasts a sleek, engaging and user-friendly interface accessible from iOS or Android 
5

mobile devices. In fiscal year 2021, we implemented major updates to MyMiX mobile app to include task 
management functionality and also support tracking of drivers using their smartphones.
◦
MiX Vision, an on-road and in-vehicle video recording solution, that allows fleet managers to record video 
footage related to driving behavior and events. We believe MiX Vision addresses an important market need 
for in-vehicle surveillance, and MiX Vision is fully integrated with our premium fleet management solutions 
to enable event-driven or time based video recording and supports two additional external cameras. MiX 
Vision AI was launched in calendar year 2021 and we have seen strong interest in this new solution which 
leverages machine vision and AI technologies to detect driver distraction, fatigue and other unsafe driving 
practices.
◦
MiX Rovi, an in-vehicle display and communications system allowing fleet operators to streamline their fleet 
operations through improved communication between drivers and their back offices. Customized data inputs 
are configured in MiX Fleet Manager and can be updated locally or remotely via the Internet. For example, a 
fleet operator of delivery vehicles can set custom data inputs for information relating to deliveries, such as 
quantities delivered and collected, times of arrival and departure or time spent at unscheduled stops. MiX 
Rovi is electronic logging devices legislation (“ELD”) compliant. In fiscal year 2022, further software 
updates for the MiX Rovi in-cab display were carried out, including the development of Canadian ELD 
solution which will be will be rolled out in calendar year 2022.
◦
MiX RIBAS, an in-cab driving aid that helps drivers improve their driving style. Using an unobtrusive system 
of symbols with red, amber and green status lights accompanied by audible warning tones, drivers receive 
feedback on their driving style in real-time, enabling customers to manage improvements in driver and 
vehicle performance and reductions in fuel consumption and accident rates.
◦
MiX Hours of Service (“Hours of Service”), allows for the real-time monitoring and compliance of legislated 
or regulated hours of work for the United States, Canada and Europe. Mandated ELD legislation in the United 
States requires truck drivers to log their hours of service electronically. European customers can also use our 
optional “MiX 3D” service to download and archive digital tachograph data as required by European law. 
This add-on also accommodates region with non-regulated driving hours legislation, such as the Middle East 
and Africa, allowing fleet operators to easily set their own driving hours rules and measure activity to reduce 
fatigue related incidents. 
◦
MiX Journey Management, offers an easy-to-use electronic alternative to paper-based systems that ensures all 
risks relating to journeys are readily visible to decision makers when it matters most. MiX Journey 
Management suits fleet operators across diverse industries, and is ideal for those with large fleets of vehicles 
that travel long distances and carry passengers or cargo. 
•
MiX Asset Manager. Our portfolio of asset tracking products includes third party hardware products and products 
developed ourselves. By keeping track of valuable assets including generators, light towers, storage tanks and pumps, 
our asset management solution allows for increased visibility of corporate assets, resulting in improved asset 
utilization and reduced loss.
•
Matrix. Our Matrix suite of mobile asset management solutions is designed for entry-level fleets and consumers. The 
Matrix range of solutions can provide real-time and historical vehicle tracking and positioning, unauthorized vehicle 
use alerts, panic emergency response, crash alerts, driver behavior alerts, fuel tax logbooks and vehicle maintenance 
notifications. Users can access their Matrix subscription functionality via a web-based interface or our mobile 
applications.
•
Beam-e. Beam-e leverages our large network of subscribers as a crowdsourcing platform to locate vehicles without the 
expense of utilizing a traditional cellular network connection. Each Beam-e device communicates with other nearby 
devices in order to form a crowdsourced network that interfaces with our systems. Rental car companies, consumers 
and owners of high-value mobile assets can use Beam-e to provide entry-level tracking and recovery services at an 
upfront cost and monthly subscription price point that is well below the cost of traditional vehicle tracking solutions. 
We currently offer Beam-e in South Africa and are evaluating opportunities for expansion into other geographies 
which are similar to South Africa.
6

•
MiX Now. MiX Now is our self-service, plug and play offering for small fleet operators. This easy to use system helps 
companies monitor and manage the behavior and performance of their vehicles and drivers. Business owners can 
receive instant notifications or information from their mobile phones or log in from their computer from anywhere in 
the world, to get all the information they need to save money and improve their business operations. We currently offer 
MiX Now in the United States and are evaluating opportunities for expansion into other geographies.
Customers deploy our solutions to collect real-time data from their vehicles and transmit this information to our secure 
third-party data centers for processing. We generally design our own hardware and firmware in order to ensure their modularity, 
quality and interoperability with our core subscription offerings. We outsource the manufacturing of these devices and seek to 
drive device costs down over time in order to reduce the upfront investment required by our customers. In addition to sales of 
these devices to customers, we offer customers the option of bundling our devices as a full service option, further reducing the 
capital investment required to access our solutions.
We believe our modular, proprietary designs and control over the entire ecosystem gives us an advantage over 
competitors who rely on third-party commodity in-vehicle devices because we are able to provide more customized service and 
solutions through our proprietary devices. Currently we have three dominant in-vehicle platforms, namely one for enterprise 
fleet management, one for consumer vehicle management and light fleet management and one for Beam-e or MiX Tabs for 
entry-level vehicle and asset tracking and recovery.
Principal features associated with our subscription-based offerings include the following:
•
Vehicle tracking. Our vehicle tracking functionality allows our customers to pinpoint the exact locations of vehicles 
using real-time data. Notifications about vehicle activity and status are accessed through a web-based interface or our 
mobile applications. Our customers also have the ability to access historical tracking data for analysis.
•
Location management. Our location management and geofencing features allow customers to easily designate 
geographic areas in which vehicles are allowed or not allowed to travel, or areas deemed dangerous or high risk. 
Customers receive notifications when a vehicle enters or exits unauthorized regions or locations.
•
Vehicle security. Our vehicle security solution provides our customers with security options tailored to individual 
requirements. We offer vehicle tracking and recovery features, providing safety and security for our customers and 
their vehicles and helping to reduce the costs associated with theft.
•
Reporting & dashboards. We provide our customers with on-demand reports enabling access to a wide range of fleet 
data. Our reports contain detailed information about driver behavior, vehicle location, idle time, miles and hours 
driven, average speed, acceleration, crash analysis and vehicle diagnostics. We also offer premium data visualization 
and business intelligence tools.
•
Regulatory compliance. Customers can use our solutions to assist in regulatory compliance, for example hours of 
service and fuel tax reporting.
•
Vehicle and driver management. We provide functionality for customers to manage licenses, registrations, 
certifications, in-vehicle video monitoring and other vehicle and driver requirements.
•
Messaging. With MiX Rovi and MiX Go, fleet operators can communicate efficiently and effectively with their 
drivers. Custom menus direct driver workflow, jobs and navigation, ensuring drivers arrive at the correct destination 
and improving communication between fleet operators and their drivers.
•
Mobile access. We provide information to users via a variety of mobile platforms, including iOS and Android, and 
provide our customers with access to actionable business intelligence on their vehicles and mobile assets from the 
office or remotely.
•
Application integration. Our software development kits, MiX Integrate, allow our customers to integrate our 
applications with their existing enterprise software systems and allow for increased customization of our fleet reports, 
vehicle tracking alerts and location management features.
•
Real time monitoring. We offer active real time driver behavior monitoring and risk management services.
7

Our Key Competitive Strengths
The markets in which we operate are highly competitive and fragmented. We believe that the following attributes 
differentiate us from our competitors and are key factors to our success:
•
Globalized sales, distribution and support capabilities. We currently maintain a direct and indirect sales and support 
presence, with localized application support in multiple languages, in countries across Africa, Australasia, Europe, the 
Middle East, North America and South America. We believe our global presence gives us an important advantage in 
competing for business from multinational enterprise fleet customers such as Baker Hughes, BP, Chevron, DHL, G4S, 
Halliburton, Nestlé, PepsiCo, Schlumberger, Shell, The Linde Group, Total and Weatherford, who often prefer to 
consolidate disparate fleet management systems.
•
Solutions adaptable to multiple customer segments. We believe that by leveraging our common core technologies, 
personnel and systems, we can cost-effectively develop and sell a range of subscription-based fleet and mobile asset 
management solutions that are designed to meet the functionality and price needs of multiple customer segments, 
including fleet operators and consumers. Our fleet management solutions include targeted functionality to address the 
distinct needs of key industry segments, including oil and gas, transportation and logistics, government and municipal, 
bus and coach, and rental and leasing, as well as for the needs of consumers. We believe that offering a range of 
subscription-based solutions maximizes our ability to serve the addressable market and offers an appealing value 
proposition to our customers, while distinguishing ourselves from competitors that offer a single, one-size-fits-all 
solution.
•
Focus on safety and security. Most of our solutions incorporate safety and security features that enable our customers 
to enhance their drivers’ and passengers’ personal safety, encourage safe driving behavior and protect vehicle 
investments. We also offer web-based driver training, proactive journey management and other related services to 
provide a turnkey safety and security solution to manage risk and fatigue-related incidents. Our differentiated safety 
and security features have particularly strong appeal to customers in regulated industries, such as oil and gas, 
customers in industries exposed to liability concerns, such as bus and coach, and customers operating in high crime 
regions. We perform training and land transport assessments for customers to assist them in establishing and 
maintaining safety levels. We believe our safety and security offerings also help our customers to reduce operating 
costs associated with the training of drivers.
•
Track record of innovation. Our investment in software development is core to our business strategy. Our software 
teams employ an agile software development methodology. We have made a significant investment in product 
development, and we have routinely been among the first to market with innovative solutions and features that cater to 
the needs of our customers. For example, in fiscal year 2021, we added MyMiX tracking to our broad product 
portfolio. MyMiX Tracking enables fleet operators to track and manage the safety of their drivers by leveraging smart 
phone technology. We integrated our systems with the telematics services offered by two truck manufacturers and also 
launched a fringe benefit tax solution for Australia. During fiscal year 2022 we launched a new MiX Vision AI 
solution and an embedded analytics and dashboard platform leveraging a new data lake. We also developed a 
Canadian ELD solution for MiX Fleet Manager which will be released in calendar 2022, integrated with various OEM 
telematics data services and delivered various updates to our hardware platform in response to the global electronic 
component crisis. 
•
Longstanding, established market position. We have a 26-year history, a geographically diverse sales and marketing 
footprint, a large established network of distributors and dealers, and a large base of satisfied customers. Our robust 
and referenceable customer base, including numerous Forbes Global 2000 enterprises, is a critical selling point to both 
large enterprise fleets and small fleet operators.
Growth Strategy
We intend to expand our market leadership by:
•
Acquiring new customers and increasing sales to existing customers. We believe the market for fleet and mobile asset 
management solutions is large and growing, creating a significant opportunity for us to expand our customer base. 
Additionally, we believe we have the opportunity to expand our fleet management market share among our existing 
customer base by demonstrating our value proposition, growing with the customer, introducing new and innovative 
value-added solutions and displacing legacy fleet management solutions.
8

•
Expanding our geographic presence. We market and distribute our solutions directly and through a global network of 
approximately 130 channel partners outside of South Africa. We are expanding our penetration in attractive 
geographic regions, such as Brazil and the United States, and continue to expand our network of strategic and sales 
distribution partners in other regions of the world. In addition to our primary hosted data centers that serve multiple 
geographies, we also established two hosted data centers in specific countries where local conditions require that the 
data be retained in-country.
•
Broadening our customer segment focus. We currently have customers across numerous industry segments, with the 
resources of our direct sales organization focused on premium customers in certain key segments, including oil and 
gas, transportation and logistics, government and municipal, bus and coach, and rental and leasing. We are currently 
increasing our product development initiatives and sales and distribution efforts in other industry segments, such as 
service fleets, and in other customer segments, such as small business fleets and as well as mobile asset management. 
We regularly evaluate opportunities to expand our target customer focus.
•
Continuing to introduce new, innovative solutions to address market demand. We are continually innovating and 
extending our solutions portfolio based on our assessment of market demand and trends. In fiscal 2021, we added 
MyMiX Tracking, integrated with Scania and Navistar’s telematics services and launched a Fringe Benefit Tax 
solution for Australia. During fiscal year 2022 we launched a new MiX Vision AI solution, MiX OEM Connect and an 
embedded analytics and dashboard platform leveraging a new data lake. We also developed a Canadian ELD solution 
which will be released in calendar 2022, integrated with more OEM telematics data services and delivered various 
updates to all our hardware platforms in response to the global electronic component crisis. We are continually 
innovating and extending our solutions portfolio based on our assessment of market demand and trends.
•
Pursuing strategic acquisitions. Our industry is highly fragmented. We intend to selectively evaluate acquisition 
opportunities in certain geographic regions and industry segments.
Sales and Marketing
We offer our solutions in over 120 countries through a combination of our direct and indirect marketing efforts. Our 
sales and marketing strategy is segmented by geographic region and customer type to cost effectively target and acquire new 
customers, as well as expanding and up-selling existing customers. In certain regions, we sell subscriptions of our fleet 
management solutions to large enterprise fleets through our direct sales force. In other regions, and for sales to small fleet 
operators and consumers, we work with an extensive distribution network of regional partners and national distribution value-
added resellers. Through our central services organization headquartered in South Africa, we provide common marketing, 
product management, technical and distribution support to each of our regional sales and marketing operations.
The following is a brief description of the main categories of our sales and marketing efforts.
•
Direct Sales. We focus our direct selling efforts on targeting, acquiring, servicing and upselling our premium solutions 
to large enterprise fleet operators and small fleet operators. We maintain sales offices in Australia, Brazil, South 
Africa, Uganda, the United Arab Emirates, the United Kingdom and the United States. These offices sell directly to 
large enterprise fleet operators and small fleet operators in their respective regions and are also responsible for channel 
management of fleet solution distribution partners throughout their regions. Our sales and marketing approach with 
fleet customers is generally based on a combination of return on investment and the improvements in safety and 
security delivered by our solutions. Our South African sales offices also sell directly to consumers.
•
Digital Marketing. Our digital marketing focus complements our verticalized sales strategy and supports quality and 
high quantity targeted lead generation in all of our regions. Lead generation channels include search engine platforms 
and social media platforms where our target prospects are researching topics that our solutions can help them to solve, 
including supporting communicating our latest and future product launches.
•
Indirect Sales – Enterprise Fleet. We have over 130 fleet value-added resellers supporting customers with vehicles in 
over 120 countries worldwide. These resellers are responsible for sales, marketing, technical support, installation and 
training of customers in their regions. We operate a partner accreditation program in order to assure a consistent 
customer experience across our resellers worldwide. We also offer marketing and support services to enhance their 
selling success. We believe our large network provides us with a geographically diverse, highly effective channel for 
reaching local customers in countries where we do not currently have a direct presence.
9

•
Indirect Sales – Small Fleet Operators and Consumers. We currently manage an extensive network of distribution 
partners for our small fleet operator and consumer customers. Our distribution partners include automobile dealers, 
aftermarket automotive parts and service suppliers, automobile insurers and retailers. We believe our indirect 
distribution strategy for the small fleet operator and consumer markets provides us with a differentiated, cost-effective 
customer acquisition and sales model.
Our global network of independent value-added resellers and distributors is an important component of our sales 
strategy. Our resellers and distributors account for a substantial percentage of our total sales, and sales generated by certain 
resellers and distributors represent a meaningful percentage of our revenue. The terms of our agreements with our resellers do 
not usually include minimum purchase obligations, are specific to a geographic territory and are primarily non-exclusive. They 
generally have a fixed initial term, after which they may be renewed or continue indefinitely if not terminated. This is subject to 
the right of either party to terminate on specified notice generally ranging from 90 days to one year, or for breach. Similarly, 
our distributor agreements do not include minimum purchase obligations and consist principally of a commission agreement 
applicable to sales generated by the distributor.
Our revenue by geographic segment is set out in note 14 of the consolidated financial statements included in this 
annual report.
Customers
We currently serve a highly diverse customer base, including approximately 4,900 fleet operators which represented 
68% of our subscription revenue for fiscal year 2022, as well as individual consumers. We target sales of our enterprise fleet 
management solutions to customers who desire a premium solution, generally for large fleets, which we define as being fleets 
of 50 or more vehicles. Large fleets comprised 86% of our fleet customer subscriptions as of March 31, 2022. We also offer a 
range of subscription-based fleet and mobile asset management solutions optimized for the needs and price points demanded by 
small fleet operators and consumers.
Our current customer base spans numerous industry categories and customer segments, including oil and gas, 
transportation and logistics, government and municipal, bus and coach, and rental and leasing. No individual customer 
represented more than 7.0% of our subscription revenues for fiscal year 2022. For fiscal years 2022, 2021 and 2020, our top 10 
fleet customers represented 16.6%, 21.8%, and 23.7%, respectively, of our total subscription revenue.
The following is a representative list of some of our largest customers:
•
Halliburton
•
Schlumberger
•
Imperial
•
NexTier Oilfield Services
•
LafargeHolcim
•
Unitrans
•
Fleetplus Pty Ltd
•
Baker Hughes
•
Super Group
•
Chevron
•
Rio Tinto
•
Toll Group
•
Anglo
•
G4S
•
Wincanton
•
TCO Contractor (Tcon)
•
OMV Petrom
We believe that we have a satisfied customer base as evidenced by our customer retention rate and the favorable 
results of our customer surveys. In fiscal year 2022, among our more than 1,000 large fleet operator customers, we experienced 
an annual customer retention rate of 93%. We maintain a strong focus on monitoring and continuously enhancing our customer 
satisfaction levels.
10

Service and Support
Installation of our solutions in our customers’ vehicles is generally provided by us or our third-party network, which 
includes dealers and distributors and installation partners. Customer care and technical support services are provided by our 
offices in Australia, Brazil, South Africa, the United Arab Emirates, the United Kingdom, Romania and the United States. In 
many cases, our dealers and distributors also provide customers with tier-one customer support services. Our regional offices 
and dealers and distributors are, in turn, supported by our central technical support team in South Africa that handles any 
escalated issues. Existing customers can also access customer and technical support directly through our web or mobile 
applications. Our technical support department is composed of a team of highly skilled staff who are familiar with all of our 
products, including our entire range of software and service solutions as well as our hardware. The MiX Learning Centre is 
used by staff and customers around the world to undertake online training to learn about new products and enhancements.
We offer warranties of varying duration on our products. Product warranties are predominantly for a one-year period 
but periods of up to three years are provided in certain geographic locations. Our Beam-e product carries a lifetime warranty (to 
the extent that the unit remains in the vehicle into which it was installed for the original subscriber). Warranty expenses are not 
a significant portion of our total costs.
Research and Development
As of March 31, 2022, our development group consists of 165 full-time staff responsible for software, hardware and 
firmware development and quality assurance. Our primary development group is based in Stellenbosch, South Africa, and we 
have additional development resources in Johannesburg, South Africa, as well as the United States. Our software development 
teams employ an agile development methodology, while our engineering teams use traditional waterfall project management 
methods. During fiscal years 2022, 2021 and 2020, we invested $9.3 million, $7.2 million and $8.8 million, respectively, in 
research and development.
Our investment in development is core to our business strategy. Our research and development efforts principally 
involve software development, firmware development, hardware design and related test equipment. Research and development 
costs are expensed as they are incurred. In addition, we have enhanced certain of our hardware components to extend their 
functionality and reduce component and manufacturing costs.
We have been successful in expanding our product offerings over time, mostly through internal development for which 
we own all Intellectual Property. Highlights from the fiscal year 2022 include:
•
The deployment of 21system-wide platform updates and 29 mobile app updates to our live environments;
•
The implementation of a new data lake underpinning a new embedded dashboard and analytics platform for premium 
fleet customers;
•
Updates on all our hardware platforms: MiX2000, MiX4000 & MiX6000 and Beame;
•
Launch of our MiX OEM Connect solution to leverage telematics services provided by Original Equipment 
Manufacturers (truck makers); 
•
Launch of MiX Vision AI solution; and
•
Development of Canadian ELD solution which will be released in calendar 2022.
Our Devops and SaaS operations are ISO 9001 and ISO 27001 certified with a formalized quality policy and consistent 
monitoring of internal processes, supplier and solution performance. We outsource all hardware manufacturing to third parties.
Technology
Our solutions are offered using a multi-tenant SaaS architecture that scales rapidly to support additional new 
subscribers through the addition of incremental data processing and storage capacity. This architecture flexibility allows us to 
sustain high levels of uptime without degradation of system performance, despite significant subscriber growth. Our existing 
architecture and infrastructure has been designed with sufficient capacity to meet our current and anticipated future needs. Our 
subscription-based fleet and consumer service offerings are designed to be accessible via a standard web browser or mobile 
device application.
Our solutions typically include a proprietary in-vehicle device that incorporates off-the-shelf components, generally 
including a cellular modem, GPS receiver and memory capacity sufficient to run our firmware, which gathers vehicle location, 
time, speed, ignition status, miles driven and various vehicle and driver statistics. This information is collected at a predefined 
11

frequency and then sent to our receivers at secure third-party data centers, generally via a commercial cellular network. The 
information is then processed and delivered to our customers through our web-based and mobile device applications. Our 
solutions enable our fleet customers to access large volumes of historical and real-time data, monitor the location and status of 
their fleet vehicles and drivers, view a wide selection of reports and key performance indicator dashboards and generate 
valuable, actionable business intelligence.
We store data, host our solutions and serve all of our customers from third-party data centers located in Algiers in 
Algeria, Sydney in Australia, Muscat in Oman, Dublin in Ireland, and Virginia in the United States. In addition to data hosted at 
third party data centers, the vast majority of our cloud-based SaaS service leverages Amazon Web Services. Our data 
management facilities provide us with both physical security, including manned security, biometric access controls and systems 
security, including firewalls, encryption, redundant power and environmental controls. We believe that our third-party hosting 
facilities are adequate for our current needs and that suitable additional capacity will be available as needed to accommodate 
planned expansion of our operations.
Intellectual Property
We rely primarily on trade secret laws, confidentiality agreements, confidentiality procedures and contractual 
restrictions to establish and protect our intellectual property rights. We also rely to a limited extent on patent, trademark and 
copyright law. A patent covering certain aspects of our Beam-e product was issued in South Africa during fiscal year 2014 and 
a patent covering a method for driver verification was issued during fiscal year 2015. A further patent for an asset tracking 
system and method was issued in Brazil during fiscal year 2022.
We typically enter into non-disclosure and confidentiality agreements with our employees, licensees and independent 
consultants and other advisors. We also seek these protective agreements from some of our suppliers and subcontractors who 
have access to sensitive information regarding our intellectual property.
Competition
The rapidly evolving market for our solutions is competitive and highly fragmented, particularly by geography and 
customer segment. We currently compete with numerous providers of fleet and mobile asset management solutions that range 
from small, regional providers to midsized multinational providers, such as Teletrac Navman and Geotab, to large global 
providers, such as Trimble, Omnitracs and Samsara. While we currently only compete with Trimble and Omnitracs on a limited 
basis, these two competitors are well established companies with significantly greater financial and other resources than we 
have. Many of our competitors offer fleet or mobile asset management software solutions to particular industry segments or in 
limited geographic regions. For example, we compete with Microlise and Michelin (Masternaut) in Europe, in the US we 
compete with Geotab and Samsara, in South Africa we compete with Netstar and Ctrack, Tracker and Cartrack for consumer 
and small fleet mobile asset management deployments in South Africa, respectively.
We believe the principal competitive factors in our market include the following:
•
functionality and reliability;
•
total cost of ownership;
•
breadth and depth of application functionality for fleet deployments;
•
product performance;
•
interoperability;
•
brand and reputation;
•
customer service;
•
distribution channels, including a global footprint and the ability to service multinationals; 
•
regional geographic expertise including localized language support and support for applicable government regulations;
•
size of customer base and reference accounts within key industry segments;
•
ability to deliver ongoing value and return on investment; 
•
ease of deployment and ease of use;
•
relevant industry domain expertise and functionality; and
•
the financial resources of the vendor.
We believe that we compete favorably on the basis of these factors.
12

Employees
The following table presents the breakdown of our employees at the date indicated:
As of March 31,
2020
2021
2022
South Africa
860
811
849
United States
79
69
80
United Kingdom
57
53
57
United Arab Emirates
29
21
18
Australia
39
39
44
Brazil
27
26
26
Uganda
4
4
4
Romania
5
5
5
Thailand
3
3
0
Total
1103
1031
1083
Full-time
1035
946
996
Part-time
68
85
87
Total
1103
1031
1083
Government Regulation
We are subject to laws and regulations relating to our business operations, including laws applicable to providers of 
Internet and mobile services both domestically and internationally, as we collect data, including personal data, disseminate data 
and, in some cases, sell data. The application of existing domestic and international laws and regulations relating to issues such 
as user privacy and data protection, marketing, advertising, inadvertent disclosure and consumer protection in many instances is 
unclear or unsettled.
The transmission of data over the Internet and cellular networks is a critical component of our SaaS business model. 
Additionally, as cloud computing continues to evolve, increased regulation by federal, state or foreign agencies becomes more 
likely, particularly in the areas of data privacy and data security. In particular, the dynamic regulatory environment in the 
European Union and the United Kingdom, made more uncertain due to Brexit, is resulting in additional and increasingly 
complex regulation in these areas and we believe that the similarly dynamic regulatory environment of the United States, will 
follow suit. New laws governing data privacy and data security will furthermore be enacted in many other regions. Laws 
governing the solicitation, collection, processing or use of data could impair our ability to manage and report on customer data, 
which is integral to the delivery of our SaaS solutions. Increased regulation and the expansion of our business and operations 
globally have required us to devote legal and other resources to address this regulation. We continuously update and will 
continue to evaluate our group data protection and security policies, charters and procedures, to assist in maintaining data 
privacy and data security in line with international practices.
Data privacy regulations and applicable laws in the United States, the European Union or elsewhere will regulate our 
ability to use the data we gather from our customers and increase the cost of doing business and could result in claims being 
brought by our customers or third parties. As discussed below, South Africa, which is currently our largest market, has its own 
data protection and security law which came into full effect on July 1, 2021.
South African Regulatory Environment
The Protection of Personal Information Act, No. 4 of 2013 (the “POPI Act”) was promulgated into law in South Africa 
in November 2013 and came into full effect on July 1, 2021. Any failure to comply with the POPI Act may result in a fine not 
exceeding R10 million and/or imprisonment of up to 10 years, depending on the severity of such failure.
13

The purpose of the POPI Act is to promote the privacy of data subjects by establishing a legal framework to regulate 
the processing of personally identifiable information by mandating juristic persons to implement security measures that uphold 
the data protection principles and ultimately providing redress through the Information Regulator.
The POPI Act’s implementation has had an impact on our data security and business costs, practices and procedures in 
South Africa. We have, with the assistance of a third-party project specialist, completed a POPI Act implementation project. 
Data protection principles and integration remain an ongoing business priority; therefore, we are embarking on the 
implementation of data loss prevention methodologies and initiatives with the support of a third-party security specialist.
Several existing South African statutes regulate electronic communications, including the Electronic Communications 
Act, No. 36 of 2005 as amended, and the Electronic Communications and Transactions Act, No. 25 of 2002, which apply to 
several aspects of our business. These statutes regulate the generation, communication, production, processing, sending, 
receiving, recording, retaining, storing, displaying and use of information, document or signature by or in electronic form.
The Private Security Industry Regulation Act, No. 56 of 2001 (the “PSIRA Act”) also applies to our South African 
business and governs the vehicle recovery industry in South Africa. The PSIRA Act was enacted for the purposes of, inter alia: 
(i) the achievement and maintenance of a trustworthy and legitimate private security industry which acts in terms of the 
principles contained in the Constitution of the Republic of South Africa, Act No. 108 of 1996, and other applicable law, and is 
aimed at ensuring that there is greater safety and security in the country and; (ii) to regulate the private security industry and to 
exercise effective control over the practice of the occupation of security service providers in the public and national interest and 
the interest of the private security industry itself.
The National Environmental Management: Waste Act, No. 59 of 2008 (the “NEM: WA Act”) applies to producers of 
electronic waste (“e-waste”). The NEM: WA Act governs the legal reforms regulating the waste management standards, norms 
and/or practices in order to protect the health and well-being of communities, and the environment. The NEM: WA Act also 
provides for the creation of integrated waste management and industry waste management schemes. We are a member of 
electronic Waste Association of South Africa (“e-WASA”) Extended Producer Responsibility (“EPR”) scheme which is a 
conduit in fulfilling the obligations under the regulations and ensuring the environmentally sound management of e-waste. The 
scheme also responds to the socio-economic challenges and opportunities arising from high volumes of e-waste such as job 
creation, skills development as set out in the National Development Scheme and Sustainable Development Goals.
Broad-Based Black Economic Empowerment
           
The South African government established a legislative framework for the promotion of Broad-Based Black Economic 
Empowerment (“B-BBEE”). Achievement of B-BBEE objectives is measured by a scorecard which establishes a weighting for 
the various components of B-BBEE which relates to Ownership, Management Control, Skills Development, Enterprise and 
Supplier Development (including Preferential Procurement) and Socio-Economic Development. The B-BBEE codes have a 
continuous review process which resulted in new B-BBEE Codes coming into effect on May 1, 2015, with more onerous 
compliance requirements, and proposed amendments. In addition, 2018 was a very active year in terms of additional proposed 
and actual changes to the Revised Codes of Good Practice (“RCoGP”) which were published by the DTI for public comment. 
In March 2018 the DTI gazetted the Youth Employment Service (“Y.E.S”) initiative as well as proposals on some changes to 
the Skills Development scorecard. The Y.E.S. Initiative was promulgated on August 28, 2018 by Minister Dr. Rob Davies and 
amongst others provide opportunities to corporates to improve their B-BBEE contributor level by virtue of participation in the 
Y.E.S. Initiative. Amendments to the RCoGP were also signed by the Minister of Trade and Industry on May 31, 2019 for 
implementation on December 1, 2019. These have an impact on the Skills Development and Enterprise and Supplier 
Development (including Preferential Procurement) pillars. In addition, some definitions and interpretations were further 
clarified and a few General Principles amended. Since 2019, we have seen minor amendments which speak mainly to 
interpretation and clarification of the application of the Codes.
It is important for us to achieve applicable B-BBEE objectives to ensure sustainability and contribute towards the 
realization of the National Development Plan 2030. In addition, B-BBEE objectives are pursued, in significant part, by 
requiring parties who contract with corporate, governmental and State Owned Enterprises in South Africa to achieve B-BBEE 
compliance through satisfaction of an applicable scorecard. Parties improve their B-BBEE contributor level when contracting 
with businesses that have earned good B-BBEE contributor levels in relation to their scorecards. In 2019 the Minister of Labor 
also declared his intention to promulgate Section 53 of the Employment Equity Act (“EE Act”) which means that every 
employer that makes an offer to conclude an agreement with any Organ of State for the furnishing of supplies or services to that 
Organ of State must comply to certain chapters of the EE Act and attach to the offer either a certificate proving compliance with 
the relevant Chapters of the EE Act; or a declaration by the employer that it complies with the relevant Chapters of the EE Act 
which when verified by the Director-General is conclusive evidence of compliance. 
14

We have three material end-customers, which require MiX Telematics Enterprise SA Proprietary Limited to maintain 
at least a B-BBEE contributor level 3 as measured under the new B-BBEE Codes in addition to at least one requiring additional 
commitments in terms of Skills Development and Sub-Contracting of at least 30% of the contract value to a Small Black 
Owned Supplier. The value of these contracts represented 2.9% of our total revenue for fiscal year 2022. MiX Telematics 
Enterprise SA Proprietary Limited has attained the agreed compliance targets in fiscal year 2022 and furthermore has 
maintained not only their position on the scorecard to the highest level possible but also its Black ownership in particular that of 
Black Women following the conclusion of the sales of assets (properties) as allowed for in the B-BBEE Codes. Failing to 
achieve applicable B-BBEE objectives could jeopardize our ability to maintain existing business or to secure future business 
from corporate, governmental or State Owned Enterprises that could materially and adversely affect our business, financial 
condition and results of operations.
U.S. Regulatory Environment
In addition to its regulation of Internet and, by extension, many SaaS providers, the Federal Trade Commission 
(“FTC”), has been asked by consumer groups to identify practices that may compromise privacy and consumer welfare; 
examine opt-in procedures to ensure consumers are aware of the type of data being collected and how it will be used; and create 
policies to halt abusive practices. The FTC has expressed interest in particular in the mobile environment and services that 
collect sensitive data, such as location-based information, which could conceivably be expanded to include transceiver products 
such as our in-vehicle devices. Although much of the FTC’s focus is on consumer protection, to the extent that our clients use 
our systems to monitor employee movement, the FTC may assert jurisdiction. In addition to FTC scrutiny on the consumer side, 
many fleet drivers in the U.S. may belong to a union, which triggers some degree of oversight from the National Labor 
Relations Board (“NLRB”). The NLRB has taken increasing notice of the privacy rights on unionized employees, and future 
NLRB rules could affect our business model or the way in which our corporate clients use our solutions.
Our business is affected by U.S. federal and state laws and regulations governing the collection, use, retention, sharing 
and security of data that we receive from and about our users. In recent years, regulation has focused on the collection, use, 
processing, disclosure and security of information that may be used to identify or is reasonably capable of being associated 
with, or could reasonably be linked, directly or indirectly, with a particular consumer, such as a name, address, email address, 
geolocation, biometric information, and/or professional or employment-related information (“personal information” or 
“personal data”). While several states are considering and/or have recently passed new privacy legislation, California was the 
first state to enact its own privacy law, the California Consumer Privacy Act (the “CCPA”), which took effect on January 1, 
2020. The CCPA is applicable to certain businesses that collect personal information about California residents, requiring 
businesses to provide privacy notices to individuals and enhanced consumer rights (e.g., consumers may request deletion of, 
access to, or a copy of their personal information, as well as opt-out of the sale of their personal information). However, the 
CCPA carves out a B2B exemption so that most of its requirements do not apply to the personal information of employees or 
applicants held by the employing entity and used only to administer the employment relationship or applicant process; 
currently, the B2B exemption expires on January 1, 2023. The CCPA also creates a private right of action and statutory 
damages of $100-750 per violation in the event of data breach of unencrypted or “un-redacted” personal information, if the 
company does not have “reasonable” security. In addition, the California Attorney General has enforcement power and may 
issue penalties of up to $2,500 ($7,500 if intentional) per violation.
The California Privacy Rights Act (the “CPRA”), which amends the CCPA, will take effect on January 1, 2023. Most 
notably, under the CPRA, the definition of “personal information” is expanded to include “sensitive personal information” 
which includes government identifiers, account and login information, precise geolocation data, racial or ethnic origin, religious 
or philosophical beliefs, union membership, contents of mail, email and text messages, genetic data, and certain sexual 
orientation, health and biometric information. If collected, certain notices and choices to limit the use of sensitive personal 
information must be provided to consumers.
Virginia became the second state to enact its own privacy law, the Virginia Consumer Protection Act (the “VCDPA”) 
which will become effective on January 1, 2023. The VCDPA is applicable to certain businesses that collect personal data about 
Virginia residents, requiring businesses to provide privacy notices to individuals and enhanced consumer rights (e.g., 
consumers may request confirmation that their personal data is processed and opt out of targeted ads, sales of their personal 
data, and profiling, as well as request correction of, deletion of, and a copy of their personal data). The definition of “personal 
data” also includes “sensitive data” which includes precise geolocation data. If collected, businesses must obtain prior consent 
to process a consumer’s sensitive data. While there is no private right of action under the VCDPA, the Virginia Attorney 
General may issue fines for the failure to cure a violation after notice of up to $7,500 per violation. That said, the VCDPA does 
not apply to individuals acting in an employee or B2B context.
15

Other states, including Colorado, Utah, and Connecticut have recently passed similar privacy laws requiring businesses 
to provide privacy notices and enhanced consumer rights to residents. Failure to comply with privacy laws could result in 
penalties. The Colorado Privacy Act is effective on July 1, 2023; the Utah Consumer Privacy Act is effective on December 1, 
2023; and the Connecticut Data Privacy Act is effective on July 1, 2023. Please note that like the VCDPA, these privacy laws 
do not apply to individuals acting in an employee or B2B context.
These state privacy laws may apply to mobile and Internet advertising privacy practices, depending on whether or not 
there is a sale or sharing of personal information pursuant to these laws, as well as if the information collected, used, disclosed, 
or otherwise processed is considered “sensitive personal information.” In addition to the potential risks imposed by state 
privacy laws, the FTC has conducted numerous related discussions and suggested that more rigorous privacy regulation is 
appropriate, possibly including regulation of non-personally identifiable information which could, with other information, be 
used to identify an individual. The commercial use of our mobile technology may reduce exposure to FTC regulation and 
enforcement, but geo-location and similar services are receiving increased regulatory interest and as such may affect how we 
conduct our business in the future.
Some U.S. state privacy laws have also adopted data minimization principles. For instance, under the CPRA, 
collection, use, retention, and sharing of a consumer’s personal information must be “reasonably necessary and proportionate to 
achieve the purposes for which the personal information was collected or processed.” Further, personal information and 
sensitive personal data information (which includes geolocation) may not be retained “for longer than is reasonably necessary.”
In addition, several U.S. state laws require data owners to implement reasonable security measures to protect the 
personal data collected from residents. These laws generally require a data owner to implement reasonable security procedures 
and practices appropriate to the nature of the information, and to protect the personal data from unauthorized access, 
destruction, use, modification, or disclosure. Although most of these state laws generally require an entity to maintain 
appropriate security, at least one state (Massachusetts) has adopted comprehensive data privacy requirements to protect 
personal data. However, these regulations only apply to more sensitive data, such as driver’s license number, Social Security 
number, and other government identifiers, as well as financial account and credit card number. California was the first state to 
enact an Internet of Things (IoT) cybersecurity law, which took effect on January 1, 2020. The law requires manufacturers of 
any internet-connected devices to equip them with “reasonable” security features that are: appropriate for the nature and 
function of the device; appropriate for the information it may collect, contain, or transmit; and designed to protect the device 
and any information contained within the device from unauthorized access, destruction, use, modification or disclosure. While 
there is no private right of action, this law may subject us to potential governmental enforcement actions for noncompliance.
Finally, we use GPS satellites to obtain location data for our in-vehicle devices. The satellites and their ground control 
and monitoring stations are maintained and operated by the U.S. Department of Defense, which does not currently impose 
additional laws and/or regulations on the ability to access location data. We cannot assure that it will not do so in the future. 
Any regulatory hurdles could impede the functionality and/or cost of our solutions, which could adversely affect our business. 
The communication systems that we use to host and transmit data may be subject to security incidents, which may also subject 
the Company to regulatory enforcement and client pressures.
European Union Regulatory Environment
We are subject to regulation under the laws of the European Union. Of particular relevance with regard to the 
regulation of our solutions are matters of data protection and privacy. More broadly, any processing of personal data in the 
course of the provision of services is governed by the European Union data protection regime. The framework legislation at a 
European Union level in respect of data protection, Directive 95/46/EC, was superseded by the General Data Protection 
Regulation (EU) 2016/679 (“GDPR”), effective May 25, 2018. In addition, local State data protection and privacy laws apply as 
well. Some of these place obligations additional to the GDPR on organizations operating in the European Union, such as 
express suppression of positioning and speeding data when vehicles are used for private trips. The GDPR creates a single legal 
framework that applies across all EU member states, and in some circumstances, to processors in a state outside of the 
European Union where this activity affected EU citizens. The GDPR has compliance obligations for data controllers and data 
processors (we regard our solutions as falling within the processor obligations, on behalf of our customers, the controller). 
National Data Protection Authorities (“NDPAs”) are able to impose fines for violations ranging from 2% to 4% of annual 
worldwide turnover, or 10 million to 20 million Euro, whichever is greater. NDPAs have the power to carry out audits, request 
information, obtain access to premises and compel implementation of specific business practices where there are compliance 
concerns and risks. Data controllers must be able to demonstrate that the personal data of any data subject can be lawfully 
processed on one of the six specified grounds, and flow down compliance obligations onto a processor. 
The GDPR adopts a risk-based approach to compliance, under which controllers and processors bear responsibility for 
assessing the degree of risk that their processing activities pose to data subjects. A controller may be required to perform data 
16

protection impact assessments before any processing that uses new technology and is likely to result in a high risk to data 
subjects. The GDPR requires controllers and processors to maintain records of their processing activities, and deal with a data 
security breach in a specific manner. Under the GDPR, data subjects have specific rights in certain circumstances, for example, 
the right to request that businesses delete their personal data (the right to be forgotten); to object to their personal data being 
processed; and to obtain a copy of their personal data within a set time frame.
Data flows within the European Union are not restricted, but some data out flows from the European Union are subject 
to restrictions to ensure an adequate protection for EU citizen’s personal data.
United Kingdom Regulatory Environment
As a result of its departure from the European Union, the United Kingdom is no longer subject to the EU GDPR 
framework. In the United Kingdom, data protection is governed by the Data Protection Act 2018 and the UK GDPR (which 
adopts the EU GDPR and procedures as at December 31, 2020 only) into UK law. At present, the United Kingdom and 
European Union regimes are similar. The UK framework places equivalent obligations on controllers and processors to those 
set out in the EU GDPR, including obligations on controllers to ensure lawful grounds for processing data, adequate security 
measures are in place to secure it, and equivalent rights are available to UK citizens to protect their personal data. However, the 
UK Government has stated an intent to reform data protection law in the future.
Cross-border Data Flows between the United Kingdom and the European Union
As a non-EU member state, the United Kingdom falls outside the free-data flow area between EU member states. 
The UK Information Commissioner (as regulator instead of NDPAs) has recognized data transfers from the United 
Kingdom into the European Union as lawful, on the grounds that the EU GDPR offers “adequate and equivalent protection” for 
personal data. On June 28, 2021, the European Commission adopted an adequacy decision for the United Kingdom, meaning 
that personal data can continue to flow freely from the EU’s Member States to the United Kingdom, and the EU will consider 
such personal data to enjoy an ‘essentially equivalent’ level of protection to that under the EU GDPR.
Australian Regulatory Environment
The Australian Privacy Principles contained in the Privacy Act of 1988 (the “Privacy Act”) regulate the collection, use, 
retention, disclosure and security of personal information. Personal information is defined as “information or an opinion about 
an identified individual, or an individual who is reasonably identifiable, whether the information or opinion is true or not or is 
recorded in a material form or not”. Personal information includes location-based information where the information enables 
the location of an individual to be ascertained. Australian privacy laws in general prohibit the transfer of personal information 
outside Australia unless an exemption applies, such as the individual to whom the information relates has consented to the 
transfer. In some circumstances, the disclosure will be permissible if there is a data transfer agreement in place between the 
transferor and the transferee under which the transferee agrees to handle the information in accordance with the Australian 
Privacy Principles. Subject to a few exemptions, the Australian Privacy Principles require the transferor to take such steps as are 
reasonable in the circumstances to ensure that an overseas recipient does not breach the Australian Privacy Principles and the 
transferor may be held responsible for any breaches of Australian privacy laws when personal information is transferred outside 
Australia, regardless of whether there is a data transfer agreement in place.
The Notifiable Data Breach (“NDB”) scheme requires companies to notify individuals whose personal information is 
involved in a data breach that is likely to result in serious harm and includes recommendations about steps individuals should 
take in response to the breach.
History and development of the Company
 
MiX Telematics Limited is a public company incorporated in the Republic of South Africa. Our principal executive 
office is located at 750 Park of Commerce Blvd., Suite 100, Boca Raton, Florida 33487. Our telephone number is 
+1-877-585-1088, and our web address is www.mixtelematics.com. We are regarded as being primary listed on the JSE and 
categorized as a domestic filer with regard to our ADSs on the NYSE.
We were founded in 1996 in Johannesburg, South Africa as Matrix Vehicle Tracking Proprietary Limited, and since 
that time, we have grown both organically and through acquisitions. Matrix Vehicle Tracking Proprietary Limited was renamed 
TeliMatrix Proprietary Limited in 2001, TeliMatrix Limited in 2007 and finally MiX Telematics Limited in 2008, subsequent to 
our listing on the JSE.
17

In 2007, we acquired Control Instruments OmniBridge Proprietary Limited and certain affiliated entities (collectively, 
“OmniBridge”), which provided fleet management services in both the South African and international markets. In November 
2007, we listed our shares on the JSE, in order to facilitate the OmniBridge acquisition. In 2008, we acquired Tripmaster 
Corporation, located in the United States, Safe Drive (including Safe Drive International Proprietary Limited), located in 
Australia and Safe Drive FZE, located in the United Arab Emirates. These acquisitions extended our geographic reach, 
broadened our customer relationships and expanded our driver safety and training solution offerings. In May 2012, we acquired 
Intellichain, located in South Africa, as part of our strategy to broaden our transportation management software functionality. 
On August 9, 2013, following a successful United States IPO, the Company’s ADSs were listed on the NYSE and are traded 
under the symbol MIXT. In December 2013, we acquired a proprietary software development business from Roitech 
Proprietary Limited, located in South Africa. The acquisition enhanced and broadened our fleet management smart phone 
application offerings. On November 1, 2014, we acquired the operating business of Compass Fleet Management (“Compass”), 
a South Africa based provider of specialized fleet management solutions in Southern Africa, that are delivered using the 
Company’s hardware and software platforms. These specialized fleet management solutions complement the Company’s 
existing fleet management solutions, and the acquisition broadens the array of services offered to current and future fleet 
management customers.
We currently have offices in South Africa, the United Kingdom, the United States, Uganda, Brazil, Australia, Romania 
and the United Arab Emirates as well as a network of more than 130 fleet value-added resellers worldwide.
Our agent for service of process in the United States is MiX Telematics North America, Inc., 750 Park of Commerce 
Blvd., Suite 100, Boca Raton, Florida 33487.
For further information on our principal investments and capital expenditures, see “Item 7. Liquidity and Capital 
Resources.”
Availability of information
Our Annual Report on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K, proxy statements 
and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as 
amended, or the Exchange Act, are available, free of charge, on our investor relations website as soon as reasonably practicable 
after we file such material electronically with or furnish it to the Securities and Exchange Commission, or the SEC. 
Additionally, our website, located at www.mixtelematics.com, also provides notifications of news or announcements regarding 
our financial performance, including press releases, public conference calls and webcasts.
Information contained on our website is not incorporated by reference into this Annual Report on Form 10-K or our 
other filings with the SEC. The SEC also maintains a website that contains our SEC filings. The address of the site is 
www.sec.gov.
Investors and others should note that we announce material financial information to our investors using our investor 
relations website, SEC filings, press releases, public conference calls and webcasts. We use these channels as well as social 
media to communicate with the public about our company, our products and services and other matters. It is possible that the 
information we post on social media could be deemed to be material information. Therefore, we encourage investors, the media 
and others interested in our company to review the information we post on the social media channels listed on our investor 
relations website.
18

ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS
Important factors that could cause actual financial, business or operating results to differ materially from 
expectations are disclosed in this annual report, including without limitation, the following risk factors. In addition to the 
risks listed below, we may be subject to other material risks that, as of the date of this report, are not currently known to 
us or that we deem immaterial at this time.
SUMMARY OF RISK FACTORS
Our business is subject to a number of risks, including risks that may prevent us from achieving our business 
objectives or may adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations, cash flow, and future prospects. 
The following is a summary of the principal risks that should be considered before investing in our securities. The list 
below is not exhaustive, and investors should read this “Risk Factors” section in full. These and other risk are described in 
more detail in this Item 1A. Risk Factors. 
Risks related to Our Business
•
We may be unable to maintain our relationships with our existing customers, which could result in a loss of 
subscription revenue.
•
The extent to which the coronavirus (“COVID-19”) outbreak and measures taken in response thereto impact our 
business, results of operations and financial condition will depend on future developments, which are highly 
uncertain and are difficult to predict.
•
Any inability to adapt to rapid technological change in our industry could impair our ability to remain 
competitive and result in a decline in market acceptance of our products.
•
Inaccurate output from Artificial Intelligence (AI) could result in brand and reputation damage. 
•
Industry consolidation may result in increased competition, which could result in a loss of customers and/or a 
reduction in revenue.
•
The loss of one or more of our key personnel, or our failure to attract, train and retain other highly qualified 
personnel, could prevent us from executing our growth plan.
•
We may expand by acquiring or investing in other companies, which may divert our management’s attention, 
result in dilution to our shareholders and consume resources that are necessary to sustain our business.
•
We may not be able to increase sales of our solutions, which could materially and adversely affect our ability to 
grow our business and increase revenue.
•
We depend on certain key suppliers and vendors to manufacture our hardware, and an interruption in the supply 
of our hardware could impair our production capacity, which would impact our ability to supply hardware to 
customers.
•
We depend on our network of dealers and distributors to sell our solutions and adverse changes in our 
relationships with significant dealers and distributors could cause a decline in sales.
•
We depend on our cellular network providers for the transmission of data from installed in-vehicle devices to our 
data centers and we would incur significant costs if the services of these network providers became unavailable 
to us.
•
Our business and our customers may be materially and adversely affected by global economic and market 
conditions. 
•
Failure of businesses to adopt fleet management solutions could reduce the demand for our solutions.
•
Changes in practices of insurance companies in the markets in which we provide our solutions could materially 
and adversely affect demand for products and services.
•
Security or privacy breaches in our electronic transactions, data and asset tracking sensors may expose us to 
additional liability or result in a loss of customers, either of which events could harm our business.
•
We are subject to U.S. and other anti-corruption laws, trade controls, economic sanctions and similar laws and 
regulations, including those in the jurisdictions where we operate. Our failure to comply with these laws and 
regulations could subject us to civil, criminal and administrative penalties and harm our reputation.
19

•
Laws and regulations relating to the Internet and data privacy in the markets in which we operate are complex 
and continuously evolving, and compliance costs are high. As these laws and regulations continue to evolve, we 
may be required to increase our compliance-related expenditures or limit the manner in which we collect 
information, the types of information that we collect, or the solutions that we offer, which may impede our ability 
to provide our solutions or may reduce our profit margins in specific geographic regions.
•
Failure to correctly and efficiently implement a new Enterprise Resource Planning (“ERP”), Customer 
Relationship Management System (“CRM”) and billing system could have a material and adverse effect on our 
operations. 
•
We may be exposed to risks related to litigation and administrative proceedings that could materially and 
adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Risks related to Intellectual Property
•
We have not traditionally relied on patents to protect our intellectual property, and we rely on trade secrecy laws, 
confidentiality agreements, confidentiality procedures and contractual restrictions to establish and protect our 
intellectual property rights, which provide only limited protection and may subject us to litigation.
•
An assertion by a third party that we are infringing on its intellectual property rights could subject us to costly 
and time-consuming litigation or expensive licenses.
Risks related to South Africa
•
Fluctuations in the value of the South African Rand have had, and will continue to have, a significant impact on 
our reported revenues and results of operations, which may make it difficult to evaluate our business 
performance between reporting periods and may also adversely affect the price of our ADSs.
•
If we do not achieve applicable black economic empowerment objectives in our South African businesses, we 
risk not being able to renew certain of our existing contracts which service South African government and quasi-
governmental customers, as well as not being awarded future corporate and governmental contracts, each of 
which would result in the loss of revenue.
•
A lack of growth, high inflation or increased interest rates in the South African economy could reduce our 
anticipated revenue and increase our operating costs.
Risks related to an Investment in our Ordinary Shares and ADSs
•
We have reported a material weakness in our internal controls over financial reporting. If we fail to remediate the 
material weakness and our control environment are considered to be ineffective, it might impair our ability to 
produce accurate and timely financial statements, which could adversely affect our operating results, our ability 
to operate our business and investors’ and customers’ view of us.
•
Certain provisions of South African law may limit our ability to issue securities and access the capital markets in 
the future, which could hinder our ability to raise capital in the future.
Risks Related to Our Business
We may be unable to maintain our relationships with our existing customers, which could result in a loss of 
subscription revenue.
We provide our solutions principally on a subscription basis, typically with an initial subscription term of three to 
five years and renewal terms varying from one to five years, or, for certain customers, on a month-to-month basis. 
However, our fleet customers have no obligation to renew their subscriptions after the initial term or after any renewal 
term expires. Consumer contracts, unless the contract is a prepaid contract, will continue indefinitely unless cancelled by 
the customer based on one calendar months’ notice. We may be unable to retain existing customers and, as a result, our 
revenue would be adversely affected. Customers may choose to cancel or not to renew their subscriptions for many 
reasons, including:
•
the belief that our solutions are not required for their needs or are not cost-effective;
•
a desire to reduce discretionary spending;
•
a belief that our competitors’ solutions provide a better value;
20

•
changes in our customers’ businesses, and regulations impacting our customers’ businesses that may decrease the 
need for our fleet and mobile asset management solutions;
•
economic downturn in our customers’ industries;
•
economic downturn in the geography in which our customers operate; 
•
a reduction in discounts offered by insurers to vehicle owners who have installed our products; or
•
a belief that a return on investment cannot be demonstrated.
Our enterprise fleet management customers, whose contracts are due for renewal, may also not renew for reasons 
entirely out of their control, such as the dissolution of their businesses. Enterprise customers may also decrease the 
number of vehicles covered by subscription contracts if their fleet sizes decrease.
Our subscription contracts generally do not provide our customers with an early termination option without 
penalty. However, if customers do not honor subscriptions for the full term, our remedies may be limited to re-negotiation 
of contract terms or legal recourse through the courts, which may not be successful or cost-effective, and we may not be 
able to recoup all of our costs.
A significant loss of or failure to renew our subscription-based contracts, or significantly different contract terms 
could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
The extent to which the COVID-19 outbreak and measures taken in response thereto impact our business, results of 
operations and financial condition will depend on future developments, which are highly uncertain and are difficult 
to predict.
The global impact of the COVID-19 pandemic and measures taken to reduce the spread of the virus have had an 
adverse effect on the global macroeconomic environment and have significantly increased economic uncertainty and 
reduced economic activity. Although governments around the globe have taken steps to mitigate some of the more severe 
economic effects of the virus and the impact of the pandemic on the economic activity globally is unfolding, there can be 
no assurance that such steps will be effective or achieve their desired results in a timely and sustainable manner or at all.
The majority of our employees have returned to our offices and we have implemented protocols to promote 
social distancing and enhance sanitary measures in our offices and facilities to conform to government restrictions and 
best practices encouraged by governmental and regulatory authorities. There is no certainty that such measures will be 
sufficient to mitigate the risks posed by the virus, in which case our employees or other individuals may become sick, our 
ability to perform critical functions could be harmed, and we may be unable to respond to some of the needs of our global 
business. We continue to support remote working arrangements and our increased reliance on remote access to our 
information systems increases our exposure to potential cybersecurity breaches. We continue to monitor the design and 
effectiveness of internal controls, taking into account that employees may be working remotely. We continue to monitor 
the situation and will take further actions as government authorities require or recommend or as we determine to be in the 
best interests of our employees, customers, suppliers and other business counterparties.
The COVID-19 pandemic has disrupted and may continue to disrupt the our operations and the operations of our 
customers for an indefinite period of time. COVID-19 has resulted in, and may continue to result in, significant economic 
volatility and uncertainty in U.S. and international financial markets, which could adversely affect our access to capital 
markets and investment activity, negatively impacting the availability of capital, the terms and conditions of financing 
arrangements and the related costs of such financing. This could result in situations where financing may not be available 
to us at all, or at terms formerly available to us.
The nature and extent of the crisis, multiple variants and waves of the virus, the public health measures to contain 
it, the progress and effectiveness of vaccination programs, different levels of restrictions and the resultant economic 
impact may differ between regions and remain uncertain. We continue to monitor the effects of the pandemic on our 
business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity as well as on our risk factors and the effectiveness of the 
control environment.
21

Any inability to adapt to rapid technological change in our industry could impair our ability to remain competitive 
and result in a decline in market acceptance of our products.
The industry in which we compete is characterized by rapid technological change, frequent introductions of new 
products and evolving industry standards. In addition to the mobile asset management industry, we are subject to changes 
in the automotive, mobile handset, Global Positioning System (“GPS”) navigation device, information technology, 
telecommunications and enterprise software industries. As the technology used in each of these industries evolves, we will 
face new integration and competition challenges. For example, as truck and automobile manufacturers continue to develop 
in-vehicle technology, GPS-based tracking solutions may become standard equipment and result in new sources of 
competition. If we are unable to adapt to rapid technological change, it could impair our ability to remain competitive and 
result in a decline in market acceptance of our products.
The development of new or improved products, systems or technologies that compete with our products may 
render our products less competitive and we may not be able to enhance our technology in a timely manner. In addition to 
the competition resulting from new products, systems or technologies, our future product enhancements may not 
adequately meet the requirements of the developing marketplace, and may not achieve the broad market acceptance 
necessary to generate significant revenues.
The development of new and improved products can be costly and time-consuming and is associated with 
inherent risks and uncertainties such as market acceptance, pricing, value proposition and continuous changes and 
developments in laws and regulations. If we are unable to successfully develop and timely introduce new and enhanced 
products which are accepted by the market it could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and 
financial condition.
Inaccurate output from Artificial Intelligence (AI) could result in brand and reputation damage. 
AI is being integrated into a number of our solutions and/or products and is likely to be a significant force in  
future service offerings. While AI can present significant benefits, it also presents risks and challenges to our business. 
Data sourcing, technology, integration and process issues, program bias into decision-making algorithms, security 
challenges and the protection of personal privacy could impair the adoption and acceptance of AI solutions. If the output 
from AI solutions are deemed to be inaccurate or questionable, our brand and reputation may be harmed and we may 
potentially be subject to legal liability claims. 
Industry consolidation may result in increased competition, which could result in a loss of customers and/or a 
reduction in revenue.
Some of our competitors have made, or may make, acquisitions or enter into partnerships or other strategic 
relationships to offer more comprehensive services or achieve greater economies of scale. In addition, new entrants not 
currently considered competitors may enter our market through acquisitions, partnerships or strategic relationships. We 
expect these trends to continue as companies attempt to strengthen or maintain their market positions. Many potential 
entrants may have competitive advantages over us, such as greater name recognition, longer operating histories, more 
varied services and larger marketing budgets, as well as greater financial, technical and other resources. Industry 
consolidation may result in competitors with more compelling service offerings or greater pricing flexibility than we have, 
or business practices that make it more difficult for us to compete effectively, including on the basis of price, sales and 
marketing programs, technology or service functionality. These pressures could result in a loss of subscribers and/or a 
reduction in revenue.
The loss of one or more of our key personnel, or our failure to attract, train and retain other highly qualified 
personnel, could prevent us from executing our growth plan.
We depend on the continued service and performance of our key personnel. The loss of one or more key 
members of our senior management team could materially and adversely affect our operations. In addition, the loss of 
other key sales, product development or technology personnel could disrupt our operations and have a materially adverse 
effect on our ability to grow our business.
Recruiting and retaining skilled staff in the technology industry is highly competitive. We may experience 
difficulty in hiring and retaining highly skilled employees with appropriate qualifications. Our failure to attract and train 
new personnel, or our failure to retain, focus and motivate our current personnel, could materially and adversely affect our 
business, results of operations and financial condition.
22

We may expand by acquiring or investing in other companies, which may divert our management’s attention, result in 
dilution to our shareholders and consume resources that are necessary to sustain our business.
We may acquire complementary products, services, technologies or businesses. We also may enter into 
relationships with other businesses to expand our portfolio of solutions or to expand our ability to provide our solutions in 
foreign jurisdictions. Negotiating these transactions can be time-consuming, difficult and expensive, and our ability to 
complete these transactions may be subject to conditions or approvals that are beyond our control, including anti-takeover 
and antitrust laws in various jurisdictions. We may seek to acquire other companies or businesses using our shares as 
consideration. Under the South African Companies Act, No. 71 of 2008, as amended (the “Companies Act”), we are 
prohibited from issuing shares representing 30% or more of our outstanding equity in connection with an acquisition 
without shareholder approval by way of special resolution. In terms of Johannesburg Stock Exchange (“JSE”) Listings 
Requirements, an acquisition or disposal constituting 30% or more of our market capitalization, will require shareholder 
approval. In addition, we are subject to New York Stock Exchange Listing Rules which, subject to limited exceptions, 
require shareholder approval of a transaction involving the sale, issuance, or potential issuance by a company of common 
stock (or securities convertible into or exercisable for common stock) equal to 20% or more of the common stock, or 20% 
or more of the voting power outstanding before the issuance, and in certain other circumstances. Consequently, these 
transactions, even if undertaken and announced, may not close.
An acquisition, investment or new business relationship may result in unforeseen operating difficulties and 
expenditures. In particular, we may encounter difficulties assimilating or integrating the businesses, technologies, 
products, personnel or operations of acquired companies, particularly if the key personnel of the acquired company 
choose not to work for us, the acquired company’s technology is not easily compatible with ours or we have difficulty 
retaining the customers of any acquired business due to changes in management or otherwise. Acquisitions may also 
disrupt our business, divert our resources and require significant management attention that would otherwise be available 
for the development of our business. Moreover, the anticipated benefits of any acquisition, investment or business 
relationship may not be realized or any such acquisition, investment or business relationship may expose us to unknown 
liabilities, including litigation against the companies we may acquire, invest in or otherwise consummate a business 
relationship with. For one or more of those transactions, we may:
•
issue additional equity securities that would dilute our shareholders;
•
use cash that we may need in the future to operate our business;
•
incur debt on terms unfavorable to us or that we are unable to repay or that may place burdensome restrictions on 
our operations;
•
incur large charges or substantial liabilities; or
•
become subject to adverse tax consequences, or substantial depreciation or amortization, deferred compensation 
or other acquisition-related accounting charges.
Any of these risks could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial 
condition.
We may not be able to increase sales of our solutions, which could materially and adversely affect our ability to grow 
our business and increase revenue.
We intend to increase sales of our solutions by increasing penetration in our existing markets and by entering 
new markets that represent a large potential source of demand for these solutions. Our success in increasing sales may be 
tied to a wide variety of factors, including demand for our services, price and service competition, customer experience, 
our relationships with third party distributors and dealers, supply chain disruptions, the rate of new vehicle sales, the oil 
price, global economic conditions and, in the case of our safety and security solutions, the perceived threat of vehicle theft 
and discounts offered by insurers.
Some car and truck manufacturers have begun installing factory fitted substitute products and services, such as 
certain GPS-based products, in new vehicles prior to their initial sale, which may preclude us from increasing sales to 
subscribers purchasing such vehicles. Our inability to market and sell our solutions to new customers, at or prior to the 
initial sale by the manufacturer, could materially and adversely affect our ability to grow our business and increase 
revenue.
23

In the Middle East and Australasia segment and the Americas segment, we generate significant revenues from 
the oil and gas sector, and we may not be able to diversify and/or successfully enter into new verticals, which could 
materially and adversely affect our ability to grow our business and increase revenue.
We depend on certain key suppliers and vendors to manufacture our hardware, and an interruption in the supply of 
components or of our hardware could impair our production capacity, which would impact our ability to supply 
hardware to customers.
We currently purchase key Global System for Mobile Communications (“GSM”) module components of our 
hardware from two key suppliers. These modules and other electronic components used in the manufacture of our 
products, have extended lead times on orders. An interruption in the supply of components from these suppliers or a 
failure to identify the need to re-order components in a timely manner would significantly impact our operations and 
require us to identify and integrate our manufacturing and supply logistics with an alternate supplier, or use a substitute 
component, which could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
The components we use to manufacture hardware are predominately supplied by manufacturers and suppliers in 
China. The COVID-19 pandemic, amongst other contributing factors, has adversely affected manufacturing capacity of 
electronic components. The component supply shortage and extended lead times may impact our business in terms of 
increased pricing and additional engineering projects to implement alternative components, however, we have so far been 
able to supply our customer demand and maintain commitments to customers. Where possible, we have also taken steps to 
mitigate our risk to some extent by buying additional safety stock of scarce items or items with extended lead times and 
continue to carefully monitor the situation.
We contract two vendors in South Africa to manufacture and assemble hardware. Each of these contracts is 
terminable on 12 months’ written notice. We have no financial control over, and limited operational influence on these 
vendors and the conduct of their businesses. These vendors could negatively impact our business by, among other things, 
extending delivery times, raising prices and limiting supply due to their own shortages and business requirements. Our 
two contract manufacturers produce different products for us and if the facilities at one of these contract manufacturers 
suffer a mass casualty event, it could take as much as three to five months, or longer, to replace production capacity. An 
extended interruption in the supply of hardware from our contract manufacturers could materially and adversely affect our 
production capacity and hence our ability to fulfil sales orders which could have a material adverse effect on our 
operations. We do not expect a hardware supply interruption would have a significant impact on our subscription revenue 
other than an inability to replace hardware as part of our maintenance programs, however, a hardware interruption will 
have a direct impact on new business growth in terms of hardware sales and the contracting of new subscribers.
We depend on our network of dealers and distributors to sell our solutions and adverse changes in our relationships 
with significant dealers and distributors could cause a decline in sales.
We currently distribute our products to small fleet operators and consumers both directly and through various 
distribution channels, including automobile dealers, aftermarket automotive parts and service suppliers, and automobile 
insurers and retailers, which we collectively refer to as “distributors”.
We currently distribute our products to enterprise fleet customers, including large enterprise fleets and small fleet 
operators, both directly and through third parties, who are assigned specific geographic territories in which they can sell, 
which we refer to as “dealers”.
We are dependent on our dealers and distributors, who account for a substantial percentage of our total sales, and 
sales generated by certain dealers and distributors individually represent a meaningful percentage of our revenue. The 
terms of our agreements with our dealers do not usually include minimum purchase obligations, are specific to a 
geographic territory and are primarily non-exclusive. It is possible that our dealers and/or distributors also have 
relationships with our competitors and we have limited, if any, controls over their business activities. 
Our dealer agreements generally have a fixed initial term, after which they may be renewed or continue 
indefinitely if not terminated. This is subject to the right of either party to terminate on specified notice, generally ranging 
from 90 days to one year, or for breach. Similarly, our distributor agreements do not generally include minimum purchase 
obligations and consist principally of a commission agreement applicable to sales generated by the distributor. If our 
relationships with our dealers and distributors deteriorate, or if a dealer or distributor, or group of related dealers and 
distributors, accounting for a material portion of our sales elects not to do business with us in the future, our sales could 
decline materially, which could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition. 
24

We depend on our cellular network providers for the transmission of data from installed in-vehicle devices to our data 
centers and we would incur significant costs if the services of these network providers became unavailable to us.
We contract with cellular network providers in each of our markets to provide cellular network services. These 
cellular networks transmit data from our customers’ in-vehicle devices to our data centers, where it is managed for the 
benefit of our customers. Certain of our installed in-vehicle devices contain a SIM card that is compatible with a specific 
cellular network provider. If a cellular network provider in one of our markets were to experience extended service 
outages or refuse to continue contracting with us for any reason or were to go out of business it may adversely affect the 
ability to collect data from our in-vehicle devices. We could incur significant costs related to the replacement of SIM 
cards for our customers and could suffer damage to our reputation and customer relationships. Any of the foregoing could 
materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
The markets in which we participate are highly fragmented and competitive, with relatively low barriers to entry, and 
increased competition could result in reduced operating margins, increased sales and marketing expenses, and the 
loss of market share.
The market for our solutions is highly fragmented, consisting of a significant number of vendors, with relatively 
low barriers to entry. Competition in our market is based primarily on:
•
functionality and reliability;
•
total cost of ownership;
•
breadth and depth of application functionality for fleet deployments;
•
product performance;
•
interoperability;
•
brand and reputation;
•
customer service;
•
distribution channels, including a global footprint and ability to service multinationals;
•
regional geographic expertise, including localized language support, support for applicable government 
regulations and the ability to comply with local Internet and data privacy regulations;
•
size of customer base and reference accounts within key industry segments;
•
ability to deliver ongoing value and return on investment;
•
ease of deployment and use;
•
relevant industry domain expertise and functionality; and
•
the financial resources of the vendor.
We compete with a number of companies in each of the geographic markets in which we operate. Such 
competition could result in reduced operating margins, increased sales and marketing expenses and the loss of market 
share, any of which would harm our operating results. We expect competition to intensify in the future with the 
introduction of new technologies, the use of mobile devices and new market entrants from outside the telematics industry, 
such as enterprise software vendors. 
The market for safety and security solutions is highly competitive. We compete in the safety and security 
solutions market primarily on the basis of the technological innovation, value-added services offered, brand recognition, 
rate of successful recoveries of mobile assets, and quality and price of our products and services. Our most competitive 
market is the vehicle and mobile asset tracking and recovery solutions market, due to the existence of a wide variety of 
competing products and services, and alternative technologies that offer various levels of protection and tracking 
capabilities. Some of these competing products and services, such as certain GPS-based products, are installed in new cars 
by vehicle manufacturers prior to their initial sale, which may make it more difficult to compete for such subscribers. 
Furthermore, providers of competing services or products may extend their offerings to the locations in which we operate, 
or new competitors may enter the safety and security solutions market.
25

Our business and our customers may be materially and adversely affected by global economic and market conditions. 
We are generating revenue through subscription and hardware sales across various industries, all exposed to  
general market and economic conditions. Global market and economic conditions have been, and continue to be, disrupted 
and unstable. Factors that could affect us and our customers include increased global inflation, investor and consumer 
confidence, fluctuations in economic growth, availability of capital in capital and equity markets, liquidity of global 
financial markets, interest rates, stability of governments in countries we operate and the strength of these economies and 
unemployment rates.
Adverse global economic conditions could result in a contraction of existing customers, a reduction in sales 
revenue, extended cash collection periods from our customers due their deteriorating financial conditions and increased 
impairments. This could also result in reduced new opportunities due to delayed or cancelled capital investment impacting 
current or anticipated customer engagement. 
We could be exposed to product liability claims, which could result in significant damage to our reputation and 
material economic loss.
Our products, and the batteries that many of them contain, could malfunction and cause damage to our 
customers’ property. In particular, the rechargeable batteries in our in-vehicle devices may be prone to leakage due to 
environmental factors, such as extreme weather conditions or overuse. Leaks in these batteries could damage our 
customers’ in-vehicle devices and vehicles. Our safety and security solutions may be disabled or prove to be ineffective as 
a result of techniques employed by car thieves, or the discovery of technological weaknesses by such persons. If there 
were a systematic failure of any of our products, we could suffer significant damage to our reputation, and any insurance 
we maintain might not be sufficient to prevent us from suffering a material economic loss. 
Failure of businesses to adopt fleet management solutions could reduce the demand for our solutions. 
We derive, and expect to continue to derive, substantial revenue from the sale of subscriptions for fleet 
management solutions to commercial customers. Widespread acceptance and use of fleet management solutions is critical 
to our future revenue growth and success. If the market for fleet management solutions fails to grow, or grows more 
slowly than we currently anticipate, demand for our solutions would be negatively affected.
The market for fleet management solutions is subject to changing customer demand and trends in preferences. 
Some of the potential factors that could affect interest in and demand for fleet management solutions include:
•
the effectiveness and reliability of solutions;
•
fluctuations in fuel and vehicle maintenance costs, which are significant drivers of customer demand for fleet 
management solutions;
•
assumptions regarding general mobile workforce inefficiency and the extent to which efficiency can be improved 
through fleet management solutions;
•
the level of governmental and regulatory burden on the fields of transportation and occupational health and 
safety;
•
the price, performance, features and availability of products and services that compete with ours;
•
our ability to maintain high levels of customer satisfaction; and
•
the rate of acceptance of web-based solutions generally.
Failure of businesses to adopt fleet management solutions could materially and adversely affect our business, 
results of operations and financial condition.
26

A decline in vehicle sales and/or an increase in the sales of factory-fitted GPS solutions in new vehicles in our markets 
could result in reduced demand for our solutions, which could materially and adversely affect our revenue.
A reduction in sales of new vehicles and/or an increase in factory-fitted GPS solutions in new vehicles could 
reduce our addressable market for solutions. New vehicle sales may decline for various reasons, including adverse 
changes in the general economic environment, a reduction in our customers’ discretionary spending, or an increase in new 
vehicle tariffs, taxes or gas prices. A decline in vehicle production levels or labor disputes affecting the automobile 
industry in the markets where we operate, may also impact the volume of new vehicle sales. A decline in sales of new 
vehicles in the markets in which we provide our solutions would result in reduced demand for such products and services, 
which could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Demand for our fleet management solutions decreases when prices for crude oil and natural gas decrease, which could 
materially and adversely affect our revenue.
Demand for our fleet management solutions can fluctuate with the prices for crude oil and natural gas, which 
impact the attractiveness of our services and also directly affects our customers in the oil and gas industry, from whom we 
derive a significant portion of our revenues. Subscription revenues from oil and gas customers in fiscal year 2022 
represented 19.2% of our total subscription revenue. Generally, lower oil and gas prices reduce the return on investment 
for many of our customers. Gains in fuel efficiency may lead to a relative decrease in the return on investment of our 
solutions perceived by our customers. The oil and gas industry is complex, and numerous geopolitical, economic, 
environmental and other factors affect pricing. Expectations for future crude oil and natural gas prices may affect our 
customers’ spending habits. Prolonged or substantial declines in crude oil and/or natural gas prices, or the perception that 
such prices will remain low, could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial 
condition.
Changes in practices of insurance companies in the markets in which we provide our solutions could materially and 
adversely affect demand for products and services.
We depend in part on the practices of insurance companies in some of our markets to support demand for certain 
of our products and services. For example, in South Africa, which is currently the largest market for our products and 
services, insurance companies either mandate the installation of tracking devices as a prerequisite for providing insurance 
coverage to owners of certain vehicles, or provide discounts on insurance premiums to encourage vehicle owners to 
subscribe to vehicle tracking and mobile asset recovery solutions such as ours. We benefit from insurance companies’ 
continued practice in the South African and certain other markets:
•
accepting mobile asset location technologies such as ours as a preferred security product;
•
providing premium discounts for using location and recovery products and services such as ours; and
•
mandating the use of our products and services, or similar products and services, for certain vehicles.
If any of these policies or practices change, revenues from the sale of our products and services could decline, 
which would materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
We face many risks associated with our existing and potential new international operations, which could prevent us 
from successfully expanding into new geographic markets, or operating successfully in existing geographic markets.
We are a global company with substantial assets located in a number of countries. We provide our services in 
more than 120 countries with 16 offices in 9 countries. In some international markets, customer preferences and buying 
behavior may be different, and we may use business or pricing models that are different from our traditional subscription 
model to provide fleet management solutions to customers in those markets, or we may be unsuccessful in implementing 
the appropriate business model. Our revenue from new foreign markets may not exceed the costs of establishing, 
marketing, and maintaining our international offerings.
In addition, expanding international operations into new territories may subject us to risks with which we have 
limited experience. These risks include:
•
lack of familiarity with local markets, including legal and regulatory requirements;
•
difficulties in finding and maintaining, or potentially replacing, local dealers and distributors;
•
competing with established local competitors;
27

•
laws favoring local competitors;
•
the cost and burden of monitoring and complying with legal and regulatory requirements in new territories, and/
or changes to existing legal and regulatory requirements, including those relating to the Internet and data privacy 
and security;
•
fluctuations in currency exchange rates or restrictions on currency exchange;
•
availability of US Dollars in countries highly dependent on resource exports;
•
potentially adverse tax consequences, including the complexities of transfer pricing, value added or other tax 
systems, double taxation, tariffs and restrictions and/or taxes on the repatriation of earnings;
•
dependence on third parties, including some commercial partners with whom we may not have extensive 
experience;
•
increased financial accounting and reporting burdens and complexities;
•
increased travel, real estate, infrastructure, insurance, legal and compliance costs associated with international 
operations;
•
political, social, and economic instability, terrorist attacks, and security concerns in general;
•
reduced or varied protection for intellectual property rights in some countries;
•
increased exposure and vulnerability to claims that we have infringed on the intellectual property of third parties;
•
exposure to liabilities under anti-corruption and anti-money laundering laws and regulations; and 
•
complexities of complying with U.S and non-U.S. export controls laws and regulations, including Export 
Administration Regulations (“EAR”).
Operating in international markets requires significant management attention and financial resources. The 
investment and additional resources required to establish operations and manage growth in additional territories may not 
produce desired levels of revenue or profitability.
Our business and results of operations may be negatively impacted by the United Kingdom’s withdrawal from the 
European Union.
Exposure to United Kingdom political developments, including the impact of the United Kingdom exiting from 
the European Union (also known as “Brexit”), could have a material adverse effect on our operations, specifically in 
Europe. The United Kingdom’s withdrawal from the European Union on January 31, 2020 created an uncertain political 
and economic environment in the United Kingdom and potentially across other EU member states for the foreseeable 
future, including while the United Kingdom reviews and reforms regulations derived from its prior membership in the 
European Union. 
The results of our operations may be affected in a number of ways, including increasing currency exchange risk, 
generating instability in the global financial markets or negatively impacting the economies of the United Kingdom and 
Europe. The cost of servicing Europe from the United Kingdom may no longer be a viable option, and we may need to 
consider alternative options. The costs of having a UK-headquartered business may increase as a result of the potential 
weakening of the British Pound. Changes to existing trade agreements between Europe and the United Kingdom could 
lead to increased customs duties, tariffs and withholding taxes for the sale of our hardware and services from the United 
Kingdom into Europe, and may result in us being less profitable.
Security or privacy breaches in our electronic transactions, data and asset tracking sensors may expose us to additional 
liability or result in a loss of customers, either of which events could harm our business. 
Any inability on our part to protect the information security of our networks, data processing systems, software 
products and platforms could have a material adverse effect on our reputation and profitability by exposing us to 
additional liability, increasing our expenses relating to resolution of these breaches and deterring users from using our 
products and services. Our systems and operations are vulnerable to damage or interruption from human error, a breach in 
cybersecurity, computer viruses, ransomware, other malware, distributed denial of service attacks, spurious spam attacks, 
intentional acts of vandalism and similar events. We cannot assure you that our current security methods and measures 
will effectively counter evolving security risks, prevent future slowdowns or disruptions, protect against extraordinary 
28

attacks while addressing the security and privacy requirements of existing and future users. Any breaches, system failures, 
slowdowns or disruptions as a result of malicious insiders or third-party action, including malevolent conduct by hackers, 
phishing and other means of social engineering could likely result in the loss, corruption or unavailability of data or 
unanticipated disruptions in service to our users, decreased levels of user satisfaction and significant negative effects on 
our reputation, which could materially and adversely affect our business.
We utilize third-party encryption and authentication technology providers to secure and review transmission of 
confidential information over the Internet, including private customer data such as bank account numbers and asset 
tracking data. Advances in technological capabilities, new discoveries in the field of cryptography, and a continually 
changing landscape of cybersecurity threats as well as other events or developments, could result in a compromise or 
breach of the technology we use to protect sensitive transaction data, including the technology provided by third-parties. If 
any such compromise of our data security, or the data security of our customers, were to occur, it could result in 
misappropriation of proprietary information or interruptions in operations, and have an adverse impact on our reputation 
or the reputation of our customers. If we are unable to detect and prevent unauthorized access to or use of confidential 
information including bank account numbers and asset tracking data, our business, results of operations and financial 
condition could be materially and adversely affected. Any such interruption or breach of our systems could also result in 
legal and reputational damage to our business, including legal claims and proceedings, liability under laws that protect the 
privacy of personal information, government enforcement actions and regulatory penalties, as well as remediation costs. 
We maintain cyber liability insurance; however, this insurance may not be sufficient to cover legal, reputational and 
financial losses that may occur as a result of an interruption or a breach of our systems.
Our operating results may be harmed if we are required to collect sales, use, services or other related taxes for our 
solutions in jurisdictions where we have not historically done so, or if there are significant changes in the effective tax 
rates exposing us to greater than anticipated tax liabilities.
We do not believe that we are ordinarily required to collect sales, use, services or other similar taxes from our 
customers in certain jurisdictions. However, one or more countries or states may seek to impose sales, use, services, or 
other tax collection obligations on us, including for past sales. For example, the European Commission introduced 
proposals addressing taxation of digital business operating within the European Union, but has not yet reached an 
agreement on a sales tax with a scope limited to digital advertising services. As a result, certain countries, including the 
United Kingdom, Italy and France moved to introduce their own digital service tax. A successful assertion by one or more 
jurisdictions that we should collect sales or other taxes on the sale of our solutions, could result in substantial tax 
liabilities, including interest and penalty charges for past sales and decrease our ability to compete for future sales. We 
review applicable rules and regulations periodically and, when we believe sales and use taxes apply in a particular 
jurisdiction, we voluntarily engage tax authorities in order to determine how to comply with their rules and regulations. 
We cannot assure you that we will not be subject to sales and use taxes or related penalties for past sales in jurisdictions 
where we presently believe sales and use taxes are not due. Furthermore, we cannot be certain that we have recorded 
sufficient provisions on our consolidated financial statements to cover taxes.
Although our client contracts ordinarily provide that our clients must pay all applicable sales and similar taxes, 
they may be reluctant to pay back taxes, and may refuse responsibility for interest or penalties associated with those taxes. 
If we are unable to collect and pay back taxes and the associated interest and penalties, we will incur unplanned expenses 
that may be substantial.
Tax laws are dynamic and subject to change as new laws are passed and new interpretations of the laws are 
published. Changes in tax legislation could increase our tax obligations in countries where we do business.
Due to the nature of our business, our services are provided within multiple jurisdictions, including certain 
jurisdictions in which we may not have anticipated our services being provided or within which we may not have had 
prior dealings. Accordingly, there may be unforeseen obligations related to certain jurisdictions that were not identified, 
where the tax legislation may have been amended or not adequately provided for in our contracts. These obligations could 
materially and adversely affect our financial position.
29

An actual or perceived reduction in vehicle theft and crime rates, may adversely impact demand for certain of our 
solutions, which could result in a loss of customers and a decline in growth.
Demand for our vehicle tracking and asset recovery solutions is influenced by prevailing or expected vehicle 
theft rates. Vehicle theft rates may decline as a result of various factors, such as the availability of improved security 
systems, implementation of improved or more effective law enforcement measures, and improved economic or political 
conditions in markets that have high theft rates. If vehicle theft rates in our markets decline significantly, or if vehicle 
owners or insurance companies believe that vehicle theft rates have declined or are expected to decline, demand for some 
of our products and services may decline, which could result in a loss of customers and a decline in growth.
We are subject to U.S. and other anti-corruption laws, trade controls, economic sanctions and similar laws and 
regulations, including those in the jurisdictions where we operate. Our failure to comply with these laws and 
regulations could subject us to civil, criminal and administrative penalties and harm our reputation.
Doing business on a worldwide basis requires us to comply with the laws and regulations of various foreign 
jurisdictions. These laws and regulations place restrictions on our exports, reexports, operations, technologies, trade 
practices, partners and investment decisions. In particular, our operations are subject to U.S. and foreign anti-corruption 
and trade control laws and regulations, such as the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act (the “FCPA”), various export controls 
and economic sanctions programs, including those administered by the U.S. Treasury Department’s Office of Foreign 
Assets Control (“OFAC”), as well as Australian and European sanctions. Certain of our products, technologies and 
services are, or may be subject to the Export Administration Regulations (“EAR”). U.S. export controls, regulations and 
economic sanctions include various restrictions and license requirements, including prohibit the shipment of certain 
products, technologies, software and services to U.S. embargoed or sanctioned countries, governments and persons. 
Complying with economic sanctions, export regulation, import laws and regulations may be time-consuming and may 
results in delays or loss of sales opportunities.
In the wake of Russia’s recent aggression in Ukraine, the United States, the European Union, and the United 
Kingdom have imposed a number of new sanctions and export control restrictions on Russia. While we maintain business 
relationships with a limited number of oil and gas customers in Russia, we are closely monitoring those relationships in 
consultation with outside advisors to maintain compliance with applicable U.S. sanctions and export control and 
regulations. At this point, certain debt and equity restrictions that have been imposed on dealings with certain Russian 
entities that are not otherwise blocked parties are impacting our ability to collect payment on the provision of services in 
Russia. Additionally, some of our products, technologies and services subject to the EAR may no longer be exported to 
Russia without a license. We are also mindful that more comprehensive trade restrictions may be imposed on Russia in 
the future, and that may impact our ability to engage in any business in Russia or with Russian entities.
While we take precautions to ensure compliance, if we fail to comply with export laws, customs and import 
regulations, economic sanctions and EAR, we could be subject to substantial civil and criminal penalties, including fines 
for the company and incarceration of responsible employees and managers, and the possible loss of export privileges. If 
our dealers and distributors fail to obtain any appropriate import, export, re-export licenses or permits, we may also be 
subject to government investigations or penalties and suffer reputational harm.
We also monitor compliance in accordance with the ten principles as set out in the United Nations Global 
Compact Principles, the Organization for Economic Co-operation and Development recommendations relating to 
corruption, and the International Labor Organization Protocol in terms of certain of the items to be monitored. As a result 
of doing business in foreign countries and with foreign partners, we are exposed to a heightened risk of violating anti-
corruption and trade control laws as well as sanctions regulations.
The FCPA prohibits us from providing anything of value to foreign officials for the purposes of obtaining or 
retaining business, or securing any improper business advantage. It also requires us to keep books and records that 
accurately and fairly reflect our transactions. As part of our business, we may deal with state-owned business enterprises, 
the employees of which are considered foreign officials for purposes of the FCPA. In addition, the United Kingdom 
Bribery Act (the “Bribery Act”) which came into effect on July 1, 2011, extends beyond bribery of foreign public officials 
and also applies to transactions with individuals not employed by a government. The Bribery Act further punishes both 
the giving and receiving of bribes, whereas the FCPA only prohibits payment of a bribe. The provisions of the Bribery 
Act are also more onerous than the FCPA in a number of other respects, including jurisdiction, non-exemption of 
facilitation payments and penalties. Some of the international locations in which we operate, lack a developed legal 
system and have higher than normal levels of corruption.
30

Anti-corruption and anti-bribery laws have been enforced aggressively in recent years and are interpreted 
broadly. In many foreign countries, particularly in countries with developing economies, it may be a local custom that 
businesses engage in practices that are prohibited by the FCPA or other applicable laws and regulations. Economic 
sanctions programs restrict our business dealings with certain sanctioned countries, persons and entities. In addition, 
because we act through dealers and distributors, we face the risk that our dealers, distributors and customers might further 
distribute our products to a sanctioned person or entity, or an ultimate end-user in a sanctioned country, which might 
subject us to an investigation concerning compliance with OFAC or other sanctions regulations. Moreover, we can be held 
liable for the corrupt or other illegal activities of these third-party intermediaries, our employees, representatives, 
contractors, partners, and agents, even if we do not explicitly authorize such activities.
Violations of anti-corruption laws, trade control laws and sanctions regulations are punishable by civil penalties, 
including fines, denial of export privileges, injunctions, asset seizures, debarment from government contracts and 
revocations or restrictions of licenses, as well as criminal fines and imprisonment. 
We have developed policies and procedures as part of a company-wide compliance program that is designed to 
assist our compliance with applicable U.S. and international anti-corruption and trade control laws and regulations, 
including the FCPA, the Bribery Act and trade controls and sanctions programs administered by OFAC, and provide 
regular training to our employees to comply with these laws and regulations. However, there can be no assurance that all 
of our employees, consultants, partners, agents or other associated persons will not take actions in violation of our policies 
and these laws and regulations, or that our policies and procedures will effectively prevent us from violating these 
regulations in every transaction in which we may engage, or provide a defense to any alleged violation.
 In particular, we may be held liable for the actions that our local, strategic or joint venture partners take inside or 
outside of the United States, even though our partners may not be subject to these laws. Such a violation, even if our 
policies prohibit it, could materially and adversely affect our reputation, business, results of operations and financial 
condition. Any violation of the FCPA, other applicable anti-corruption laws, or anti-money laundering laws could result in 
whistleblower complaints, adverse media coverage, investigations, severe criminal or civil sanctions and suspension or 
debarment from government contracts, which could have an adverse effect on our reputation, business, financial 
condition, results of operations, and prospects. In addition, responding to any enforcement action may result in a 
significant diversion of management’s attention and resources and significant defense costs and other professional fees. 
Our continued international expansion, including in developing countries, and our development of new partnerships and 
joint venture relationships worldwide, could increase the risk of FCPA, OFAC or Bribery Act violations in the future.
Operating in emerging markets subjects us to greater risks than those we would face if we only operated in 
more developed markets, which could increase our operating costs and inhibit our growth plan.
Emerging markets, including Africa, Eastern Europe, Mexico, the Middle East, Asia and South America, are 
subject to greater risks than more developed markets. The Middle East region is experiencing ongoing instability, which 
has affected and may continue to affect our growth in the region. The Brazilian market continues to experience political 
and economic issues such as high unemployment rates, high inflation rates and corruption allegations, which affect our 
growth in the region and our ability to introduce new services to the region. South Africa is experiencing political and 
economic issues, as well as high unemployment rates, which could affect our ability to maintain our existing customer 
base as well as our ability to grow our existing customer base. The political, economic and market conditions in many 
emerging markets present risks that could make it more difficult to operate our business successfully. These risks include:
•
political and economic instability, including higher rates of inflation and currency fluctuations;
•
higher levels of corruption, including bribery of public officials;
•
loss due to civil strife, acts of war or terrorism, guerrilla activities and insurrection;
•
a lack of well-developed legal systems which could make it difficult for us to enforce our intellectual property 
and contractual rights;
•
logistical and communications challenges;
•
potential adverse changes in laws and regulatory practices, including import and export license requirements and 
restrictions, tariffs, legal structures and tax laws;
•
difficulties in staffing and managing operations and ensuring the safety of our employees;
•
restrictions on the right to convert or repatriate currency or export assets;
31

•
greater risk of uncollectible accounts and longer collection cycles; and
•
introduction or changes to indigenization and empowerment programs.
Laws and regulations relating to the Internet and data privacy in the markets in which we operate are complex and 
continuously evolving, and compliance costs are high. As these laws and regulations continue to evolve, we may be 
required to increase our compliance-related expenditures or limit the manner in which we collect information, the 
types of information that we collect, or the solutions that we offer, which may impede our ability to provide our 
solutions or may reduce our profit margins in specific geographic regions.
Various laws and regulations associated with the Internet and data privacy are complex and increase our cost of 
doing business. Furthermore, these laws and regulations expose us to fines and penalties if we fail to comply with them. 
Although we have implemented procedures designed to comply with international practices and have established 
additional group policies, charters and procedures to assist in maintaining data privacy and data security, we have not 
undertaken a formal legal review to determine our compliance with data privacy and data security laws in jurisdictions 
outside of the UK, the European Union and South Africa. 
Furthermore, our employees, contractors and agents may not always comply with the policies and procedures we 
establish regarding data privacy and data security, particularly as we expand our operations through organic growth and 
acquisitions. While our employees may violate our policies and procedures, the Company remains responsible for, and 
obligated to implement, policies and procedures and enter into contracts with service providers that require appropriate 
protection. Any violations could subject us to civil or criminal penalties, including substantial fines or prohibitions on our 
ability to offer our products in one or more countries, and could also materially damage our reputation, our brand, our 
international expansion efforts, our business, results of operations and financial condition.
The transmission of data over the Internet and cellular networks is a critical component of our software-as-a-
service (“SaaS”) business model. Additionally, as cloud computing continues to evolve, increased regulation by federal, 
state or foreign agencies becomes more likely, particularly in the areas of data privacy and data security. In addition, 
taxation of services provided over the Internet or other charges imposed by government agencies, or by private 
organizations for accessing the Internet, may be imposed. Any regulation imposing greater fees for Internet use or 
restricting information exchange over the Internet, could result in a decline in the use of the Internet and the viability of 
Internet-based services, which could harm our business.
Our solutions and products enable us to collect, manage, store, and otherwise process a wide range of data related 
to fleet management such as mobile asset location and fuel usage, speed and mileage. We obtain our data from a variety of 
sources, including our customers and third-party providers. The United States and various state governments have adopted 
or proposed limitations on the collection, distribution and use of personal data, as well as requirements that must be 
followed if a breach of such personal data occurs. The California Consumer Privacy Act (“CCPA”), effective January 1, 
2020, was the first consumer privacy law in the United States. The CCPA created new privacy rights for California 
consumers which will be expanded by the newly passed California Privacy Rights Act (“CPRA”) (collectively, 
“California privacy laws”), effective January 1, 2023. Currently, employee and B2B data are exempt from California 
privacy laws, but the exemption is set to expire on January 1, 2023. Virginia recently became the second state to enact a 
consumer privacy law, the Virginia Consumer Data Protection Act (“VCDPA”), and Colorado passed a consumer privacy 
law as well. Effective January 1, 2023, the VCDPA and Colorado Privacy Act (“CPA”) will also require businesses to 
provide privacy notices and enhanced consumer rights to their consumers. Both the VCDPA and CPA do not apply to 
employee or commercial data. Failure to comply to the CCPA or in future with the CPRA, VCDPA, and/or CPA (to the 
extent required) could result in penalties.
Companies must have reasonable policies, procedures and safeguards in place to protect personal data. The U.S. 
Federal Trade Commission (“FTC”), which is the primary enforcement authority against “unfair” or “deceptive” practices 
in the U.S., has found it to be an unfair business practice when a company does not provide adequate safeguards to protect 
consumers’ personal data, because the lack of safeguards harms consumers and consumers cannot avoid the harm.
In addition, several U.S. state laws require data owners to implement reasonable security measures to protect the 
personal data collected from residents. These laws generally require a data owner to implement reasonable security 
procedures and practices appropriate to the nature of the information, and to protect the personal data from unauthorized 
access, destruction, use, modification, or disclosure. Although most of these state laws generally require an entity to 
maintain appropriate security, at least one state (Massachusetts) has adopted comprehensive data privacy requirements to 
protect personal data. However, these regulations only apply to more sensitive data, such as driver’s license number, 
32

Social Security number, and other government identifiers, as well as financial account and credit card number. California 
was the first state to enact an Internet of Things (IoT) cybersecurity law, which took effect on January 1, 2020. If 
applicable, the IoT law requires manufacturers of any internet-connected devices to equip devices with reasonable security 
features that are: appropriate for the nature and function of the device; appropriate for the information it may collect, 
contain, or transmit; and designed to protect the device and any information contained within the device from 
unauthorized access, destruction, use, modification or disclosure. 
Some U.S. state privacy laws have also adopted data minimization principles. For instance, under the CPRA, 
collection, use, retention, and sharing of a consumer’s personal information must be “reasonably necessary and 
proportionate to achieve the purposes for which the personal information was collected or processed.” Further, personal 
data and sensitive personal data may not be retained “for longer than is reasonably necessary”.
In the European Union, the General Data Protection Regulation (“GDPR”) came into effect on May 25, 2018. 
GDPR contains robust obligations on data processors and heavy documentation requirements for data protection 
compliance by companies. Amongst other requirements, GDPR governs data collection, use, storage and disclosure of 
personal data in the European Union. GDPR requires informed consent for the use of cookies and direct electronic 
marketing and imposes conditions on obtaining valid consent. Failure to comply with GDPR could result in penalties and 
fines for noncompliance. In addition to GDPR, the EU has another draft regulation in the approval process that focuses on 
the right to privacy. The proposed regulation, known as the ePrivacy Regulation would replace the member state laws that 
implement the current European Union ePrivacy Directive. The ePrivacy Regulation will significantly increase fines for 
non-compliance.
In the United Kingdom, data protection is governed by the Data Protection Act 2018 and the UK GDPR (which 
adopts the EU GDPR and procedures as of 31 December 2020). At present, the UK and EU regimes are similar. The UK 
framework places equivalent obligations on Controllers and Processors to those set out in the EU GDPR including 
obligations on Controllers to ensure lawful grounds for processing data, adequate security measures are in place to secure 
it, and equivalent rights are available to UK citizens to protect their personal data. As a non-EU Member state, the UK 
falls outside the free-data flow area between EU Member states. The UK Information Commissioner (as regulator instead 
of National Data Protection Authorities (“NDPAs”)) has recognized data transfers from the UK into the EU as lawful, on 
the grounds that the EU GDPR offers “adequate and equivalent protection” for personal data. The EU has established a 
temporary “adequacy bridge” (set out in the UK-EU Trade and Cooperation Agreement 2020) to enable the continuation 
of data flows on an interim basis from the EU to the UK, pending a formal decision from the EU to accept the adequacy of 
the UK data protection regime post-Brexit.  This acceptance is anticipated to be approved during 2021. In the event that 
the adequacy is not approved, Standard Contractual Clauses can be implemented to manage transfers without significant 
disruption to compliance. 
The Protection of Personal Information Act, No. 4 of 2013 (the “POPI Act”) was promulgated into law in South 
Africa in November 2013 and came into full effect on July 1, 2021. Any failure to comply with the POPI Act may result 
in a fine not exceeding R10 million and/or imprisonment of up to 10 years, depending on the severity of such failure.
We continuously update and will continue to evaluate our group data protection and security policies, charters, 
and procedures to assist in maintaining data privacy and data security in line with international privacy practices.
We may also be subject to costly notification and remediation requirements if we, or a third party, determines 
that we have been the subject of a data breach involving personal data of individuals. Data breach notification regulations 
vary among the countries where we conduct business, and also vary among the states of the United States, and any such 
breach involving personal data could be subject to any number of these requirements.
As noted above, we have sought to implement internationally recognized practices regarding data privacy and 
data security. If our privacy or data security measures fail to comply, or are perceived to fail to comply, with current or 
future laws and regulations, we may be subject to litigation, regulatory investigations, fines or other liabilities. Moreover, 
if future laws and regulations limit our customers’ ability to use and share this data or our ability to store, process and 
share data with our customers over the Internet, demand for our solutions could decrease and our costs could increase. We 
might also have to limit the manner in which we collect data, the types of personal data that we collect, or the solutions we 
offer. Any of these risks would materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
33

A governmental challenge to our transfer pricing policies or practices could impose significant costs on us.
The group has intercompany transactions and consequently closely monitors the appropriateness of its transfer 
pricing policies and compliance therewith. The global transfer pricing environment, including with respect to operational 
and reporting requirements, is continuously evolving and subject to input from multiple sources and jurisdictions. These 
complexities require management to closely monitor new developments, which it does. 
Many countries routinely examine transfer pricing policies of taxpayers subject to their jurisdiction, and 
authorities challenge transfer pricing policies aggressively where there is potential non-compliance and impose 
interest and penalties where non-compliance is determined. Although the documentation of and support for our 
transfer pricing policies has not been the subject of a governmental proceeding beyond examination to date, there can be 
no assurance that a governmental authority will not challenge these policies more aggressively in the future or, if 
challenged, that we will prevail. We could suffer costs related to one or more challenges to our transfer pricing. 
Although South Africa signed the Multilateral Competent Authority Agreement on the Exchange of Country-by-
Country (“CbC”) Reports on January 27, 2016, and published its CbC Reporting Regulations on December 23, 2016 
(“CbC Regulations”), the Company is not under any obligation to file a CbC Report as its turnover is below the required 
threshold. In terms of the CbC Regulations, the ultimate parent entity of Multinational Enterprise Groups (“MNE Group”) 
with total consolidated group revenue of at least R10 billion (or €750 million should the MNE Group be headquartered 
outside of South Africa), must submit a CbC Report to the South African Revenue Service (“SARS”).
In addition to the CbC Regulations, any entity which has entered into cross-border related party transactions, 
which exceed or are reasonably expected to exceed R100 million per year in the aggregate, must submit a “Master File” 
and “Local File” to SARS.
MiX Telematics International meets this threshold and therefore is required to submit Master File and Local File 
returns.
Reduction in regulation in certain markets may adversely impact demand for certain of our solutions by reducing the 
necessity for, or desirability of, our solutions.
Regulatory compliance and reporting is driven by legislation and requirements, which are often subject to 
change, from regulatory authorities in nearly every jurisdiction globally. For example, in the United States, fleet operators 
can face numerous complex regulatory requirements, including mandatory Compliance, Safety and Accountability driver 
safety scoring, hours of service, compliance and fuel tax reporting. The reduction in regulation in certain markets may 
adversely impact demand for certain of our solutions, which could materially and adversely affect our business, financial 
condition and results of operations.
Failure to correctly and efficiently implement a new Enterprise Resource Planning (“ERP”), Customer Relationship 
Management System (“CRM”) and billing system could have a material and adverse effect on our operations. 
We have completed the implementation of a new fully-integrated ERP, CRM and billing system in the African 
Fleet Subsidiaries as well as completed the implementation of the ERP system with an interim billing solution in the 
Middle East RSO. The implementation of the ERP, CRM and billing systems to our other operations are carried out 
according to a phased roll out plan. The overall aim of these new systems is to enable management to achieve enhanced 
quality, reliability and timeliness of information; improve integration and visibility of information stemming from 
different management functions and countries; and optimize global management of corporate processes.
The adoption of a new ERP, CRM and billing system, which will replace the various accounting systems within 
our individual operations, poses several challenges relating to, among other things, project governance, migration of data, 
potential instability of the new system, communication of new rules and procedures, training of personnel and maintaining 
effective internal controls. We are aware of the potential risks associated with a global system implementation and intend 
to adopt mitigation plans and contingency plans, in order to ensure business continuity, this includes mitigating issues 
noted during the pilot implementation before embarking on the full roll-out. However, there can be no assurance that a 
new ERP, CRM and billing system will be successfully implemented and failure to do so could have a material adverse 
effect on our operations and ability to execute on our growth strategy.
34

If the accounting estimates we make, and the assumptions on which we rely, in preparing our consolidated financial 
statements prove inaccurate, our actual results may be adversely affected. 
Our consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with GAAP. The preparation of these 
consolidated financial statements requires us to make estimates and assumptions about, among other things, the 
assessment of expected cash flows used in evaluating goodwill and long-lived assets for impairment, the amortization 
period for deferred commissions, the determination of useful lives of the Company’s customer relationships, maintenance 
and warranty accruals, contingencies, expected credit losses, the classification of devices and other hardware as in-vehicle 
devices (equipment) versus inventory based on the future expectation of the different types of customer contracts, income 
and deferred taxes, unrecognized tax benefits, valuation allowances on deferred tax assets and stock-based compensation. 
These estimates and assumptions affect the reported amounts of our assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses, the amounts 
of charges accrued by us, and related disclosure of contingent liabilities. We base our estimates on historical experience 
and on various other assumptions that we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances and at the time they are made. 
If our estimates or the assumptions underlying them are not correct, actual results may differ materially from our estimates 
and we may need to, among other things, accrue additional charges that could adversely affect our results of operations, 
which in turn could adversely affect our stock price. In addition, new accounting standards, amendments and 
interpretations of accounting standards have occurred and may occur in the future that could adversely affect our reported 
financial results.
We may be exposed to risks related to litigation and administrative proceedings that could materially and adversely 
affect our business, results of operations and financial condition. 
Our business may expose us to litigation and administrative proceedings relating to labor, regulatory, tax 
proceedings, governmental investigations, tort claims, contractual disputes and criminal prosecution, among other matters, 
that could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations, and financial condition. In the context of 
these proceedings, we may not only be required to pay fines or monetary damages but also be subject to sanctions or 
injunctions affecting our ability to continue our operations. While we may contest these matters vigorously and make 
insurance claims when appropriate, litigation and other proceedings are inherently costly and unpredictable, making it 
difficult to accurately estimate the outcome of actual or potential litigation or proceedings. Although we will establish 
provisions in accordance with the requirements of GAAP, the amounts that we reserve could vary significantly from any 
amounts we actually pay due to the inherent uncertainties in the estimation process. In addition, litigation and 
administrative proceedings can involve significant management time and attention and be expensive, regardless of 
outcome. During the course of any litigation and administrative proceedings, there may be announcements of the results 
of hearings and motions and other interim developments. If securities analysts or investors regard these announcements as 
negative, the trading price of our ordinary shares and ADSs may decline. For more information, see “Item 3. Legal 
Proceedings.”
Risks Related to Intellectual Property
We have not traditionally relied on patents to protect our intellectual property, and we rely on trade secrecy laws, 
confidentiality agreements, confidentiality procedures and contractual restrictions to establish and protect our 
intellectual property rights, which provide only limited protection and may subject us to litigation.
Our future success and competitive position depend in part on our ability to protect our intellectual property and 
proprietary technologies. We rely primarily on trade secrecy laws, confidentiality agreements, confidentiality procedures 
and contractual restrictions to establish and protect our intellectual property rights, all of which provide only limited 
protection and may not currently, or in the future, provide us with a competitive advantage. Our confidentiality 
agreements with our employees, licensees, independent contractors and other advisers may not effectively prevent 
disclosure of confidential information and may not provide an adequate remedy in the event of unauthorized disclosure of 
confidential information. In addition, others may independently discover our trade secrets or develop similar technologies 
and processes, and, in either event we would not be able to assert trade secret rights. 
We also rely, to a limited extent, on patent, trademark and copyright law. A patent covering certain aspects of our 
Beam-e product was issued in South Africa during fiscal year 2014 and a patent covering a method for driver verification 
was issued during fiscal year 2015. A further patent for an asset tracking system and method was issued in Brazil on May 
4, 2021. We have traditionally not sought patent protection over our intellectual property. As a result, we may not be able 
to successfully defend our intellectual property from third-party infringement.
35

We cannot assure you that any future trademark registrations will be issued for pending or future applications, or 
that any registered trademarks will be enforceable, or provide adequate protection of our proprietary rights, or that any 
such trademarks will not be challenged, invalidated, or circumvented.
Effective patent, trademark, copyright, and trade secret protection may not be available in every country in which 
our solutions are available, or where we have employees or independent contractors. In addition, the legal standards 
relating to the validity, enforceability, and scope of protection of intellectual property rights in Internet-related industries 
are uncertain and continue to evolve. The steps we have taken, and will take, may not prevent unauthorized use, reverse 
engineering, or misappropriation of our technologies and we may not be able to detect any of the foregoing. Any of the 
foregoing events could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
An assertion by a third party that we are infringing on its intellectual property rights could subject us to costly and 
time-consuming litigation or expensive licenses.
The fleet management, mobile asset management and technology industries are characterized by the existence of 
a large number of patents, copyrights, trademarks and trade secrets and by frequent litigation based on allegations of 
infringement or other violations of intellectual property rights. Much of this litigation involves patent-holding companies 
or other adverse patent owners who have no relevant product revenues of their own, and against whom our own limited 
patent portfolio may provide little or no deterrence. We have been subject to such claims in the past and may face 
additional claims in the future.
We have not historically conducted comprehensive art searches to determine whether our solutions infringe the 
patent rights of third parties in our current markets, or those markets we may enter in the future. Third parties may assert 
that we are infringing on patents, of which we are currently unaware and that would have been disclosed by prior art 
searches if they had been conducted. Our status as a public company in the United States has raised our visibility and may 
invite holders of patents who have not previously sought to enforce them against us, to bring or threaten claims for 
infringement or seek to negotiate royalty or other payments from us. The fact that we have relatively few patents 
associated with our intellectual property means that we may not be able to successfully defend our intellectual property 
from third-party infringement. Any of the foregoing could materially and adversely affect our business, results of 
operations and financial condition.
We cannot assure you that we will prevail in any future intellectual property infringement litigation given the 
complex technical issues and inherent uncertainties in such litigation. Defending such claims, regardless of their merit, 
could be time-consuming and distracting to management, result in costly litigation or settlement, cause development  
delays, or require us to enter into royalty or licensing agreements. In addition, we are obligated to indemnify some of our 
customers and other contract counterparties against third parties’ claims of intellectual property infringement based on our 
solutions. If our solutions violate any third-party intellectual property rights, we could be required to withdraw those 
solutions from the market, re-develop those solutions or seek to obtain licenses from third parties, which might not be 
available on reasonable terms, or at all. Any efforts to redevelop our solutions, obtain licenses from third parties on 
favorable terms or license a substitute technology might not be successful and, in any case, might substantially increase 
our costs and harm our business, financial condition and operating results. Withdrawal of any of our solutions from the 
market could harm our business, financial condition and operating results.
36

Our software may contain undetected defects or software errors, which could result in damage to our reputation or 
market rejection of our products.
We must update our solutions quickly to keep pace with the rapidly changing market, including the third-party 
software and devices with which our solutions integrate, and we have a history of frequently introducing new releases. 
Our solutions and/or updates to our solutions could contain errors or defects, which were not detected during our review 
processes, especially when first introduced or when new versions are released. Our software may not be free from errors 
or defects, which could result in damage to our reputation or harm to our operating results.
We warrant that our hardware will be free of defects for various periods of time. The operation of the hardware is 
controlled by the firmware loaded on the hardware. We generally provide firmware updates to our fleet customers by 
“over-the-air” wireless communication of the updated firmware directly to our customers’ in-vehicle devices. If the 
firmware does not function as expected and it prevents the uploading of updated firmware, then the problem can not be 
corrected by an over-the-air update and will require direct servicing of the installed on-board computer by trained 
personnel, which imposes a very significant cost on us. Variations among communications protocols in the markets in 
which we operate increase the risk of error in the remote installation of firmware. Although we attempt to manage this risk 
by introducing firmware updates in stages, so that the success of deployment can be assessed on a small number of in-
vehicle devices before the deployment risk is expanded to a larger customer base, there can be no assurance that we will 
be successful in detecting firmware operation and integration problems or otherwise in managing our exposure to 
remediation expense related to the deployment of firmware updates.
Our “over-the-air” transmission of firmware updates could permit a third party to disable our customers’ in-vehicle 
devices or introduce malware into our customers’ in-vehicle devices, which could expose us to widespread loss of 
service and customer claims. 
“Over-the-air” transmission of our firmware updates may provide the opportunity for a third party, who has deep 
inside knowledge of our systems, to modify or disable our customers’ in-vehicle systems or introduce malware into our 
customers’ in-vehicle systems. No such incidents have occurred to date, but there can be no assurance that they will not 
occur in the future. Damage to our customers’ in-vehicle devices as a result of such incidents could only be remedied 
through direct servicing of their installed in-vehicle devices by trained personnel, which would impose a very significant 
cost on us, particularly if the incidents are widespread. Moreover, such incidents could expose us to widespread loss of 
service and claims by our customers under various theories of liability, the outcome of which would be uncertain. Third 
party interference with our over-the-air transmission of firmware, or with our customers’ in-vehicle devices during such 
process, could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
Any significant disruption in service on, or security breaches of, our SaaS platform or computer systems, could 
compromise our information, damage our reputation and result in a loss of customers.  
Our brand, reputation, and ability to attract, retain, and serve our customers depend upon the reliable 
performance of our service and our customers’ ability to access our solutions at all times. Our customers rely on our 
solutions to make operating decisions related to their fleet, as well as to measure, store and analyze valuable data 
regarding their businesses. We collect and store sensitive data, including data transmitted from our customers’ in-vehicle 
devices concerning the location of their mobile assets, as well as personally identifiable information concerning our 
customers and employees. Our solutions are vulnerable to interruption and our data centers are vulnerable to damage or 
interruption from human error, intentional malicious acts, computer viruses or hackers, pandemics, earthquakes, 
hurricanes, floods, fires, war, terrorist attacks, power losses, hardware failures, systems failures, telecommunications 
failures and similar events, any of which could limit our customers’ ability to access our solutions. Prolonged delays or 
unforeseen difficulties in connection with adding capacity or upgrading our network architecture may cause our service 
quality to suffer. Any event that significantly disrupts our service or exposes our data to misuse could damage our 
reputation and harm our business and operating results, including causing us to issue credits to customers, subjecting us to 
potential liability, reducing our customer retention rates, or increasing our cost of acquiring new customers, any of which 
would have the effect of reducing our revenue and could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations 
and financial condition.
Any breach of our data or system security could result in our customer data being accessed, publicly disclosed, 
lost or stolen, our business and operations being interrupted, a loss of confidence in our products and services and other 
negative consequences such as civil liability, including under laws that protect the privacy of personal information, and 
regulatory penalties, any or all of which could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results 
of operations.
37

In addition, we store data, host our solutions and serve all of our customers from our servers, which are located at 
third-party data center facilities in Algiers in Algeria, Sydney in Australia, Muscat in Oman, Dublin in Ireland, Dubai in 
UAE and Virginia in the United States. While we control and have access to the servers and some of the physical 
components that are located in these external data centers, we do not control the operation of these facilities or certain 
equipment. Problems faced by our third-party data center locations, with the telecommunications network providers with 
whom they or we contract, or with the systems by which our telecommunications providers allocate capacity among their 
customers, including us, could adversely affect the experience of our customers. Third-party operators of our data centers 
could decide to close their facilities without adequate notice. In addition, any financial difficulties, such as bankruptcy, 
faced by our secure third-party data center operators or any of the service providers with whom they or we contract may 
have negative effects on our business, the nature and extent of which are difficult to predict.
In addition to data hosted at third party data centers, we have transitioned the vast majority of our data to cloud-
based service platforms such as Amazon Web Services (“AWS”) and Azure. The use of such service presents similar risks 
to the use of a conventional third party hosted environment, although at a level that is viewed internally as considerably 
lower. The use of cloud-based servicing may however present additional complexity which may be more easily managed 
using physical data centers, for example the jurisdiction of data and applicability of various laws and regulations denoting 
the transfer of data between jurisdictions is more complex in a cloud based environment. 
Certain of our customer agreements currently, and may in the future, provide minimum service level 
commitments regarding items such as uptime, functionality or performance. If we are unable to meet the stated service 
level commitments for these customers, or suffer extended periods of service unavailability, we are or may be 
contractually obligated to provide these customers with credits for future subscriptions, provide services at no cost or pay 
other penalties, which could adversely impact our profitability. Additionally, if our contracted or physical capacity is 
unable to keep up with our growing needs, this could have an adverse effect on our business. Our disaster recovery 
systems are located at our third-party hosting facilities. We use a redundant architecture and regularly review and increase 
capacity. However, our systems have not been tested under all disaster conditions and may not have sufficient capacity to 
recover all data and services in the event of an outage. In the event of a disaster in which our disaster recovery systems are 
irreparably damaged or destroyed, we would experience interruptions in access to our services. Any changes in third-party 
service levels at our data centers or any errors, defects, disruptions, or other performance problems with our solutions 
could harm our reputation and may damage our data. Interruptions in our services could materially and adversely affect 
our business, results of operations and financial condition, cause us to issue refunds to customers, subject us to potential 
liability, or adversely affect our subscriber retention rates.
In South Africa we are reliant on Eskom (South African Power Utility), which has had challenges in meeting the 
country’s power demand, resulting in load shedding and intermittent power outages. Although it has not resulted in our 
operations being impacted directly, not having power in some of the Global System for Mobile Communications (“GSM”) 
signal towers may impact our ability to locate and track vehicles in that area.
Our solutions rely on third-party software and any inability to license such software from third parties could render 
our solutions ineffectual.
We rely on software and other intellectual property licensed from third parties, including mapping software and 
data from Google and Here, to develop and provide solutions to our customers. In addition, we may need to obtain future 
licenses from third parties to use software or other intellectual property associated with our solutions. We cannot assure 
you that these licenses will be available to us on acceptable terms, without significant price increases or at all. Any loss of 
the right or inability to obtain the right to use any such software or other intellectual property required for the 
development and maintenance of our solutions could result in interruptions in the provision of our solutions until 
equivalent technology is either developed by us, or, if available from others, is identified, obtained, and integrated, which 
could harm our business.
In addition, we incorporate some open source software into our platform. The terms of many open source 
licenses to which we are subject have not been interpreted by U.S. courts or courts of other jurisdictions, and there is a 
risk that those licenses could be construed in a manner that imposes unanticipated conditions or restrictions on our ability 
to commercialize our solutions. In that event, we could be required to seek licenses from third parties in order to continue 
offering our solutions, to re-develop our solutions, to discontinue sales of our solutions, or to release our proprietary 
software source code under the terms of an open-source license, any of which could adversely affect our business.
38

We depend on third-party technology, including cellular and GPS networks, and any disruption, failure or increase in 
costs could impede the functionality of our solutions.
Two critical links in our current solutions are between in-vehicle devices and GPS satellites, and between in-
vehicle devices and cellular networks, which allow us to obtain location data and transmit it to our system. Increases in 
the fees charged by cellular carriers for data transmission or changes in the cellular networks, such as a cellular carrier 
discontinuing support of the network currently used by our in-vehicle devices, requiring retrofitting of our in-vehicle 
devices, could increase our costs and impact our profitability. We have initiated activities to migrate new installations to 
the next generation of cellular network compatibility, in order to maximize expected useful life of our in-vehicle devices. 
However, cellular carriers could in the future discontinue support for our currently utilized cellular technologies. Also, 
while we have included the ability to store GPS data in our in-vehicle devices in case of temporary cellular network 
connectivity failure, widespread disruptions or extended failures of the cellular networks would adversely affect our 
solutions’ functionality and utility and harm our financial results.
GPS is a satellite-based navigation and positioning system consisting of a network of orbiting satellites. These 
satellites and their ground support systems are complex electronic systems, subject to electronic and mechanical failures 
and possible sabotage and it is not certain that the U.S. government will remain committed to the operation and 
maintenance of GPS satellites in the future. In addition, technologies that rely on GPS depend on the use of radio 
frequency bands and any modification of the permitted uses of these bands may adversely affect the functionality of GPS 
and, in turn, our solutions. The satellites and their ground control and monitoring stations are maintained and operated by 
the U.S. Department of Defense, which does not currently charge users for access to the satellite signals and does not 
impose on the ability to access location data. We cannot assure you that it will not do so in the future. Any disruption, 
failure, increase in costs or regulatory hurdles could impede the functionality and/or cost of our solutions, which could 
adversely affect our business. The communication systems that we use to host and transmit data may be subject to security 
incidents, which may also subject the Company to regulatory enforcement and client pressures.
Our solutions integrate with third-party technologies and if our solutions become incompatible with these technologies, 
our solutions would lose functionality and our customer acquisition and retention could be adversely affected.
Our solutions integrate with third-party software and devices to allow our solutions to perform key functions. We 
cannot guarantee that this ease of integration will continue or that we will be able to integrate with other products at all or 
without additional cost. Additionally, previously unidentified errors, viruses or bugs may also be present in third-party 
software that our customers use in conjunction with our solutions. Changes to third-party software that our customers use 
in conjunction with our solutions could also render our solutions ineffective. Customers may conclude that our software is 
the cause of these errors, bugs or viruses and terminate their subscriptions. The inability to easily integrate with, or the 
presence of any defects in, any third-party software could result in increased costs, or in delays in software releases or 
updates to our products until such issues have been resolved, which could damage our reputation and materially and 
adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Risks Related to South Africa
Fluctuations in the value of the South African Rand have had, and will continue to have, a significant impact on our 
reported revenues and results of operations, which may make it difficult to evaluate our business performance between 
reporting periods and may also adversely affect the price of our ADSs.
The majority of our subscription agreements and operating expenses are incurred outside the United States and 
denominated in foreign currencies and are subject to fluctuations due to changes in foreign currency exchange rates, 
particularly changes in the South African Rand. Currency fluctuations, particularly those in respect of the South African 
Rand, may positively or negatively impact our reported income and expenses due to the effects of translating the 
functional currency of our foreign subsidiaries into our reporting currency of U.S. Dollars.
The majority of our revenues are derived from currencies other than the U.S. Dollar. Accordingly, changes in 
exchange rates, and in particular a strengthening of the U.S. Dollar, will negatively impact our revenues and income as 
reported in U.S. Dollars. The depreciation of the Rand may also negatively impact the prices at which our ADR’s trade. 
Due to the significant fluctuation in the value of the South African Rand and its impact on our results, you may 
find it difficult to compare our results of operations between financial reporting periods. This difficulty may have a 
negative impact on the price of our ADSs and/or increase their volatility. During fiscal year 2022, the South African Rand 
strengthened by 9.2% against the U.S. Dollar (Rand/U.S. Dollar exchange rate averaged R14.86 and fluctuated between a 
39

high of R16.30 and a low of R13.43). This compared to an average exchange rate of R16.37 during fiscal year 2021 
(which fluctuated between a high of R18.59 and a low of R14.78). The South African Rand exchange rate is affected by 
various international and South African political factors and economic conditions resulting since the outbreak of the 
COVID-19 pandemic. 
As stated above we operate internationally and are exposed to foreign exchange risk arising from various 
currency exposures, primarily with respect to the South African Rand, the Euro, the Australian Dollar, Brazilian Real and 
the British Pound. These exposures may change over time as business practices evolve and could have a material adverse 
impact on our financial results and cash flows. Fluctuation in currency exchange rates impacts our operating results. We 
have implemented a foreign currency hedging policy to reduce our net exposure, on certain recognized assets and 
liabilities, to fluctuations in foreign currencies. Our policy is primarily based on economic hedging principles of managing 
certain of our on balance sheet risk, as opposed to using derivative financial instruments. We do not attempt to hedge 
currency translation risk. Our future attempts to hedge against foreign currency risk could be unsuccessful and expose us 
to losses.
If we do not achieve applicable black economic empowerment objectives in our South African businesses, we risk not 
being able to renew certain of our existing contracts which service South African government and quasi-governmental 
customers, as well as not being awarded future corporate and governmental contracts, each of which would result in 
the loss of revenue.
The South African government established a legislative framework for the promotion of Broad-Based Black 
Economic Empowerment (“B-BBEE”). Achievement of B-BBEE objectives is measured by a scorecard which establishes 
a weighting for the various components of B-BBEE which relate to ownership, enterprise and supplier development and 
socio-economic development. The B-BBEE codes are regularly updated. 
It is important for us to achieve applicable B-BBEE objectives to ensure sustainability and contribute towards the 
realization of the National Development Plan 2030. In addition, B-BBEE objectives are pursued, in significant part, by 
requiring parties who contract with corporate, governmental and state owned enterprises in South Africa to achieve B-
BBEE compliance through satisfaction of an applicable scorecard. Parties improve their B-BBEE contributor level when 
contracting with businesses that have earned good B-BBEE contributor levels in relation to their scorecards. 
MiX Telematics Enterprise SA Proprietary Limited engages with government and state owned enterprises in 
tendering for business and is therefore required to maintain at least a certain B-BBEE contributor level to continue to 
provide the service. Currently some material end-customers requires MiX Telematics Enterprise SA Proprietary Limited 
to maintain at least a B-BBEE level 2 or 3. The value of these contracts represented 2.9% of our total revenue for fiscal 
year 2022. MiX Telematics Enterprise SA Proprietary Limited has attained the agreed compliance targets in fiscal year 
2022. 
The Employment Equity Act promotes equality in the workplace, and ensures that employees are treated fairly 
and have equal opportunities within the workplace. The Minister of Employment and Labour may identify national 
economic sectors as per Statistics South Africa and after consulting with those relevant sectors and with the advice of the 
Employment Equity Commission, set numerical targets for the purpose of ensuring the equitable representation of suitably 
qualified people from designated groups at all occupational levels in the workforce. The Minister plans to set and 
implement different numerical targets for different occupational levels, sub-sectors or regions within a sector or on the 
basis of any other relevant factor by September 2022. This means that MiX Telematics will not set its own Employment 
Equity targets but targets will be imposed. In addition, all organizations doing business with government or state owned 
enterprises are required to obtain an annual Employment Equity Certificate of Compliance in order to continue doing 
business or tender for business with the government. 
We currently have continued recognition of Black ownership by previous shareholders, until the end of fiscal 
year 2022. The continuing consequences principle enables companies to continue claiming points for ownership based on 
the number of years the Black participants held shares before selling them. With a portion of the continuing consequences 
recognition coming to an end during fiscal year 2022, and the remainder expiring in fiscal year 2024. MiX Telematics 
Limited will not be able to continue claiming points for Ownership beyond these times. It is important for MiX 
Telematics to explore a Black shareholder opportunity at the Group level in order to recognize flow-through to all South 
African entities.
40

Failing to achieve applicable B-BBEE objectives could jeopardize our ability to maintain existing business or to 
secure future business from corporate, governmental or state-owned enterprises that could materially and adversely affect 
our business, financial condition and results of operations.
We face the risk of disruption from labor disputes and changes to South African labor laws, which could result in 
significant additional operating costs or alter our relationship with our employees.
Our operations may be materially affected by changes to labor laws. South African laws relating to labor that 
regulate work time, provide for mandatory compensation in the event of termination of employment for operational 
reasons, and impose monetary penalties for non-compliance with administrative and reporting requirements in respect of 
affirmative action policies, could result in significant costs. In addition, future changes to South African legislation and 
regulations relating to labor may increase our costs or alter our relationship with our employees. The resulting disruptions 
could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Socio-economic inequality in South Africa or regionally may subject us to political and economic risks which may 
affect the ownership or operation of our business.
We are incorporated and own significant operations in South Africa. As a result, we are subject to political and 
economic risks relating to South Africa. South Africa was transformed from a racially based government into a 
democracy in 1994, with successful rounds of democratic elections held under a modern constitution during 1994, 1999, 
2004, 2009, 2014 and most recently, in May 2019. The next national elections are scheduled to be held in 2024. We fully 
support government policies aimed at redressing the disadvantages suffered by the majority of citizens under the previous 
non-democratic dispensation and recognize that in order to implement these policies, our operations and profits may be 
impacted. However, South Africa faces many challenges in overcoming substantial racial differences in levels of 
economic and social development among its people. While South Africa features highly developed and sophisticated 
business sectors and financial and legal infrastructure at the core of its economy, large parts of the country’s black 
population, particularly in rural areas, do not have access to adequate education, health care, housing and other services, 
including water and electricity. In addition, South Africa also has a higher level of unemployment than the United States.
The ruling party which has controlled the South African government since democracy has committed itself to 
creating a stable, democratic, free market economy, which it has achieved to a great extent. It remains difficult however, 
to predict the future political, social and economic direction of South Africa or the manner in which any future 
government will attempt to address the country’s inequalities. It is also difficult to predict the impact that addressing these 
inequalities will have on our business. Furthermore, there has been regional, political and economic instability in countries 
neighboring South Africa, which could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial 
condition.
Although political conditions in South Africa are generally stable, changes may occur in the composition of its 
ruling party or in its political, fiscal and legal systems which might affect the ownership or operation of our business, 
which may, in turn, materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. These risks 
may include changes in legislation, arbitrary interference with private ownership of contract rights, and changes to 
exchange controls, taxation and other laws or policies affecting foreign trade or investment and could materially and 
adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. Any changes in investment ratings, regulations 
and policies or a shift in political attitudes both within and towards South Africa are beyond our control and could 
materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
A lack of growth, high inflation or increased interest rates in the South African economy could reduce our anticipated 
revenue and increase our operating costs. 
The South African Reserve Bank (“SARB”) estimated and expects gross domestic product (“GDP”) to grow by 
2.0% in 2022. The same report indicated that GDP is expected to grow by 1.9% in both 2023 and 2024. The International 
Monetary Fund, in April 2022, projected that the South African economy is expected to grow by 1.9% in 2022.
Current economic projections remain uncertain as a result of the COVID-19 pandemic sweeping around the 
world, a sudden and sharp surge in global inflation mainly as a result of global supply chain constraints, global politics, 
sanctions and impact thereof on global trade. Furthermore, the South African economy is also impacted by the high 
unemployment rate. In the fourth quarter of 2021, the official unemployment rate was 35.3%, with unemployment as per 
the expanded definition reported as 46.2%. 
41

The South African economy has in the past and may in the future continue to be characterized by rates of 
inflation and interest rates that are substantially higher than those prevailing in the United States and other developed 
economies. The SARB set the inflation target range as between 3% and 6%. SARB reported inflation in April 2022 at 
5.9%, and are projecting that it will breach the upper limit of the target range in the 2nd quarter of 2022. Inflation is 
however expected to return to the target midpoint in 2023. 
Economic conditions in South Africa may be further impacted by the South African credit ratings from the three 
major credit rating agencies. All three major rating agencies kept the South African credit ratings on Non-Investment 
Grade Speculative, however all three rating agencies have changed the outlook from negative to stable.
•
Standard & Poor’s affirmed South Africa’s long term foreign-currency credit rating to BB-, three notches below 
investment grade May 21, 2022, and kept the country’s local currency debt at BB, however changed the outlook 
from stable to positive;
•
Fitch maintained the rating on sub-investment grade BB- and revised the outlook from negative to stable on 
December 15 2021; and
•
Moody’s maintained its sub-investment grade Ba2 rating, but changed the outlook from negative to stable on 
April 1, 2022.
Consequently, economic conditions in South Africa could impact our anticipated revenue growth, increase our 
South African-based costs, decrease our operating margins and adversely affect our ability to obtain cost-effective debt 
financing in South Africa.
Our financial flexibility could be constrained by South African currency restrictions, which, in turn, could hinder our 
normal corporate functioning.
South African companies are subject to exchange control limitations, which could hinder our normal corporate 
functioning, particularly given our significant expansion outside of South Africa in recent years. Exchange controls have 
been relaxed in recent years and may continue to be relaxed. However, South African companies remain subject to certain 
restrictions on their ability to raise and deploy capital outside of the Southern African Common Monetary Area, which 
includes South Africa, Namibia, Lesotho and Swaziland. These restrictions have affected the manner in which we have 
financed our acquisitions outside South Africa. These restrictions or any adverse changes to these restrictions could 
materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Risks Related to an Investment in our Ordinary Shares and ADSs
Sales of our ordinary shares may adversely affect the prices of our ordinary shares and ADSs.
Sales of substantial amounts of our ordinary shares in the public market, including sales by our officers, directors 
and principal shareholders, or the perception that such sales may occur, could adversely affect the prevailing market price 
of our ordinary shares or our ADSs as well as our ability to raise capital through an offering of our securities. In the 
future, we may also sponsor the sale of shares currently held by some of our shareholders, or issue new shares. We can 
make no prediction as to the timing of any such sales or the effect, if any, that future sales of our ordinary shares, or the 
availability of our ordinary shares for future sale, will have on the market price of our ordinary shares or ADSs prevailing 
from time to time.
The price of our ordinary shares or ADSs may be volatile and fluctuate significantly, which could result in substantial 
losses for investors.
Market prices for our securities may be volatile in response to various factors, some of which are beyond our 
control. Such volatility could negatively impact the perceived value and market prices of our ordinary shares or ADSs. In 
addition to the risks described in this ‘Risk Factors’ section of the annual report, some of the factors that may cause these 
market prices to fluctuate include:
•
actual or anticipated fluctuations in our financial results or the financial results of our competitors;
•
loss of existing customers or inability to attract new customers;
•
actual or anticipated changes in our growth rate;
42

•
our announcement of results for a financial reporting period that are lower than expected, whether caused by our 
results of operations or by currency fluctuations;
•
changes in estimates of our financial results or recommendations by securities analysts;
•
failure of any of our solutions to achieve or maintain market acceptance;
•
changes in market valuations of similar companies;
•
changes in our capital structure, including issuances or repurchases of securities or the incurrence of debt;
•
announcements by us or our competitors of significant products, technologies, services, contracts, acquisitions, 
or strategic alliances;
•
success of competitive products or services;
•
regulatory developments in South Africa, the United States or other countries;
•
actual or threatened litigation involving us or our industry;
•
additions or departures of key personnel;
•
breaches of security;
•
general perception of the future of the fleet and mobile asset management market or our solutions;
•
sales of ADSs or ordinary shares by our shareholders;
•
the outbreak of COVID-19 globally and the impact thereof on our results, economic activities, the business of 
various sectors and the adverse market conditions created as a result of the pandemic;
•
ADS price and volume fluctuations attributable to inconsistent trading volume levels of our ADSs; and
•
changes in general economic, industry, and market conditions.
We issue quarterly press releases and other disclosure of our financial results. Our quarterly operating results will 
fluctuate in the future as a result of a variety of factors, including, but not limited to, impact of COVID-19 on our business 
and the businesses of our customers, our ability to accurately forecast revenue and appropriately plan our expenses, long 
sales cycles for our enterprise fleet management solutions, service outages or security breaches and any related 
occurrences which could impact our reputation as well as fluctuations in currency exchange rates. If our quarterly 
operating results or guidance fall below the expectations of research analysts or investors, the price of our ordinary shares 
and ADSs could decline substantially.
In addition, the stock market in general, and the market for technology companies in particular, has experienced 
extreme price and volume fluctuations that have often been unrelated or disproportionate to the operating performance of 
those companies. These broad market and industry factors may materially harm the market price of our ordinary shares 
and ADSs. Securities class action litigation has often been instituted against companies following periods of volatility in 
the overall market and in the market price of a company’s securities. This litigation, if instituted against us, could result in 
very substantial costs, divert our management’s attention and resources, and harm our business, operating results, and 
financial condition.
Exchange rate volatility may adversely affect the market price of our ADSs and any dividends payable to ADS holders.
As discussed above and further discussed below, there have been significant fluctuations in the exchange rate 
between the South African Rand and the U.S. Dollar, specifically since the outbreak of COVID-19 and the adverse market 
conditions created as a result. Unforeseen events in international markets, fluctuations in interest rates, changes in capital 
flows, political developments or inflation rates may cause further exchange rate instability that could, in turn, depress the 
value of the South African Rand, thereby decreasing the U.S. Dollar value of our ADSs and any dividends or distributions 
paid on the ordinary shares underlying the ADSs.
Our shares trade on more than one market and this may result in price variations.
Our ordinary shares have been traded on the JSE since 2007, and our ADSs have been traded on the New York 
Stock Exchange (the “NYSE”) since August 2013. Trading in our ordinary shares and ADSs on these markets takes place 
in U.S. Dollars on the NYSE and South African Rand on the JSE, and at different times, resulting from different time 
zones, trading days and public holidays in the United States and South Africa. The trading prices of our ordinary shares 
43

and ADSs on these two markets may differ due to these and other factors. Any decrease in the price of our ordinary shares 
on the JSE could cause a corresponding decrease in the trading price of our ADSs on the NYSE.
We have reported a material weakness in our internal controls over financial reporting. If we fail to remediate the 
material weakness and our control environment are considered to be ineffective, it might impair our ability to produce 
accurate and timely financial statements, which could adversely affect our operating results, our ability to operate our 
business and investors’ and customers’ view of us.
Under Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, we are required to furnish a management certification and 
auditor attestation regarding the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. We are required to report, 
among other things, control deficiencies that constitute a “material weakness” or changes in internal control that 
materially affect, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, internal control over financial reporting. A material 
weakness is a deficiency, or a combination of deficiencies, in internal control over financial reporting, such that there is a 
reasonable possibility that a material misstatement of the company’s annual or interim financial statements will not be 
prevented or detected on a timely basis.
In 2022, Management identified several deficiencies in the design and operating effectiveness of business 
process level controls in the areas of management review of income tax, consignment stock and capitalization of internally 
generated software costs at the Company’s Africa segment as a result of the lack of senior financial resources to 
appropriately supervise and execute control activities. These deficiencies aggregated with other business process level 
control deficiencies could result in material misstatement in the financial statements and therefore constitute a material 
weakness.  For a discussion of the material weakness and our remediation efforts, see Item 9A, Controls and Procedures, 
in this Annual report on Form 10-K. We cannot assure you that our efforts to remediate this internal control weakness will 
be successful or that other material weaknesses will not occur. 
If we fail to maintain an effective internal control environment, our ability to produce accurate and timely 
financial statements could be impaired, which could adversely affect our operating results, our ability to operate our 
business, and investors’ and customers’ views of us. In addition, if we identify any additional material weaknesses in the 
future, the disclosure of that fact, even if quickly remediated could reduce the market’s confidence in our financial 
statements and negatively affect the trading price of our ADSs.
Inherent limitations on the effectiveness of the system of disclosure controls and procedures could result in 
misstatement due to error or fraud going undetected.
There are inherent limitations to the effectiveness of any system of disclosure controls and procedures, including 
the possibility of human error and the circumvention or overriding of the controls or the procedures. Accordingly, even 
disclosure controls and procedures designed and operating effectively, can only provide reasonable assurance of achieving 
their control objectives. Because of the inherent limitations in an effective system of internal controls, misstatement due to 
error or fraud may occur and not be detected. 
Certain provisions of South African law may limit or otherwise discourage a takeover or business combination that 
could otherwise benefit our shareholders.
Various transactions including, without limitation, those which result in a person, or a group of persons acting in 
concert, holding shares entitled to exercise or cause to be exercised 35% or more of the voting rights at meetings of our 
shareholders will be subject to the Fundamental Transactions and Takeover Regulations (the “Takeover Regulations”), 
promulgated in terms of Section 196 of the Companies Act, which are regulated by the Takeover Regulation Panel. The 
Takeover Regulations impose various obligations in such circumstances including the requirement of an offer to minority 
shareholders.
A transaction will be subject to the approval of the competition authorities in terms of the Competition Act, 
No. 89 of 1998, as amended (the “Competition Act”), if it results in the acquisition of “control”, as defined in the 
Competition Act and otherwise falls within the scope of the Competition Act. The Competition Act prohibits a transaction 
within its scope from being implemented without the necessary approvals.
To the extent applicable, a transaction may be subject to the JSE Listings Requirements as well as the approval of 
the Exchange Control Department of the South African Reserve Bank, and other applicable regulatory bodies. In addition, 
certain fundamental transactions such as mergers, amalgamations, schemes of arrangements and sales of a majority of a 
company’s assets, require the approval of shareholders exercising 75% of the voting rights at a shareholders meeting, and 
44

if 15% or more of a company’s shareholders vote against the transaction, any dissenting shareholder may, within five 
days, require the company, at its expense, to obtain court approval before implementing the resolution. Even if less than 
15% of the shareholders vote against the resolution, any dissenting shareholder may apply to court for a review of the 
transaction. Such regulations, including the Takeover Regulations and the Competition Act, may have the effect of 
delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control of us including an extraordinary transaction (such as a merger, 
tender offer, scheme of arrangement or sale of all or substantially all of our assets) that might provide a premium price for 
our shareholders.
We are a “smaller reporting company”, and the reduced disclosure requirements applicable to smaller reporting 
companies may make our ordinary shares or ADSs less attractive to investors.
We are a “smaller reporting company” as defined in the Exchange Act and have elected to take advantage of 
certain of the scaled disclosures available to smaller reporting companies, including simplified executive compensation 
disclosures in our filings. We cannot predict whether investors will find our ordinary shares or ADSs less attractive 
because of our reliance on any of these exemptions. If some investors find our ordinary shares or ADSs less attractive as a 
result, there may be a less active trading market for such securities. As a result, investors in our ordinary shares or ADSs 
may experience a decrease, which could be substantial, in the value of such securities, including decreases unrelated to 
our operating performance or prospects, or a complete loss of their investment.
The concentration of ownership of our capital stock limits your ability to influence corporate matters.
At May 27, 2022, our executive officers, directors, current 5% or greater shareholders and entities affiliated with 
them, beneficially own 34.9% of our ordinary shares. This significant concentration of share ownership may adversely 
affect the trading price for our ordinary shares and ADSs because investors often perceive disadvantages in owning stock 
in companies with concentrated share ownership. In addition, these shareholders, acting together, may be able to control 
our management and affairs and matters requiring shareholder approval, including the election of directors and the 
approval of significant corporate transactions, such as mergers, consolidations or the sale of substantially all of our assets. 
Shareholders owning greater than 25% of our outstanding ordinary shares will have the ability to block certain corporate 
actions, including the issuance of additional equity securities for cash. See “Certain provisions of South African law may 
limit our ability to issue securities and access the capital markets in the future, which could hinder our ability to raise 
capital in the future.” Consequently, this concentration of ownership may have the effect of exacerbating the delays and 
limitations on capital market transactions and could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and 
financial condition.
Certain provisions of South African law may limit our ability to issue securities and access the capital markets in the 
future, which could hinder our ability to raise capital in the future.
The authority of our Board of Directors to issue additional securities is limited by the JSE Listings Requirements 
and certain provisions of the Companies Act and our Memorandum of Incorporation, and as a result we may be unable to 
access the capital markets on a timely basis when it is opportune to do so. Under the JSE Listings Requirements, the 
issuance of equity securities, or securities convertible into equity securities, for cash by our Board of Directors requires 
shareholder approval, either by means of a specific authority for a specific transaction or by way of a general authority, 
for a limited time period. If a general authority is not in place, we may experience extended delays and uncertainty in 
seeking shareholder approval for financing transactions and as a result we may be unable to execute financing transactions 
with available investors, on advantageous terms or at all. Moreover, while a general authority could allow our Board of 
Directors to issue for cash additional ordinary shares representing up to 30% of the ordinary shares outstanding at the time 
of the general authorization, as a practical matter, shareholders in the South African market are often reluctant to grant 
general authorities up to the 30% threshold. The Company has sought a general authority to issue equity securities, or 
securities convertible into equity securities, for cash, limited to 5% of the ordinary shares outstanding at the time the 
general authorization is sought. A general authorization would not permit our Board of Directors to issue ordinary shares 
for cash with a greater than 10% discount to the 30-day volume-weighted average price, as of the issuance date, which, if 
we were to experience significant financial difficulties in the future, could prevent us from obtaining funds when needed.  
Shareholders owning greater than 25% of our outstanding ordinary shares have the ability to block an issuance of ordinary 
shares for cash. The Company has sought a further limited authority approving the placement of the authorized but 
unissued shares of the Company under the control of directors who may issue such shares in their discretion. This 
authority, if approved by a majority of shareholders, is only valid until the Company’s next annual general meeting or 
until renewed; is in line with the Memorandum of Incorporation and provides limited flexibility to execute financing 
transactions or any approval of a general authorization to our Board of Directors. While we will be able to issue non-
45

convertible debt securities without shareholder approval, we will not be able to grant any voting rights to debt holders, 
which would be likely to increase the cost of any such debt issuance to the Company.
The relative volatility and illiquidity of the South African securities markets may substantially limit your ability to sell 
the ordinary shares underlying our ADSs at the price and time you desire.
Our ordinary shares are listed for trading on the JSE. Investing in securities that trade in emerging markets, such 
as South Africa, often involves greater risk than investing in the securities of issuers in the United States, and such 
investments are generally considered to be more speculative in nature. The South African securities market is substantially 
smaller, less liquid, more concentrated and can be more volatile than major securities markets in the United States. The 
South African securities market was also severely impacted by the outbreak of COVID-19. There is also significantly 
greater concentration in the South African securities markets than in major securities markets in the United States. On 
May 27, 2022, the JSE total market capitalization amounted to R20,478.7 billion ($1,309.4 billion) and this market 
capitalization was represented by 316 companies. Accordingly, although you are entitled to withdraw the ordinary shares 
underlying our ADSs from the depositary at any time, your ability to sell such shares at a price and time you desire may 
be substantially limited. The Bank of New York Mellon (“BNYM”) serves as the depositary (the “depositary”) with 
respect to the ADSs.
Holders of our ADSs in the United States may have difficulty bringing actions and enforcing judgements, against us, 
our directors and our executive officers based on the civil liabilities provisions of the federal securities laws or other 
laws of the United States or any state thereof.
We are incorporated in South Africa; however, half of our directors and the majority of our senior management 
reside within of the United States. The rest of the directors, senior management and certain experts names herein, either 
reside in South Africa or other jurisdictions. A portion of the assets of these persons and substantially all of the 
Company’s assets are therefore located outside of the United States. As a result, it may not be possible for investors to 
enforce against these persons or us a judgement obtained in a United States court predicated upon the civil liability 
provisions of the federal securities or other laws of the United States or any state thereof. South Africa is also not party to 
any international treaty or convention relating to the enforcement of foreign judgements.
 A foreign judgement is not directly enforceable in South Africa, but constitutes a cause of action which will be 
enforced by South African courts provided that:
•
the court that pronounced the judgement had jurisdiction (under its own laws) to entertain the case according to 
the principles recognized by South African law with reference to the jurisdiction of foreign courts;
•
the defendant was a resident subject to the foreign court’s jurisdiction or was at least present in the foreign 
court’s jurisdiction at the commencement of the action, or must have submitted to that court’s jurisdiction either 
contractually or by conduct, in the latter instance, by defending the case on its merits;
•
the judgement is final and conclusive (that is, it cannot be altered by the court which pronounced it);
•
the judgement has not lapsed or been satisfied;
•
the recognition and enforcement of the judgement by South African courts would not be contrary to public 
policy, including observance of the rules of natural justice which require that the documents initiating the United 
States proceeding were properly served on the defendant and that the defendant was given the right to be heard 
and represented by counsel in a free and fair trial before an impartial tribunal;
•
the judgement was not obtained by fraudulent means;
•
the judgement does not involve the enforcement of a penal or revenue law of the foreign state; and
•
the enforcement of the judgement is not otherwise precluded by the provisions of the South African Protection of 
Businesses Act of 1978, as amended.
It is the policy of South African courts to award compensation for the loss or damage actually sustained by the 
person to whom the compensation is awarded. Although the award of punitive damages is generally unknown to the South 
46

African legal system that does not mean that such awards are necessarily contrary to public policy. Whether a judgement 
was contrary to public policy depends on the facts of each case. Exorbitant, unconscionable, or excessive awards will 
generally be contrary to public policy. South African courts cannot enter into the merits of a foreign judgement and cannot 
act as a court of appeal or review over the foreign court. South African courts will usually implement their own procedural 
laws and, where an action based on an international contract is brought before a South African court, the capacity of the 
parties to the contract will usually be determined in accordance with South African law.
It is doubtful whether an original action based on U.S. federal securities laws may be brought before South 
African courts. A plaintiff who is not a resident in South Africa may be required to provide security for costs in the event 
of proceedings being initiated in South Africa. Furthermore, the Rules of the High Court of South Africa require that 
documents executed outside South Africa must be notarially authenticated for the purpose of use in South Africa. 
Holders of our ADSs may not receive dividend payments, which could cause you to lose some or all of the value of any 
dividend distribution.
Under the terms of our deposit agreement with the depositary for our ADSs, the depositary will convert any cash 
dividend or other cash distribution we pay on the ordinary shares underlying the ADSs into U.S. Dollars, if it can do so on 
a reasonable basis and can transfer the U.S. Dollars to the United States. If this conversion is not possible or if any 
government approval becomes necessary and cannot be obtained, the deposit agreement allows the depositary to distribute 
the foreign currency only to those ADS holders to whom it is permissible to do so. If the exchange rate fluctuates 
significantly during a time when the depositary cannot convert the foreign currency or distribute a payment to you, you 
may lose some or all of the value of any dividend distribution. We consider the issuance of such dividends on a quarter-
by-quarter basis.
Holders of our ADSs may be subject to additional risks related to holding ADSs rather than ordinary shares.
ADS holders do not hold ordinary shares directly and thus are subject to, among others, the following additional 
risks:
•
as an ADS holder, we will not treat you as one of our shareholders and you will not be able to exercise 
shareholder rights, except through the depositary as permitted by the deposit agreement;
•
distributions on the ordinary shares represented by your ADSs will be paid to the depositary, and before the 
depositary makes a distribution to you on behalf of your ADSs, any withholding taxes that must be paid will be 
deducted. Additionally, if the exchange rate fluctuates during a time when the depositary cannot convert the 
foreign currency, you may lose some or all of the value of the distribution; and
•
we and the depositary may amend or terminate the deposit agreement without the ADS holders’ consent in a 
manner that could prejudice ADS holders.
You must act through the depositary to exercise your voting rights, as a result of which you may be unable to exercise 
your voting rights on a timely basis.
As a holder of ADSs, and not the ordinary shares underlying your ADSs, we will not treat you as one of our 
shareholders and you will not be able to exercise shareholder rights. The depositary will be the holder of the ordinary 
shares underlying your ADSs, and ADS holders will be able to exercise voting rights with respect to the ordinary shares 
represented by the ADSs only in accordance with the deposit agreement relating to the ADSs. There are practical 
limitations on the ability of ADS holders to exercise their voting rights due to the additional procedural steps involved in 
communicating with these holders. For example, holders of our ordinary shares will receive notice of shareholders’ 
meetings by mail, the securities exchange news service of the JSE or by other means and will be able to exercise their 
voting rights by either attending the meeting in person or voting by proxy. ADS holders, by comparison, will not receive 
notice directly from us. Instead, in accordance with the deposit agreement, we will provide notice of any applicable 
meeting date to the depositary as soon as practicable. If we ask it to do so, as soon as practicable after receiving notice 
from us of any such meeting, the depositary will mail to holders of ADSs the notice of the meeting and a statement as to 
the manner in which voting instructions may be given by holders. Subject to satisfaction of the foregoing standard, there is 
no specified number of days within which the depositary must mail ADS holders the notice of meeting and voting 
instructions. To exercise their voting rights, ADS holders must then instruct the depositary as to voting the ordinary shares 
represented by their ADSs. Due to these procedural steps involving the depositary, the process for exercising voting rights 
may take longer for ADS holders than for holders of ordinary shares. The ordinary shares represented by ADSs for which 
the depositary fails to receive timely voting instructions may not be voted at all.
47

Judgements of South African courts with respect to our ADSs will be payable only in South African Rand, which could 
expose any prevailing party to exchange rate risk until the judgement is collected.
If proceedings are brought in a South African court seeking to enforce the rights of holders of the ADSs, any 
judgement made in favor of such holders, even if the judgement is on an obligation deemed to be denominated in U.S. 
Dollars, could only be made or awarded in South African Rand based on the exchange rate in effect at the time the 
judgement is entered. The prevailing party in such proceeding would therefore bear exchange rate risk until the judgement 
could be collected and converted into another currency.
By purchasing ADSs, holders will irrevocably submit to the jurisdiction of state or federal courts in New York, New 
York in connection with any legal suit, action or proceeding relating to the deposit agreement or our ADSs.
By purchasing ADSs or an interest therein, holders of ADSs irrevocably agree that any legal suit, action or 
proceeding against or involving us or the depositary, arising out of or based upon the deposit agreement or the ADSs, may 
only be instituted in a state or federal court in New York, New York, and by purchasing ADSs or an interest therein 
holders irrevocably waive any objection to the laying of venue of any such proceeding. We have agreed to indemnify the 
depositary and its agents under certain circumstances. Neither the depositary nor any of its agents will be liable to holders 
or beneficial owners of ADSs or interests in ADSs for any indirect, special, punitive or consequential damages (including, 
without limitation, lost profits) of any form incurred by any person or entity, whether or not foreseeable and regardless of 
the type of action in which such a claim may be brought.
There is a risk that we will be classified as a passive foreign investment company (“PFIC”), which could result in 
adverse U.S. federal income tax consequences to U.S. holders of ordinary shares or our ADSs.
We may be classified as a PFIC for U.S. federal income tax purposes, which could result in adverse U.S. federal 
income tax consequence to U.S. holders.
Based on the current price of our ADSs and the composition of our income and assets, we do not believe that we 
are a PFIC for U.S. federal income tax purposes for our current taxable year ended March 31, 2022. However, a separate 
determination must be made after the close of each taxable year as to whether we are a PFIC. We cannot assure you that 
we will not be a PFIC for any future taxable year. If we were treated as a PFIC for any taxable year during which a U.S. 
holder held an equity share or an ADS, certain adverse U.S. federal income tax consequences could apply to the U.S. 
holder.
ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
None.
48

ITEM 2. PROPERTIES
Our principal executive offices are located in Boca Raton, Florida. In addition, we maintain facilities in various 
locations outside of the United States, including South Africa, the United Kingdom, Uganda, Brazil, Australia, Romania and the 
United Arab Emirates. All of our facilities are leased. We believe that our facilities are adequate for our current needs and that 
suitable additional space will be available as needed to accommodate any potential expansion.
ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
Patent Infringement matter
PerDiemCo, LLC v. MiX Telematics Limited and MiX Telematics North America, Inc. (Case No. 2:21-cv-00190, 
United States District Court for the Eastern District of Texas): This patent infringement case was filed on May 29, 2021, in 
United States federal court in the Eastern District of Texas. In the complaint, PerDiemCo (the “Plaintiff”) alleges that MiX 
Telematics’ (the “Company”) “ELD and geo-fencing products and services” including “MiX On-Board Computers (e.g. 3000 
or 4000 Series products),” MiX Rovi II, MiX Fleet Manager, and MiX Telematics’ related Software as a Service infringe 
United States patent numbers 10,382,966; 10,021,198; 9,871,874; 9,680,941; 10,277,689, 10,602,364; 10,397,789; 10,819,809 
& 10,171,950.
On February 7, 2022 the Company and Plaintiff entered into a settlement and license agreement under which the 
Plaintiff released the Company from all its claims and granted it a patent license, fully resolving the lawsuit. The parties have 
filed a joint stipulation of dismissal with prejudice with the court.
The Company does not expect that the terms of this settlement will have a material adverse effect on its business, 
results of operations, financial condition, or cash flows.
Competition Commission Matter
On April 15, 2019, the Competition Commission of South Africa (the “Commission”) referred a matter to the 
Competition Tribunal of South Africa (“Tribunal”). The Commission contends that the Company and a number of its channel 
partners have engaged in market division. Should the Tribunal rule against MiX Telematics, the Company may be liable to an 
administrative penalty in terms of the Competition Act, No. 89 of 1998. The Company cooperated fully with the Commission 
during its preliminary investigation.
The Commission’s lawyer recently approached the Tribunal to secure a pre-hearing date. The pre-hearing will be used 
to set a timetable for the further process towards a hearing in due course. The parties expect the pre-hearing (once held) to result 
in dates for a hearing being established (along with a timeline for the production of documents such as the Commission’s 
investigative record, discovery, exchange of factual witness statements etc). The Tribunal has not yet reverted on the pre-
hearing date.
We cannot predict the timing of a resolution or the ultimate outcome of the matter. However, the Company and its 
external legal advisers continue to believe that we have consistently adhered to all applicable laws and regulations and that the 
referral from the Commission is without merit. We have therefore currently not made any provisions for this matter.
The Ugandan Value Added Tax (“VAT”) matter 
The Ugandan Revenue Authorities (“URA”) have reviewed MiX Telematics’ cross-border services and assert that 
VAT is payable on these imported services in terms of the place of supply rules included within its local VAT legislation. On 
January 18, 2018, MiX Telematics East Africa Limited (“MiX East Africa”) instituted proceedings in the Tax Appeals Tribunal 
to challenge the URA’s decision on this matter based on the interpretation of the law and calculation errors by the URA. MiX 
East Africa appeared in front of the Tax Appeals Tribunal on a number of occasions to present its defense but the Tax Appeals 
Tribunal ruled in favor of the URA. On September 19, 2019, MiX East Africa appealed the decision to the High Court of 
Uganda. It was noted by the High court that there was an issue regarding the quantum of VAT to be charged by Uganda which 
was not raised. MiX East Africa therefore filed an application to amend the notice of appeal to include this issue. That 
application was heard in January 2021 and the ruling is pending. Provisions have been made based on current information at 
hand.
49

ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURE.
Not applicable.
PART II
ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND 
ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
Market information
The principal market for the ordinary shares of MiX Telematics Limited is the JSE, and the ordinary shares are traded 
under the symbol “MIX”. The Company’s ADSs are listed on the NYSE and are traded under the symbol “MIXT”. BNYM 
serves as depositary with respect to the ADSs.
Holders of record
As of May 27, 2022, there were 1,934 holders of record of our ordinary shares.
Dividends policy
Dividend payments are currently considered on a quarter-by-quarter basis.
Securities authorized for issuance under equity compensation plans
Information regarding our equity compensation plans is incorporated by reference in Item 12 of Part III of this Annual 
Report on Form 10-K.
50

Purchases of equity securities by the issuer and affiliated purchasers
On May 23, 2017, our Board of Directors (“the Board”) approved a share repurchase program of up to R270 million 
(equivalent of $18.6 million as of March 31, 2022) under which the Company could repurchase its ordinary shares, including 
American Depositary Shares (“ADSs”). On December 3, 2021, the Board approved an increase to the share repurchase program 
under which the Company may repurchase ordinary shares, including ADSs. Post this increase, and after giving effect to shares 
already purchased under the program as at December 2, 2021, the Company could repurchase additional shares with a 
cumulative value of R160 million ($10.0 million). The total value of the whole share repurchase program post the December 3, 
2021 increase is R396.5 million ($24.9 million). During fiscal year 2022 shares with a value of R44.7 million (equivalent of 
$3.0 million as of March 31, 2022) were repurchased under the share repurchase program. Additional shares to the value of 
R115.3 million (equivalent of $8.0 million as of March 31, 2022) may still be repurchased.
The Company may repurchase its shares from time to time at its discretion through open market transactions and block 
trades, based on ongoing assessments of the capital needs of the Company, the market price of its securities and general market 
conditions. This share repurchase program may be discontinued at any time by the Board of Directors, and the Company has no 
obligation to repurchase any amount of its securities under the program. The repurchase program will be funded out of existing 
cash resources.
Fiscal year 2018 purchase
During fiscal year 2018 the following purchases had been made under the share repurchase program:
Period
Total number of 
shares 
repurchased
Average price paid 
per share (1) 
R
Shares canceled 
under the share 
repurchase 
program
Total value of shares 
purchased as part of 
publicly announced 
program 
R’000
Maximum value of 
shares that may yet 
be purchased under 
the program 
R’000
Month
June 2017
 
5,015,660 
3.72  
5,015,660  
18,666  
251,334 
 
5,015,660 
 
5,015,660  
18,666  
251,334 
(1)         Including transaction costs.
Table below shows the equivalent U.S Dollar amounts, converted at the average monthly exchange rate for the month 
of the purchase.
Period
Total number of 
shares 
repurchased
Average price paid 
per share (1) 
$
Shares canceled 
under the share 
repurchase 
program
Total value of shares 
purchased as part of 
publicly announced 
program 
$’000
Maximum value of 
shares that may yet 
be purchased under 
the program 
$’000
Month
June 2017
 
5,015,660  
0.29  
5,015,660  
1,447  
19,489 
 
5,015,660 
 
5,015,660  
1,447  
19,489 
(1)         Including transaction costs.
Subsequent to the repurchase, the shares were delisted and now form part of the authorized unissued share capital of the 
Company.
51

Fiscal year 2019 purchase
During fiscal year 2019 the following purchases had been made under the share repurchase program:
Period
Total number of 
shares 
repurchased
Average price paid 
per share (1) 
R
Shares canceled 
under the share 
repurchase 
program
Total value of shares 
purchased as part of 
publicly announced 
program 
R’000
Maximum value of 
shares that may yet 
be purchased under 
the program 
R’000
Month
October 2018
 
9,157,695 
8.03  
9,157,695  
73,548  
177,786 
 
9,157,695 
 
9,157,695  
73,548  
177,786 
(1)         Including transaction costs.
Table below shows the equivalent U.S Dollar amounts, converted at the average monthly exchange rate for the month 
of the purchase.
Period
Total number of 
shares 
repurchased
Average price paid 
per share (1) 
$
Shares canceled 
under the share 
repurchase 
program
Total value of shares 
purchased as part of 
publicly announced 
program 
$’000
Maximum value of 
shares that may yet 
be purchased under 
the program 
$’000
Month
October 2018
 
9,157,695  
0.55  
9,157,695  
5,069  
12,253 
 
9,157,695 
 
9,157,695  
5,069  
12,253 
(1)         Including transaction costs.
Subsequent to the repurchase, the shares were delisted and now form part of the authorized unissued share capital of the 
Company.
Fiscal year 2020 purchase
During fiscal year 2020 the following purchases had been made under the share repurchase program: 
Period
Total number of 
shares 
repurchased
Average price 
paid per share (1) 
R
Shares canceled 
under the share 
repurchase 
program
Total value of shares 
purchased as part of 
publicly announced 
program 
R’000
Maximum value of 
shares that may yet 
be purchased under 
the program 
R’000
Month
July 2019
 
27,500 
8.54  
—  
235  
177,551 
August 2019
 
13,789,250 
8.62  
—  
118,890  
58,661 
December 2019
 
166,615 
7.25  
—  
1,207  
57,454 
January 2020
 
2,850,914 
8.34  
—  
23,766  
33,688 
February 2020
 
21,722 
7.95  
3,039,251  
173  
33,515 
 
16,856,001 
8.54  
3,039,251  
144,271  
33,515 
(1)         Including transaction costs.
52

Table below shows the equivalent U.S Dollar amounts, converted at the average monthly exchange rate for the month 
of the purchase.
Period
Total number of 
shares 
repurchased
Average price 
paid per share (1) 
$
Shares canceled 
under the share 
repurchase 
program
Total value of shares 
purchased as part of 
publicly announced 
program 
$’000
Maximum value of 
shares that may yet 
be purchased under 
the program 
$’000
Month
July 2019
 
27,500  
0.61  
—  
17  
12,634 
August 2019
 
13,789,250  
0.57  
—  
7,859  
3,878 
December 2019
 
166,615  
0.50  
—  
84  
3,984 
January 2020
 
2,850,914  
0.58  
—  
1,655  
2,346 
February 2020
 
21,722  
0.53  
3,039,251  
12  
2,232 
 
16,856,001  
0.58  
3,039,251  
9,627  
2,232 
(1)         Including transaction costs.
Shares repurchased in Q3 2020 and Q4 2020 were delisted in Q4 2020 and now form part of the authorized unissued 
share capital of the Company.
Fiscal year 2021 purchase
There were no purchases during fiscal year 2021 under the share repurchase program.
Fiscal year 2022 purchase
During fiscal year 2022 the following purchases had been made under the share repurchase program: 
Period
Total number of 
shares 
repurchased
Average price 
paid per share (1) 
R
Shares canceled 
under the share 
repurchase 
program
Total value of shares 
purchased as part of 
publicly announced 
program 
R’000
Maximum value of 
shares that may yet 
be purchased under 
the program 
R’000
Month
December 2021
 
1,567,791  
7.52  
—  
11,795  
148,220 
January 2022
 
2,004,618  
7.31  
2,330,135  
14,649  
133,571 
February 2022
 
911,600  
7.56  
—  
6,893  
126,678 
March 2022
 
1,536,076  
7.42  
3,689,950  
11,395  
115,283 
 
6,020,085  
7.43  
6,020,085  
44,732  
115,283 
(1)         Including transaction costs.
Table below shows the equivalent U.S Dollar amounts, converted at the average monthly exchange rate for the month 
of the purchase.
Period
Total number of 
shares 
repurchased
Average price 
paid per share (1) 
$
Shares canceled 
under the share 
repurchase 
program
Total value of shares 
purchased as part of 
publicly announced 
program 
$’000
Maximum value of 
shares that may yet 
be purchased under 
the program 
$’000
Month
December 2021
 
1,567,791  
0.47  
—  
743  
9,332 
January 2022
 
2,004,618  
0.47  
2,330,135  
944  
8,608 
February 2022
 
911,600  
0.50  
—  
453  
8,317 
March 2022
 
1,536,076  
0.49  
3,689,950  
759  
7,684 
 
6,020,085  
0.48  
6,020,085  
2,899  
7,684 
53

(1)         Including transaction costs.
Shares repurchased in Q3 2022 and Q4 2022 were delisted in Q4 2022 and now form part of the authorized unissued 
share capital of the Company. 
54

ITEM 6. RESERVED
55

 ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND 
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
The following discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations should be read in 
conjunction with our consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes included in Item 8 of this annual 
report on Form 10-K.
This discussion contains forward-looking statements that involve risks, uncertainties and assumptions. Our 
future results may vary materially from those indicated as a result of the risks that affect our business, including, among 
others, those identified in “Forward-Looking Statements” and “Item 1A. Risk Factors”.  
Overview
We are a leading global provider of connected fleet and mobile asset solutions delivered as Software as a Service 
(“SaaS”). Our solutions deliver a measurable return by enabling our customers to manage, optimize and protect their 
investments in commercial fleets or personal vehicles. We generate actionable insights that enable a wide range of 
customers, from large enterprise fleets to small fleet operators and consumers, to reduce fuel and other operating costs, 
improve efficiency, enhance regulatory compliance, enhance driver safety, manage risk and mitigate theft. Our solutions 
mostly rely on our proprietary, highly scalable technology platforms, which allow us to collect, analyze and deliver 
information based on data from our customers’ vehicles. Using an intuitive, web-based interface, dashboards or mobile 
apps, our fleet customers can access large volumes of real-time and historical data, monitor the location and status of their 
drivers and vehicles and analyze a wide number of key metrics across their fleet operations. 
We were founded in 1996 and we have offices in South Africa, the United Kingdom, the United States, Uganda, 
Brazil, Australia, Romania and the United Arab Emirates as well as a network of more than 130 fleet value-added 
resellers worldwide. MiX Telematics shares are publicly traded on the Johannesburg Stock Exchange (JSE: MIX) and 
MiX Telematics American Depositary Shares are listed on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE: MIXT).
We derive the majority of our revenues from subscriptions to our fleet and mobile asset management solutions. 
Our subscriptions generally include access to our SaaS solutions, connectivity, and in many cases, use of an in-vehicle 
device. We also generate revenues from the sale of in-vehicle devices, which enable customers to use our subscription-
based solutions, installation services of our in-vehicle-devices and driver training for fleet customers. We generate sales 
through the efforts of our direct sales teams, staffed in our regional sales offices, and through our global network of 
distributors and dealers. Our direct sales teams focus on marketing our fleet solutions to global and multinational 
enterprise accounts and to other large customer accounts located in regions of the world where we maintain a direct sales 
presence. Our direct sales teams have industry expertise across multiple industries, including oil and gas, transportation 
and logistics, government and municipal, bus and coach, rental and leasing, and utilities. In some markets, we rely on a 
network of distributors and dealers to sell our solutions on our behalf. Our distributors and dealers also install our in-
vehicle devices and provide training, technical support and ongoing maintenance for the customers they support.
Impact of COVID-19
We have considered the impact of COVID-19 including its impact on expected credit losses and potential 
goodwill impairments, however numerous uncertainties remain, including the severity of the disease, the duration of the 
outbreak, actions that may be taken by governmental authorities, the impact on our customers and other factors identified 
in Item 1A. “Risk Factors - The extent to which the COVID-19 outbreak and measures taken in response thereto impact 
our business, results of operations and financial condition will depend on future developments, which are highly uncertain 
and are difficult to predict.” in this Form 10-K. 
Business, employees and operations
The majority of our employees have returned to our offices and we have implemented protocols to promote 
social distancing and enhance sanitary measures in our offices and facilities to conform to government restrictions and 
best practices encouraged by governmental and regulatory authorities. 
56

COVID-19 has disrupted the operations of our customers and channel partners, our operations and the results of 
our operations. The nature and extent of the crisis, multiple variants and waves of the virus, the public health measures to 
contain it, the progress and effectiveness of vaccination programs, different levels of restrictions and the resultant 
economic impact may differ between regions and remains uncertain.
Cash resources and liquidity
Based on our internal projections we believe that we have sufficient cash reserves to support us for the 
foreseeable future. Further details on our cash resources and borrowings available under our credit facilities are provided 
in the liquidity and capital resources section below.
Financial position and impairments
We have taken into account the impact of COVID-19, to the extent possible, on our financial statements as of 
reporting date. However, future changes in economic conditions related to COVID-19 could have an impact on future 
estimates and judgements used, particularly those relating to Goodwill sensitivities and impairment assessments, as well 
as expected credit losses. Refer to note 2 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information regarding 
Goodwill sensitivities. We will continue to evaluate the nature and extent of the impact to our business, consolidated 
results of operations, and financial condition.
Key Financial Measures and Operating Metrics
In addition to financial measures based on our consolidated financial statements, we monitor our business 
operations using various financial and non-financial metrics. 
Subscription Revenue
Subscription revenue represents subscription fees for our solutions, which include the use of our SaaS fleet 
management solutions, connectivity, and in many cases, our in-vehicle devices. Our subscription revenue is driven 
primarily by the number of subscribers and the monthly price per subscriber, which varies depending on the services and 
features customers require, hardware options, customer size and geographic location.
In fiscal year 2022 subscription revenue has decreased as a percentage of total revenue due to an increase in 
hardware and other revenue. A key driver of our recent hardware revenue improvement has been the new MiX Vision AI 
solution, which is seeing strong adoption. In fiscal years 2020, 2021 and 2022, subscription revenue represented 87.6%, 
89.3% and 86.2% respectively, of our total revenue. In fiscal years 2020, 2021 and 2022, our top 10 customers 
represented 23.7%, 21.8% and 16.6% respectively, of our subscription revenue.
Subscribers
Subscribers represent the total number of discrete services we provide to customers at the end of the period. 
 
Fiscal Year Ended March 31,
 
2020
2021
2022
Subscribers
 
818,487  
744,677  
815,165 
Factors Affecting Our Performance
Level of Subscription Revenue and Hardware Revenue
In fiscal year 2022 subscription revenue has decreased as a percentage of total revenue due to an increase in 
hardware and other revenue. In fiscal year 2022, subscription-based revenues accounted for 86.2% of our total revenues, 
down from 89.3% in 2021 and 87.6% in 2020.  
We believe that we are well positioned to grow our base of subscribers, by adding both fully-bundled 
subscriptions; subscriptions where the hardware has been purchased upfront and various add-on solutions that can drive 
incremental average revenue per user (“ARPU”) expansion over time. We intend to maintain our investment in sales and 
marketing and continue to attract new subscribers by introducing attractive new features and services. 
57

Additionally, we believe we have the opportunity to expand our fleet management market share among our 
existing customer base by demonstrating our value proposition, growing with the customer, introducing new and 
innovative value-added solutions and displacing legacy fleet management solutions. 
Fluctuations in Exchange Rates
Revenue from our international operations has historically represented a substantial portion of our total revenue. 
Accordingly, changes in exchange rates, and in particular a strengthening of the U.S. Dollar, will negatively affect our 
reported income and expenses as expressed in U.S. Dollars (our reporting currency). The South African Rand is the 
functional currency for the Company. Currency fluctuations in the South African Rand may positively or negatively 
impact our reported income and expenses due to the effects of translating the functional currency of our foreign 
subsidiaries into Rand at different average exchange rates and then translating into our reporting currency of U.S. Dollars.  
In fiscal year 2022, the Rand strengthened by 9.2% against the U.S. Dollar and by 5.0% against the British 
Pound, as shown in the table below.
Average exchange rate for Fiscal Year 
Ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
South African Rand for U.S. Dollars (per $1.00)
14.78
16.37
14.86
% movement
 7.5 %
 10.8 %
 (9.2) %
South African Rand for British Pound (per £1.00)
18.78
21.35
20.29
% movement
 4.2 %
 13.7 %
 (5.0) %
We expect continued exchange rate volatility in the South African Rand against other major currencies. The 
South African Rand has been even more volatile due to the uncertain economic conditions in South Africa, the war in 
Ukraine and sanctions against Russia. As of June 10, 2022, the South African Rand/U.S. Dollar exchange rate was 15.66, 
5.4% higher than the average exchange rate for fiscal year 2022. 
Mix of Subscribers with Different Revenue and Cost Economics
We offer services to a wide range of customers, from large enterprise vehicle fleets to small fleet operators and 
consumers. The subscription revenue and cost per subscriber and the subscriber retention pattern differ by type of 
subscriber. For example, our entry-level consumer solution, Beam-e, is characterized by lower revenue and lower cost per 
subscriber compared to our large enterprise solutions. Small fleet and consumer customers will enter into and terminate 
contracts much more frequently than our enterprise customers, thereby affecting subscriber retention. As the mix of our 
subscriber base evolves, the average revenue per subscriber and average cost per subscriber is likely to change.
Varying Economic Conditions in our Markets
We seek to capitalize on opportunities and manage risks in our key markets, which are geographically dispersed 
with subscribers located in more than 120 countries worldwide. Overall, we believe that our presence across multiple 
geographic markets and our exposure to multiple economies provides us with diversification from the risk of changing 
economic conditions in any one country or region. Other macroeconomic factors, such as expectations for future crude oil 
and natural gas prices, affect our customers’ spending habits. Prolonged or substantial declines in crude oil and/or natural 
gas prices, or the perception that such prices will decrease in the future, negatively impacts our net subscriber growth and 
hardware sales in this sector. In addition to macroeconomic changes, performance in any given region may vary due to 
multiple factors, including growth in subscribers, the overall profile of the customer base (for example, in Africa, we have 
a significant consumer subscriber base), the services and hardware options selected by particular subscribers and our 
distribution strategy in the region. 
Changes in regional conditions require management to formulate strategic responses that safeguard our financial 
position and maintain our balanced approach to producing revenue growth, profitability and cash flow. 
Changing Customer Needs and Ongoing Investment in Technology
We continuously analyze market trends and opportunities in the various geographies in which we operate and 
have identified an opportunity to increase subscription revenue growth by the addition of new products and services in 
certain of the regions in which we operate. Our investment in software development is core to our business strategy. Our 
58

software teams employ an agile software development methodology. We have made a significant investment in product 
development, and we have routinely been among the first to market with innovative solutions and features that cater to the 
needs of our customers. For example, major updates to the MiX Vision solution were made in fiscal year 2021 and MiX 
Vision AI was launched in fiscal year 2022.
Long Sales Cycle for Our Enterprise Fleet Management Solutions
From period to period, our revenues may fluctuate depending upon the customer contracts we have secured. The 
typical sales cycle for large enterprise fleet management solutions contracts may be long, especially in comparison to the 
sales cycle for our consumer solutions. It may also be difficult for us to predict the timing of when we will enter into 
enterprise fleet management contracts.
Longer sales cycles for large contracts, for both customers who purchase in-vehicle devices and those who opt 
for the fully bundled option, may affect the comparability of financial results in certain segments. Our revenue may 
fluctuate from period to period depending on the level and timing of hardware sales, while subscription revenue growth is 
also impacted by the timing of the rollout of large enterprise fleets. We are focused on mitigating these long sales cycles 
and the associated volatility by enhancing our sales pipeline management process, by increasing our sales and marketing 
investment levels across all geographical segments and by diversifying our customer segment focus. 
Investment in Sales and Marketing
We offer our solutions in over 120 countries through a combination of our direct and indirect marketing efforts. 
Our sales and marketing strategy is segmented by geographic region and customer type in order to cost effectively target 
and acquire new customers. In certain regions, we sell subscriptions of our fleet management solutions to large enterprise 
fleets through our direct sales force. In other regions, and for sales to small fleet operators and consumers, we work with 
an extensive distribution network of regional partners and national distribution dealers. Through our central services 
organization headquartered in South Africa, we provide optimized marketing, product management, technical and 
distribution support to each of our regional sales and marketing operations. We continue to focus on growth and expect to 
continue to invest in sales and marketing to grow our customer base and to expand within existing customers. 
Basis of Presentation and Key Components of Our Results of Operations
In fiscal year 2022, we managed our business in six segments which include Africa, Americas, Brazil, Europe 
and the Middle East and Australasia (our regional sales offices (“RSOs”)), and our central services organization (“CSO”). 
CSO is the central services organization that wholesales products and services to RSOs which, in turn, interface with our 
end-customers, distributors and dealers. CSO is also responsible for the development of hardware and software platforms 
and provides common marketing, product management, technical and distribution support to each of the other reportable 
segments. CSO is a reportable segment because it produces discrete financial information which is reviewed by the chief 
operating decision maker (“CODM”) and has the ability to generate external revenues.
The CODM has been identified as the Chief Executive Officer who makes strategic decisions. The performance 
of the reportable segments has been measured and evaluated by the CODM using Segment Adjusted EBITDA, which is a 
measure that uses income before income tax expense excluding net interest income/expense, net foreign exchange gains/
losses, net loss/profit on sale of property, plant and equipment, depreciation, amortization, operating lease costs, stock-
based compensation costs, restructuring costs, legal costs associated with patent infringement, gains or losses on the 
disposal or impairments of long-lived assets and corporate and consolidation entries. Product development costs are 
capitalized and amortized and this amortization is excluded from Segment Adjusted EBITDA. The adjusted EBITDA 
definition has been updated also to exclude legal costs relating to a patent infringement matter that arose during fiscal year 
2022.
In determining Segment Adjusted EBITDA, the margin generated by CSO, net of any unrealized intercompany 
profit, is allocated to the geographic region where the external revenue is recorded by our RSOs. The costs remaining in 
CSO relate mainly to research and development of hardware and software platforms, common marketing, product 
management and technical and distribution support to each of the RSOs.
Each RSO’s results reflect the external revenue earned, as well as the Segment Adjusted EBITDA earned (or loss 
incurred) before the remaining CSO and corporate costs allocations. Segment assets are not disclosed because such 
information is not reviewed by the CODM. 
59

Revenue
The majority of our revenue is subscription-based. Consequently, growth in subscribers influences our 
subscription revenue growth. However, other factors, including, but not limited to, the types of new subscribers we add 
and the timing of entry into subscription contracts also play a significant role. The price and terms of our customer 
subscription contracts vary based on a number of factors, including fleet size, hardware options, geographic region and 
distribution channel. In addition, we derive revenue from the sale of in-vehicle devices, which are used to collect, generate 
and transmit the data used to enable our SaaS solutions. 
Our customer contracts typically have a three to five year initial term. Following the initial term, most fleet 
customers elect to renew for fixed terms ranging from one to five years. Our third party dealers are typically billed 
monthly based on active connections. Some of our customer agreements, including our consumer subscriptions, provide 
for automatic monthly or yearly renewals unless the customer elects not to renew its subscription. Our consumer customer 
contracts in South Africa are governed by the Consumer Protection Act, which allows customers to cancel without paying 
the full balance of the contract amount. Our fleet contracts and our customer contracts outside of South Africa are 
generally non-cancellable.
Cost of Revenue and Gross Margin
Cost of revenue associated with our subscription revenue consists primarily of costs related to cellular 
communications, infrastructure hosting, third-party data providers, service contract maintenance costs, commission 
expense related to third party dealers or distributors (commission is capitalized and amortized, on a straight-line basis, 
unless the amortization period is 12 months or less) and depreciation of our capitalized installed in-vehicle devices. Cost 
of sales associated with our hardware revenue includes the cost of the in-vehicle devices, cost of hardware warranty, 
shipping costs, custom duties, and commission expense related to third party dealers or distributors. We capitalize the cost 
of in-vehicle devices utilized to service customers, for customers selecting our bundled option, and we depreciate these 
costs from the date of installation over their expected useful lives.
We expect that cost of revenue as a percentage of revenue will vary from period to period depending on our 
revenue mix, including the proportion of our revenue attributable to our subscription-based services. Subscription revenue 
generates a higher gross profit margin than hardware and other revenue. The majority of the other components of our cost 
of revenue are variable and are affected by the number of subscribers, the composition of our subscriber base, and the 
number of new subscriptions sold in the period.
Operating Expenses
Sales and Marketing
Sales and marketing expenses consist primarily of salaries and wages to sales and marketing employees, 
commissions paid to employees, travel-related expenses, and advertising and promotional costs. We pay our sales 
employees commissions based on achieving subscription targets and we capitalize commission and amortize it (unless the 
amortization period is 12 months or less). Advertising costs consist primarily of costs for print, radio, television and 
digital advertising, search engine optimization, promotions, public relations, customer events, tradeshows and 
sponsorships. We expense advertising costs as incurred. We plan to continue to invest in sales and marketing in order to 
grow our sales and build brand and category awareness. 
Administration and Other Charges
Administration and other charges consist primarily of salaries and wages for administrative staff, travel costs, 
professional fees (including audit and legal fees), real estate leasing costs, expensed research and development costs and 
depreciation of fixed assets including vehicles and office equipment and amortization of intangible assets. We expect that 
administration and other charges will increase in absolute terms as we continue to grow our business. 
Research and Development
For additional disclosures in respect of research and development, technology and intellectual property please 
refer to “Item 1. Business”.
60

Taxes
In fiscal years 2020, 2021 and 2022 our effective tax rates were 47.2%, 15.3% and 33.1% respectively, compared 
to a South African statutory rate of 28%. Taxation mainly consists of normal statutory income tax paid or payable and 
deferred tax on any temporary differences.  
Our effective tax rate may vary primarily according to the mix of profits made in various jurisdictions and the 
impact of certain non-deductible/non-taxable foreign exchange movements, net of tax. As a result, significant variances in 
future periods may occur. A reconciliation of the actual tax rate to the South African tax rate of 28% is disclosed in note 
11 to the consolidated financial statements. 
61

Results of operations
The following table sets forth certain consolidated statements of income data:
For the year ended March 31, 
2020
2021
2022
(In thousands)
Total revenue
$ 
145,650 $ 
126,894 $ 
143,294 
Total cost of revenue
 
53,015  
43,865  
51,859 
Gross profit
 
92,635  
83,029  
91,435 
Sales and marketing
 
13,324  
11,344  
15,436 
Administration and other
 
58,263  
53,487  
61,550 
Income from operations
 
21,048  
18,198  
14,449 
Other expense
 
299  
897  
574 
Net interest income/(expense)
 
67  
(72)  
(510) 
Income tax expense
 
9,829  
2,634  
4,418 
Net income
 
10,987  
14,595  
8,947 
Less: Net income attributable to non-controlling interest
 
—  
—  
— 
Net income attributable to MiX Telematics Limited
$ 
10,987 $ 
14,595 $ 
8,947 
The following sets forth, as a percentage of revenue, consolidated statements of income data:
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
(Percentage)
Total revenue
 100.0 %
 100.0 %
 100.0 %
Total cost of revenue
 36.4 
 34.6 
 36.2 
Gross profit
 63.6 
 65.4 
 63.8 
Sales and marketing
 9.1 
 8.9 
 10.8 
Administration and other
 40.0 
 42.2 
 43.0 
Income from operations
 14.5 
 14.3 
 10.1 
Other expense
 0.2 
 0.7 
 0.4 
Net interest income/(expense)
 — 
 (0.1) 
 (0.4) 
Income tax expense
 6.7 
 2.0 
 3.1 
Net income
 7.5 
 11.5 
 6.2 
Less: Net income attributable to non-controlling interest
 — 
 — 
 — 
Net income attributable to MiX Telematics Limited
 7.5 
 11.5 
 6.2 
62

Results of Operations for Fiscal Year 2021 Compared to Fiscal Year 2022
Revenue
For the year ended March 31,
2021
2022
% Change
% Change at 
constant 
currency
(In thousands, except for percentages)
Subscription revenue
$ 
113,351 
$ 
123,573 
 9.0 %
 2.8 %
Hardware and other revenue
 
13,543 
 
19,721 
 45.6 %
 41.2 %
$ 
126,894 
$ 
143,294 
 12.9 %
 6.9 %
Our total revenue increased by $16.4 million or 12.9%, from fiscal year 2021 to fiscal year 2022. The principal 
factors affecting our revenue growth included:                 
•
Subscription revenue increased by 9.0% to $123.6 million, compared to $113.4 million for fiscal year 2021. 
Subscription revenue represented 86.2% of our total revenue for fiscal year 2022 compared to 89.3% for the prior 
year. Subscription revenues increased by 2.8% on a constant currency basis, year over year. During fiscal year 
2022, our subscriber base grew by a net 70,500 subscribers to 815,200 subscribers at March 31, 2022.  
The majority of our revenues and subscription revenues are derived from currencies other than the U.S. Dollar. 
Accordingly, the weakening of the U.S. Dollar against these currencies (in particular against the South African 
Rand) following currency volatility, has positively impacted our revenue and subscription revenues reported in 
U.S. Dollars. Compared to fiscal year 2021, the South African Rand strengthened by 9% against the U.S. Dollar. 
The Rand/U.S. Dollar exchange rate averaged R14.86 in fiscal year 2022 compared to an average of R16.37 
during fiscal year 2021. The impact of translating foreign currencies to U.S. Dollars at the average exchange 
rates during fiscal year 2022 led to a 6.2% increase in reported U.S. Dollar subscription revenues. 
•
Hardware and other revenue increased by $6.2 million, or 45.6%, from fiscal year 2021 to fiscal year 2022. Our 
fiscal year 2022 hardware revenue strength has been due to the new MiX Vision AI solution, which is seeing 
strong adoption, as well as the improvement in trading conditions in line with economic recovery from the 
pandemic.
The impact of translating foreign currencies to U.S. Dollars at the average exchange rates during fiscal year 2022 
led to a 6.0% increase in reported U.S. Dollar revenues.
A breakdown of third party revenue by segment is shown in the table below:
 
For the Year Ended March 31,
 
2021
2022
2021
2022
2021
2022
 
(In thousands)
Total Revenue
Subscription Revenue
Hardware and other 
revenue
Africa
$ 
67,948 $ 
83,176 $ 
62,453 $ 
74,778 $ 
5,495 $ 
8,398 
Americas
 
18,981  
15,574  
18,211  
14,036  
770  
1,538 
Middle East and Australasia
 
21,237  
22,554  
16,558  
16,950  
4,679  
5,604 
Europe
 
14,579  
17,254  
12,138  
13,509  
2,441  
3,745 
Brazil
 
4,064  
4,654  
3,922  
4,253  
142  
401 
CSO
 
85  
82  
69  
47  
16  
35 
Total
$ 
126,894 $ 
143,294 $ 
113,351 $ 
123,573 $ 
13,543 $ 
19,721 
63

In the Africa segment, subscription revenue increased by $12.3 million or 19.7%. On a constant currency basis, 
the increase in subscription revenue was 9.5% as a result of a 10.6% increase in subscribers since April 1, 2021. Hardware 
and other revenue increased by $2.9 million or 52.8%. Total revenue increased by $15.2 million or 22.4%. On a constant 
currency basis, total revenue growth was 12.4%. 
In the Americas segment, subscription revenue declined by $4.2 million or 22.9% despite a 8.1% increase in 
subscribers since April 1, 2021. Included in fiscal year 2021 subscription revenue reported was a once off contract 
modification fee of $1.1 million, pertaining to the reduction of existing subscriber contracts of a major energy sector 
customer following a reduction of their fleet due to prevailing economic conditions. Hardware and other revenue 
increased by $0.8 million or 99.7%. Total revenue declined by $3.4 million or 18.0%.
 Subscription revenue in the Middle East and Australasia segment increased by $0.4 million or 2.4%. On a 
constant currency basis, the increase in subscription revenue was 0.5%. Subscribers increased by 3.5% since April 1, 
2021. Hardware and other revenue increased by $0.9 million or 19.8%. Total revenue increased by $1.3 million or 6.2%. 
Total revenue in constant currency increased by 4.1%.
In the Europe segment, subscription revenue increased by $1.4 million or 11.3%. On a constant currency basis, 
the growth in subscription revenue was 9.9%. Subscribers increased by 10.0% since April 1, 2021. Hardware and other 
revenues increased by $1.3 million or 53.4%. Total revenue increased by $2.7 million or 18.4%. On a constant currency 
basis total revenue growth was 16.9%.  
In the Brazil segment, subscription revenue increased by $0.3 million or 8.4%. On a constant currency basis, 
subscription revenue increased by 7.2%. Subscribers increased by 4.4% since April 1, 2021. Hardware and other revenue 
increased by $0.3 million or 182.4%. Total revenue increased by $0.6 million or 14.5%. On a constant currency basis, 
total revenue increased by 13.2%.
Cost of Revenue and Gross Margin
For the year ended March 31,
2021
2022
(In thousands, except for 
percentages)
Cost of revenue - subscription
$ 
33,414 
$ 
36,683 
Cost of revenue - hardware and other
 
10,451 
 
15,176 
Gross profit
$ 
83,029 
$ 
91,435 
Gross profit margin 
 65.4 %
 63.8 %
Gross profit margin - subscription
 70.5 %
 70.3 %
Gross profit margin - hardware and other
 22.8 %
 23.0 %
Compared to an increase in total revenue of $16.4 million or 12.9%, cost of revenues increased by $8.0 million 
or 18.2%, from fiscal year 2021 to fiscal year 2022. This, together with the higher levels of hardware and other revenue, 
resulted in a lower gross profit margin of 63.8% in fiscal year 2022 compared to 65.4% in fiscal year 2021.
Subscription revenue, which generates a higher gross profit margin than hardware and other revenue, contributed 
86.2% of total revenue in fiscal year 2022 compared to 89.3% in fiscal year 2021. 
During fiscal year 2022, hardware and other margins were higher than in fiscal year 2021, mainly due to the 
geographical sales mix and the distribution channels. Hardware sales via our dealer channel and the MiX Vision AI attract 
lower gross margins. 
64

Sales and Marketing  
For the year ended March 31,
2021
2022
(In thousands, except for 
percentages)
Sales and marketing
$ 
11,344 
$ 
15,436 
As a percentage of revenue
 8.9 %
 10.8 %
Sales and marketing costs increased by $4.1 million, or 36.1%, from fiscal year 2021 to fiscal year 2022 against a 
12.9% increase in total revenue. The increase in fiscal year 2022 was primarily as a result of increases of $1.9 million in 
advertising costs, $1.5 million in employee costs, $0.2 million in bonuses, $0.2 million in travel costs and other increases 
of $0.3 million, none of which were individually significant. In fiscal year 2022, sales and marketing costs represented 
10.8% of revenue compared to 8.9% of revenue in fiscal year 2021. 
Administration and Other Expenses
For the year ended March 31,
2021
2022
(In thousands, except for 
percentages)
Administration and other
$ 
53,487 
$ 
61,550 
As a percentage of revenue
 42.2 %
 43.0 %
Administration and other expenses increased by $8.1 million, or 15.1%, from fiscal year 2021 to fiscal year 
2022.
The increase mainly relates to increases of $3.4 million in salaries and wages, $1.2 million in bonuses, $0.8 
million in information & technology costs, $2.3 million in professional fees (including $0.6 million in legal costs 
associated with patent infringement), $0.6 million in training and recruitment costs, increases in expected credit loss 
provision of $0.9 million, offset by $0.9 million saving due to restructuring costs and other decreases of $0.2 million, 
none of which were individually significant.
 
Taxation
For the year ended March 31,
2021
2022
(In thousands, except for 
percentages)
Income tax expense
$ 
2,634 
$ 
4,418 
Effective tax rate
 15.3 %
 33.1 %
Income tax expense increased by 67.7%. Our effective tax rate increased by 17.8% to 33.1% in fiscal year 2022. 
A reconciliation of our effective tax rate to the South African corporate tax rate of 28% for both fiscal years 2022 and 
2021, is presented in note 11 to the consolidated financial statements. In fiscal year 2022 the effective tax rate decreased 
by 3.1% as a result of certain non-taxable foreign exchange movements on intercompany loans which have led to deferred 
tax charges being recognized in the consolidated statements of income. In fiscal year 2021 non-taxable foreign exchange 
differences decreased the tax rate by 19.7%.
65

Results of Operations for Fiscal Year 2020 Compared to Fiscal Year 2021
Revenue
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
% Change
% Change at 
constant 
currency
(In thousands, except for percentages)
Subscription revenue
$ 
127,570 
$ 
113,351 
 (11.1) %
 (6.1) %
Hardware and other revenue
 
18,080 
 
13,543 
 (25.1) %
 (23.8) %
$ 
145,650 
$ 
126,894 
 (12.9) %
 (8.3) %
Our total revenue decreased by $18.8 million or 12.9%, from fiscal year 2020 to fiscal year 2021. The principal 
factors affecting our revenue contraction included:                 
•
Subscription revenue decreased by 11.1% to $113.4 million, compared to $127.6 million for fiscal year 2020. 
Subscription revenue represented 89.3% of our total revenue for fiscal year 2021 compared to 87.6% for the prior 
year. Subscription revenues decreased by 6.1% on a constant currency basis, year over year. The decline in 
constant currency subscription revenue was primarily due to the contraction in our subscriber base as a result of 
economic conditions attributable to the COVID-19 pandemic. During fiscal year 2021, our subscriber base 
contracted by 73,800 subscribers to 744,700 subscribers at March 31, 2021. We experienced fleet contraction in 
a number of key verticals such as the oil and gas vertical, consumer vertical and leasing vertical which impacted 
both our subscriber-count and subscription revenue line, the contraction is mainly attributable to our low ARPU 
asset tracking subscribers. 
The majority of our revenues and subscription revenues are derived from currencies other than the U.S. Dollar. 
Accordingly, the strengthening of the U.S. Dollar against these currencies (in particular against the South African 
Rand) following currency volatility arising from the economic disruption caused by COVID-19, has negatively 
impacted our revenue and subscription revenues reported in U.S. Dollars. Compared to fiscal year 2020, the 
South African Rand weakened by 11% against the U.S. Dollar. The Rand/U.S. Dollar exchange rate averaged 
R16.37 in fiscal year 2021 compared to an average of R14.78 during fiscal year 2020. The impact of translating 
foreign currencies to U.S. Dollars at the average exchange rates during fiscal year 2021 led to a 5.0% reduction 
in reported U.S. Dollar subscription revenues. 
•
Hardware and other revenue decreased by $4.5 million, or 25.1%, from fiscal year 2020 to fiscal year 2021 
primarily as a result of a global economic slowdown following the disruption caused by the COVID-19 
pandemic. As shown in the table below, hardware and other revenue was lower across all geographical segments.
The impact of translating foreign currencies to U.S. Dollars at the average exchange rates during fiscal year 2021 
led to a 4.6% reduction in reported U.S. Dollar revenues.
A breakdown of third party revenue by segment is shown in the table below:
 
For the Year Ended March 31,
 
2020
2021
2020
2021
2020
2021
 
(In thousands)
Total Revenue
Subscription Revenue
Hardware and other 
revenue
Africa
$ 
76,756 $ 
67,948 $ 
70,886 $ 
62,453 $ 
5,870 $ 
5,495 
Americas
 
24,529  
18,981  
22,322  
18,211  
2,207  
770 
Middle East and Australasia
 
23,130  
21,237  
17,389  
16,558  
5,741  
4,679 
Europe
 
15,027  
14,579  
11,682  
12,138  
3,345  
2,441 
Brazil
 
5,795  
4,064  
5,181  
3,922  
614  
142 
CSO
 
413  
85  
110  
69  
303  
16 
Total
$ 
145,650 $ 
126,894 $ 
127,570 $ 
113,351 $ 
18,080 $ 
13,543 
66

In the Africa segment, subscription revenue decreased by $8.4 million or 11.9%. On a constant currency basis, 
the contraction in subscription revenue was 3.4% as a result of a 10.1% decrease in subscribers since April 1, 2020. 
Hardware and other revenue decreased by $0.4 million or 6.4%. Total revenue decreased by $8.8 million or 11.5%. On a 
constant currency basis, total revenue contraction was 3.1%. 
In the Americas segment, subscription revenue declined by $4.1 million or 18.4% as a result of both a 27.7% 
decrease in subscribers since April 1, 2020 and as a result of economic conditions in the oil and gas vertical. Included in 
fiscal year 2021 subscription revenue reported above is revenue of $1.1 million pertaining to the reduction of existing 
subscriber contracts of a significant energy sector customer, following a reduction of their fleet due to current economic 
conditions. Hardware and other revenue declined by $1.4 million or 65.1%. Total revenue declined by $5.5 million or 
22.6%.
Subscription revenue in the Middle East and Australasia segment declined by $0.8 million or 4.8%. On a 
constant currency basis, the decline in subscription revenue was 7.2%. Subscribers decreased by 1.8% since April 1, 2020. 
Hardware and other revenue declined by $1.1 million or 18.5%. Total revenue declined by $1.9 million or 8.2%. Total 
revenue in constant currency declined by 10.7%.
In the Europe segment, subscription revenue growth was $0.5 million or 3.9%. On a constant currency basis, the 
growth in subscription revenue was 0.3%. Subscribers increased by 0.5% since April 1, 2020. Total revenue decreased by 
$0.4 million or 3.0%, due to a decrease in hardware and other revenues of $0.9 million compared to fiscal year 2020. 
Total revenue decreased by 6.4% on a constant currency basis.  
In the Brazil segment, subscription revenue declined by $1.3 million or 24.3%. On a constant currency basis, 
subscription revenue decreased by 0.5%. Subscribers increased by 3.9% since April 1, 2020 which was offset by pricing 
concessions granted to customers as a result of economic conditions attributable to the COVID-19 pandemic. Hardware 
and other revenue declined by $0.5 million or 76.9%. Total revenue declined by $1.7 million or 29.9%. On a constant 
currency basis, total revenue decreased by 7.8%.
Cost of Revenue and Gross Margin
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
(In thousands, except for 
percentages)
Cost of revenue - subscription
$ 
39,828 
$ 
33,414 
Cost of revenue - hardware and other
 
13,187 
 
10,451 
Gross profit
$ 
92,635 
$ 
83,029 
Gross profit margin 
 63.6 %
 65.4 %
Gross profit margin - subscription
 68.8 %
 70.5 %
Gross profit margin - hardware and other
 27.1 %
 22.8 %
Compared to a decrease in total revenue of $18.8 million or 12.9%, cost of revenues decreased by $9.2 million or 
17.3%, from fiscal year 2020 to fiscal year 2021. 
Subscription revenue, which generates a higher gross profit margin than hardware and other revenue, contributed 
89.3% of total revenue in fiscal year 2021 compared to 87.6% in fiscal year 2020. Fiscal year 2020 included $2.0 million 
in-vehicle device accelerated depreciation which resulted in an increased subscription revenue margin in fiscal year 2021 
compared to fiscal year 2020.
During fiscal year 2021, hardware and other margins were lower than in fiscal year 2021, mainly due to the 
geographical sales mix and the distribution channels. Hardware sales via our dealer channel attract lower gross margins. 
67

Sales and Marketing  
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
(In thousands, except for 
percentages)
Sales and marketing
$ 
13,324 
$ 
11,344 
As a percentage of revenue
 9.1 %
 8.9 %
Sales and marketing costs decreased by $2.0 million, or 14.9%, from fiscal year 2020 to fiscal year 2021 against 
a 12.9% decrease in total revenue. The decrease in fiscal year 2021 was primarily as a result of savings of $1.0 million in 
employee costs, $0.7 million in travel costs and other decreases of $0.3 million, none of which were individually 
significant. In fiscal year 2021, sales and marketing costs represented 8.9% of revenue compared to 9.1% of revenue in 
fiscal year 2020. 
Administration and Other Expenses
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
(In thousands, except for 
percentages)
Administration and other
$ 
58,263 
$ 
53,487 
As a percentage of revenue
 40.0 %
 42.2 %
Administration and other expenses decreased by $4.8 million, or 8.2%, from fiscal year 2020 to fiscal year 2021.
The decrease mainly relates to savings of $4.1 million in salaries and wages, travel costs of $0.8 million and 
decreases in expected credit loss provision of $1.0 million, offset by restructuring costs of $1.1 million.
 
Taxation
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
(In thousands, except for 
percentages)
Income tax expense
$ 
9,829 
$ 
2,634 
Effective tax rate
 47.2 %
 15.3 %
Income tax expense decreased by 73.2%. Our effective tax rate decreased by 31.9% to 15.3% in fiscal year 2021. 
A reconciliation of our effective tax rate to the South African corporate tax rate of 28% for both fiscal years 2021 and 
2020, is presented in note 11 to the consolidated financial statements. In fiscal year 2021 the effective tax rate decreased 
by 19.7% as a result of certain non-taxable foreign exchange movements on intercompany loans which have led to 
deferred tax charges being recognized in the consolidated statements of income. In fiscal year 2020 non-deductible 
foreign exchange differences increased the tax rate by 19.6%.
Inflation Risk
We do not believe that inflation had a material effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations 
in the last three fiscal years. Current economic projections remain uncertain as a result of the COVID-19 pandemic 
sweeping around the world, a sudden and sharp surge in global inflation mainly as a result of global supply chain 
constraints, global politics, sanctions and the impact thereof on global trade. If our costs were to become subject to 
significant inflationary pressures, we may not be able to fully offset these higher costs through price increases. Our 
inability to do so could harm our business, financial condition and results of operations. Refer to Item 1A. “Risk Factors” 
for further information regarding inflation risk.
68

Non-GAAP Financial Measures  
We use certain measures to assess the financial performance of our business. Certain of these measures are 
termed “non-GAAP measures” because they exclude amounts that are included in, or include amounts that are excluded 
from, the most directly comparable measure calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP, or are calculated using 
financial measures that are not calculated in accordance with GAAP. These non-GAAP measures include adjusted 
EBITDA, adjusted EBITDA margin, adjusted net income, adjusted net income per share, free cash flow and constant 
currency information.
An explanation of the relevance of each of the non-GAAP measures, a reconciliation of the non-GAAP 
measures to the most directly comparable measures calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP and a discussion 
of their limitations is set out below. We do not regard these non-GAAP measures as a substitute for, or superior to, the 
equivalent measures calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP or those calculated using financial measures that 
are calculated in accordance with GAAP. 
Adjusted EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA Margin
Adjusted EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA margin are two of the profit measures reviewed by the CODM. We 
define adjusted EBITDA as income before income taxes, net interest income/expense, net foreign exchange gains/losses, 
depreciation of property, plant and equipment including capitalized customer in-vehicle devices, amortization of 
intangible assets including capitalized internal-use software development costs and intangible assets identified as part of a 
business combination, stock-based compensation costs, restructuring costs, legal costs associated with patent infringement 
and profits/losses on the disposal or impairments of assets or subsidiaries. The adjusted EBITDA definition has been 
updated also to exclude legal costs relating to a patent infringement matter that arose during fiscal year 2022. We define 
adjusted EBITDA margin as adjusted EBITDA divided by total revenue. 
We have included adjusted EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA margin in this Annual Report on Form 10-K because 
they are key measures that our management and Board of Directors use to understand and evaluate our core operating 
performance and trends; to prepare and approve its annual budget; and to develop short and long-term operational plans. 
In particular, the exclusion of certain expenses in calculating adjusted EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA margin can provide 
a useful measure for period-to-period comparisons of the Company’s core business. Accordingly, we believe that adjusted 
EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA margin provide useful information to investors and others in understanding and 
evaluating our operating results. 
A reconciliation of net income (the most directly comparable financial measure presented in accordance with 
GAAP) to adjusted EBITDA for the periods shown is presented below.
Reconciliation of net income to adjusted EBITDA for the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
(In thousands)
Net income
$ 
10,987 
$ 
14,595 
$ 
8,947 
Plus: Income tax expense
 
9,829 
 
2,634 
 
4,418 
(Less)/plus: Net interest (income)/expense
 
(67) 
 
72 
 
510 
Plus: Foreign exchange losses
 
610 
 
959 
 
648 
Plus: Depreciation (1)
 
16,149 
 
12,878 
 
10,693 
Plus: Amortization (2)
 
3,823 
 
3,681 
 
4,258 
Plus: Impairment of long-lived assets
 
6 
 
8 
 
47 
Plus: Stock-based compensation costs
 
660 
 
1,273 
 
1,325 
(Less)/plus: Net (profit)/loss on sale of property, plant and equipment
 
(270) 
 
13 
 
(36) 
(Less)/plus: Restructuring costs
 
(1) 
 
1,055 
 
164 
Plus: Legal costs associated with patent infringement
 
— 
 
— 
 
591 
Adjusted EBITDA
$ 
41,726 
$ 
37,168 
$ 
31,565 
Adjusted EBITDA margin
 28.6 %
 29.3 %
 22.0 %
(1)    Includes depreciation of owned equipment (including in-vehicle devices). 
(2)    Includes amortization of intangible assets (including intangible assets identified as part of a business combination).
69

Our use of adjusted EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA margin have limitations as analytical tools, and should not 
be considered as performance measures in isolation from, or as a substitute for, analysis of our results as reported under 
GAAP. 
Some of these limitations are:
•
although depreciation and amortization are non-cash charges, the assets being depreciated and amortized may 
have to be replaced in the future, and adjusted EBITDA does not reflect cash capital expenditure requirements 
for such replacements or for new capital expenditure requirements;
•
Adjusted EBITDA does not reflect changes in, or cash requirements for, our working capital needs;
•
Adjusted EBITDA does not consider the potentially dilutive impact of equity-based compensation;
•
Adjusted EBITDA does not reflect tax payments that may represent a reduction in cash available to us; 
•
other companies, including companies in our industry, may calculate adjusted EBITDA differently, which 
reduces its usefulness as a comparative measure; and
•
certain of the adjustments (such as restructuring costs, impairment of long-lived assets and others) made in 
calculating adjusted EBITDA are those that management believes are not representative of our underlying 
operations and, therefore, are subjective in nature.
Because of these limitations, adjusted EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA margin should be considered alongside 
other financial performance measures, including income from operations, net income and our other results.
Adjusted Net Income 
Adjusted net income is defined as net income excluding net foreign exchange gains/losses net of tax.
Reconciliation of net income to adjusted net income
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
(In thousands)
Net income
$ 
10,987 
$ 14,595 
$ 
8,947 
Net foreign exchange losses
 
610 
 
959 
 
648 
Income tax effect of net foreign exchange losses
 
4,028 
 
(3,657) 
 
(563) 
Adjusted net income
$ 
15,625 
$ 11,897 
$ 
9,032 
Basic and Diluted Adjusted Net Income per share
Adjusted net income per share is defined as adjusted net income divided by the weighted average number of 
ordinary shares in issue during the period.
We have included adjusted net income per share in this Annual Report because it provides a useful measure for 
period-to-period comparisons of our core business by excluding net foreign exchange gains/losses net of tax and 
associated tax consequences from earnings. Accordingly, we believe that adjusted net income per share provides useful 
information to investors and others in understanding and evaluating our operating results.
70

Reconciliation of net income to adjusted net income per share
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
(In thousands)
Net income 
$ 
10,987 
$ 14,595 
$ 
14,595 
Net foreign exchange losses
 
610 
 
959 
 
959 
Income tax effect of net foreign exchange losses
 
4,028 
 
(3,657) 
 
(3,657) 
Adjusted net income
$ 
15,625 
$ 11,897 
$ 
9,032 
Weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue
Basic (’000)
 
553,653 
 549,415 
 
551,923 
Diluted (’000)
 
567,879 
 560,624 
 
563,958 
Adjusted net income per share
Basic ($)
$ 
0.028 
$ 
0.022 
$ 
0.016 
Diluted ($)
$ 
0.028 
$ 
0.021 
$ 
0.016 
Free Cash Flow
Free cash flow is determined as net cash provided by operating activities less capital expenditure for investing 
activities. We believe that free cash flow provides useful information to investors and others in understanding and 
evaluating the Company’s cash flows as it provides detail of the amount of cash the Company generates or utilizes after 
accounting for all capital expenditures including investments in in-vehicle devices.
The following table (in thousands) reconciles Net Cash Provided by Operating Activities to Free Cash Flow for 
the periods shown:
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
(In thousands)
Net cash provided by operating activities
$ 
28,178 
$ 
38,572 
$ 
19,402 
Less: Capital expenditure payments
 
(20,372)  
(8,654)  
(26,217) 
Free cash flow
$ 
7,806 
$ 
29,918 
$ 
(6,815) 
Constant Currency Information
Constant currency information has been presented in the sections below to illustrate the impact of changes in 
currency rates on our results. The constant currency information has been determined by adjusting the current financial 
reporting year’s results to the prior year’s average exchange rates, determined as the average of the monthly exchange 
rates applicable to the year. The measurement has been performed for each of our currencies, including the South African 
Rand and British Pound. The constant currency growth percentage has been calculated by utilizing the constant currency 
results compared to the prior year results. 
The constant currency information represents non-GAAP information. We believe this provides a useful basis to 
measure the performance of our business as it removes distortion from the effects of foreign currency movements during 
the period.
Due to the significant portion of our customers who are invoiced in non-U.S. Dollar denominated currencies, we 
also calculate our subscription revenue growth rate on a constant currency basis, thereby removing the effect of currency 
fluctuation on our results of operations.
71

Refer to discussion below for the annual constant currency growth. The following tables provide the constant 
currency reconciliation to the most directly comparable GAAP measure for the fiscal years shown:
Subscription Revenue
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
% 
Change
2021
2022
% 
Change
(In thousands, except for percentages)
Subscription revenue as 
reported
$ 127,570 
$ 113,351 
 (11.1) %
$ 
113,351 
$ 
123,573 
 9.0 %
Conversion impact of U.S. 
Dollar/other currencies
 
— 
 
6,437 
 5.0 %
 
— 
 
(7,048) 
 (6.2) %
Subscription revenue on a 
constant currency basis
$ 127,570 
$ 119,788 
 (6.1) %
$ 
113,351 
$ 
116,525 
 2.8 %
Hardware and Other Revenue
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
% 
Change
2021
2022
% 
Change
(In thousands, except for percentages)
Hardware and other revenue as 
reported
$ 
18,080 
$ 
13,543 
 (25.1) %
$ 
13,543 
$ 
19,721 
 45.6 %
Conversion impact of U.S. 
Dollar/other currencies
 
— 
230
 1.3 %
 
— 
 
(596) 
 (4.4) %
Hardware and other revenue on 
a constant currency basis
$ 
18,080 
$ 
13,773 
 (23.8) %
$ 
13,543 
$ 
19,125 
 41.2 %
Total Revenue
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
% 
Change
2021
2022
% 
Change
(In thousands, except for percentages)
Total revenue as reported
$ 145,650 
$ 126,894 
 (12.9) %
$ 
126,894 
$ 
143,294 
 12.9 %
Conversion impact of U.S. 
Dollar/other currencies
 
— 
 
6,667 
 4.6 %
 
— 
 
(7,644) 
 (6.0) %
Total revenue on a constant 
currency basis
$ 145,650 
$ 133,561 
 (8.3) %
$ 
126,894 
$ 
135,650 
 6.9 %
72

Liquidity and capital resources
We believe that our cash and borrowings available under our credit facilities will be sufficient to meet our 
liquidity requirements for the foreseeable future. Liquidity risk is reduced as a result of stable income due to the 
recurring nature of our income, available cash resources, as well as unutilized facilities which are available.
  
The following tables provide a summary of our cash flows for each of the three years ended March 31, 2020, 
2021 and 2022:
Fiscal Year Ended March 31,
 
2020
2021
2022
(In thousands)
Net cash generated from operating activities
$ 
28,178 $ 
38,570 $ 
19,402 
Net cash used in investing activities
 
(19,422)  
(8,650)  
(26,157) 
Net cash used in financing activities
 
(15,451)  
(5,209)  
(5,067) 
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents, and restricted 
cash
 
(6,695)  
24,711  
(11,822) 
Cash, and cash equivalents and restricted cash at the beginning of the 
year
 
27,838  
18,652  
46,343 
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents, and 
restricted cash
 
(2,491)  
2,978  
198 
Cash, and cash equivalents and restricted cash at the end of the year
$ 
18,652 $ 
46,341 $ 
34,719 
We fund our operations, capital expenditure and acquisitions through cash generated from operating activities, 
cash on hand and our undrawn borrowing facilities.
It is currently our policy to pay regular dividends, and we consider such dividend payments on a quarter-by-
quarter basis.
As of March 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, the Company had approved, but not yet contracted, capital commitments 
for intangible assets of $3.0 million, $4.7 million and $5.6 million respectively. 
As of March 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, the Company had approved, and contracted, capital commitments for 
property, plant and equipment of $1.8 million, $1.2 million and $14.8 million, respectively; and for intangible assets of 
$0.9 million, $1.3 million and $1.6 million respectively. 
Capital commitments will be funded out of a mixture of working capital and cash and cash equivalents. Capital 
commitments for intangible assets relate to software and technology and capital commitments for property, plant and 
equipment mainly relate to in-vehicle devices. 
On May 23, 2017, the MiX Telematics Limited Board approved a share repurchase program of up to           
R270 million (equivalent of $18.6 million as of March 31, 2022) under which we may repurchase our ordinary shares, 
including ADSs. On December 3, 2021, the Board approved an increase to the share repurchase program under which the 
Company may repurchase ordinary shares, including ADSs. Post this increase, and after giving effect to shares already 
purchased under the program as at December 2, 2021, the Company could repurchase additional shares with a 
cumulative value of R160 million ($10.0 million). The total value of the whole share repurchase program post the 
December 3, 2021 increase is R396.5 million ($24.9 million). During fiscal year 2022 shares with a value of R44.7 
million (equivalent of $3.0 million as of March 31, 2022) were repurchased under the share repurchase program. 
Additional shares to the value of R115.3 million (equivalent of $8.0 million as of March 31, 2022) may still be 
repurchased.
We expect any repurchases under this share repurchase program to be funded out of existing cash resources. 
During fiscal year 2022, the Company repurchased 6,020,085 ordinary shares on the open market at prevailing market 
prices for a cumulative consideration of $3.0 million. Refer to “Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related 
Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities” for information regarding our share repurchase program. 
73

Operating Activities
Net cash provided by operating activities during fiscal year 2020 consisted of our net income (after excluding 
non-cash charges) of $52.3 million, a net reduction in operating assets and liabilities investments of $18.8 million, net 
interest received of $0.5 million and taxes paid of $5.8 million. 
Net cash provided by operating activities increased from $28.2 million in fiscal year 2020 to $38.6 million in 
fiscal year 2021 which is primarily attributable to improved cash generated from operations of $10.5 million offset by 
lower net interest received of $0.1 million. The improved cash generated from operations is primarily as a result of 
improved working capital management of $17.9 million (specifically a decrease in accounts receivables of $9.2 million 
due to improved management of receivables and lower revenues, an increase in accrued expenses and other liabilities of 
$8.6 million, foreign currency translation adjustments of $6.0 million, and lower capitalized commissions of $1.4 
million, partially offset by a decrease in accounts payables of $5.9 million, prepaid expenses and other current assets of 
$1.6 million and an increase in inventories of $0.4 million), and an increase in net income of $3.6 million.
Net cash provided by operating activities decreased from $38.6 million in fiscal year 2021 to $19.4 million in 
fiscal year 2022. This is primarily attributable to lower cash generated from operations of $17.4 million, lower net 
interest received of $0.3 million and increased taxation paid of $1.4 million. The lower cash generated from operations is 
primarily as a result of a decrease in net income of $5.6 million and a deterioration in working capital management of 
$10.0 million (specifically an increase in accounts receivables of $10.3 million due to slower collection of receivables 
and higher revenues, an increase in capitalized commissions of $1.1 million due to higher revenues, an increase in 
inventories of $0.5 million, a increase in prepaid expenses and other current assets of $0.8 million and an adverse change 
in foreign currency translation adjustments of $2.5 million, partially offset by an increase in accounts payables of $3.8 
million and an increase in accrued expenses and other liabilities of $1.4 million).
Net cash provided by operating activities during fiscal year 2022 consisted of our net income (after excluding 
non-cash charges) of $38.1 million, a net reduction in operating assets and liabilities investments of $11.5 million and 
taxes paid of $7.2 million.
Investing Activities
Net cash used in investing activities in fiscal year 2020 increased to $19.4 million from $19.2 million in fiscal 
year 2019. Net cash used in investing activities during fiscal year 2020 primarily consisted of capital expenditures of 
$20.4 million. Capital expenditures during the year included purchases of intangible assets of $5.7 million, which 
included internal-use software of $3.4 million as well as computer software, technology and other intangibles of $2.3 
million, and cash paid to purchase property, plant and equipment of $14.7 million, which included in-vehicle devices of 
$13.6 million. Net cash used in investing activities also included $0.3 million loan advanced to third parties offset by 
proceeds on sale of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets of $1.3 million.
Net cash used in investing activities in fiscal year 2021 decreased to $8.7 million from $19.4 million in fiscal 
year 2020, primarily due to lower in-vehicle devices capital expenditure as a result of lower revenues during the 
COVID-19 pandemic. Net cash used in investing activities during fiscal year 2021 primarily consisted of capital 
expenditures of $8.7 million. Capital expenditures during the year included purchases of intangible assets of $4.0 
million, which included internal-use software of $2.8 million as well as computer software, technology and other 
intangibles of $1.2 million, and cash paid to purchase property, plant and equipment of $4.6 million, which included in-
vehicle devices of $4.2 million. 
Net cash used in investing activities in fiscal year 2022 increased to $26.2 million from $8.7 million in fiscal 
year 2021. Net cash used in investing activities during fiscal year 2022 primarily consisted of capital expenditures of 
$26.2 million. Capital expenditures during fiscal year 2022 included purchases of intangible assets of $5.9 million and 
cash paid to purchase property, plant and equipment of $20.3 million, which included in-vehicle devices of $18.3 
million. 
Financing Activities
In fiscal year 2020, the cash used in financing activities of $15.5 million includes share repurchases of $9.8 
million, dividends paid of $6.0 million, offset by $0.3 million from facilities utilized.
74

In fiscal year 2021, the cash used in financing activities of $5.2 million includes dividends paid of $5.4 million 
and $0.7 million from facilities repaid, offset by proceeds of $0.9 million from the issue of ordinary shares in relation to 
the exercise of stock options. 
In fiscal year 2022, the cash used in financing activities of $5.1 million includes dividends paid of $5.9 million 
and ordinary shares repurchased of $3.0 million, offset by $3.9 million from facilities utilized.
Credit Facilities
As of March 31, 2022, our principal sources of liquidity were net cash balances of $28.1 million (consisting of 
cash and cash equivalents of $33.7 million less short-term debt (bank overdraft)) of $5.6 million) and unutilized 
borrowing capacity of $1.8 million available through our credit facilities. Our principal sources of credit are our facilities 
with Standard Bank Limited and Nedbank Limited. 
As of March 31, 2022, we had an overdraft facility of R64.0 million (equivalent of $4.4 million as of March 31, 
2022), a working capital facility of R25.0 million (equivalent of $1.7 million as of March 31, 2022) and an unutilized 
vehicle and asset finance facility of R8.5 million (equivalent of $0.6 million as of March 31, 2022) with Standard Bank 
Limited that bear interest at South African Prime less 1.2% except for the working capital facility that bears interest at 
South African Prime less 0.25%.
As of March 31, 2022, the overdraft facility was fully utilized. We use this facility as part of our foreign 
currency hedging strategy. We draw down on this facility in the applicable foreign currency in order to fix the exchange 
rate on existing balance sheet foreign currency exposure that we anticipate settling in that foreign currency. Our 
obligations under the overdraft facility with Standard Bank Limited are guaranteed by MiX Telematics Limited and our 
wholly-owned subsidiaries, MiX Telematics Africa Proprietary Limited and MiX Telematics International Proprietary 
Limited, and secured by a pledge of accounts receivable by MiX Telematics Limited and MiX Telematics International 
Proprietary Limited.
We have a R25.0 million (equivalent of $1.7 million as of March 31, 2022) working capital facility with 
Standard Bank Limited that bears interest at South African Prime less 0.25%. As of March 31, 2022, $1.2 million of the 
facility was utilized. We use this facility for working capital purposes in our Africa operations.
We have a R10.0 million (equivalent of $0.7 million as of March 31, 2022) facility with Nedbank Limited that 
bears interest at South African Prime less 2%. As of March 31, 2022, the facility was undrawn. We use this facility for 
working capital purposes in our Africa operations.
Our credit facilities with Standard Bank Limited and Nedbank Limited contain certain restrictive clauses, 
including without limitation, those limiting our and our guarantor subsidiaries’, as applicable, ability to, among other 
things, incur indebtedness, incur liens, or sell or acquire assets or businesses. These facilities are not subject to any 
financial covenants such as interest coverage or gearing ratios.
75

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates
Our consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with GAAP. Certain of our significant accounting 
policies and critical accounting estimates are summarized below. The preparation of consolidated financial statements in 
conformity with GAAP requires the use of estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported and disclosed. 
Significant estimates include, but are not limited to, allowances for doubtful accounts, the assessment of expected cash flows 
used in evaluating goodwill for impairment and income and deferred taxes. Our actual results could differ from those estimates, 
and such differences may be material to the consolidated financial statements. We evaluate our estimates and assumptions on an 
ongoing basis. 
Allowance for doubtful accounts 
The allowance for doubtful accounts on accounts receivables is calculated by considering all relevant information, 
internal and external about the collectability of cash flows, including information about past events, current conditions, and 
reasonable and supportable forecasts of future economic conditions to appropriately reflect the risk of losses over the remaining 
contractual lives of the assets. Historical loss rates, calculated as actual losses over a period as a percentage of revenue, are 
adjusted for current conditions and management’s expectations about future economic conditions.  
The allowance is measured on a collective basis where management groups their customers appropriately based on 
their credit risk characteristics. 
The allowance for doubtful accounts is a valuation account and the asset’s carrying amount is reduced and the amount 
of the loss is recognized in the consolidated statements of income. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance. 
Actual write-downs are recorded when the asset is deemed uncollectible after all efforts to recover have yielded no results. 
Goodwill
Goodwill is not amortized but is tested for possible impairment at least annually, or when circumstances change that 
would more likely than not reduce the fair value of a reporting unit below its carrying value. Goodwill is allocated to a 
reporting unit for the purpose of impairment testing. The carrying value of the reporting unit, to which goodwill has been 
allocated, is compared to its fair value, and a goodwill impairment charge is recognized for the amount (if any) by which the 
carrying value exceeds the fair value, limited to the amount of the goodwill. 
The fair values of the reporting units are determined based on the use of pre-tax cash flow projections based on 
approved financial budgets covering a 5-year period. These cash flows take into account market-based assumptions and near-
term expectations. The discount rates used were calculated using the capital asset pricing model. These rates reflect specific 
risks relating to the relevant reporting units. The growth rate has been determined based on the expected long-term inflation 
outlook. 
No impairments of goodwill existed as of the most recent testing date, March 31, 2022 or the previous testing, March 
31, 2021. Given the headroom that exists in the reporting units, we believe that a reasonable change in assumptions would not 
result in any goodwill impairments. The changes in the carrying value of goodwill during fiscal year 2021 and fiscal year 2022 
are attributable only to foreign currency translation adjustments.
Although there were no impairments of goodwill as of March 31, 2021 and 2022, significant judgement was exercised 
in determining the fair value of each reporting unit. In particular, to the extent that anticipated new contracts do not materialize 
and the business strategy does not come to fruition, or key personnel are not retained, the forecasts on which the impairment 
tests were performed could be negatively impacted.
Taxation 
We are subject to income taxes in numerous jurisdictions. During the process of determining our world-wide provision 
for income taxes, we are required to make judgements in respect of international tax matters, including transfer pricing and 
controlled foreign company legislation. Where applicable tax legislation is subject to interpretation, management makes 
assessments, based on expert tax advice, of the relevant tax that is more likely than not to be paid and provides accordingly.
Income taxes are accounted for under the asset and liability method. Income tax expense is recognized in the 
consolidated statements of income, except to the extent that it relates to items recognized in other comprehensive income or 
directly in equity. We use the portfolio approach for releasing income tax effects from accumulated other comprehensive 
income.
76

The current income tax charge is calculated on the basis of the tax laws and tax rates enacted by the reporting date in 
the countries where we operate and generate taxable income. Interest, and penalties, incurred on the underpayment of income 
taxes is classified as interest expense, and administration expenses, respectively.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the 
financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases and operating loss and tax 
credit carryforwards. Deferred tax is measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which 
those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. Uncertainty generated by the current economic 
environment may affect the valuation of our deferred tax assets over time. Our accounting for deferred tax balances represent 
management’s best estimate of future events that can be appropriately reflected in the accounting estimate.
Deferred tax liabilities arising on investments in domestic subsidiaries are not recognized to the extent that the 
investment can be recovered on a tax-free basis; and on investments in foreign subsidiaries to the extent that the undistributed 
earnings will be invested indefinitely or will be remitted in a tax-free liquidation.
77

ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
As a “smaller reporting company”, we are not required to provide the information required by this Item 7A.
78

ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
The information concerning our consolidated financial statements, together with the reports of Deloitte & Touche 
(“Deloitte”) are presented at the beginning of page 93 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
79

ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND 
FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
None.
80

ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
 EVALUATION OF DISCLOSURE CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
In connection with the preparation of this report, an evaluation was carried out by certain members of Company 
management, with the participation of the Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer of the effectiveness of 
the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Securities and Exchange Commission’s (“SEC”) Rules 
13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (“Exchange Act”)), as of March 31, 
2021. Disclosure controls and procedures are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in reports filed 
or submitted under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized, and reported within the time periods specified 
in the SEC’s rules and forms, and that such information is accumulated and communicated to management, including the 
Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosures. 
Due to the material weakness in internal control over financial reporting described below, management 
concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were not effective as of March 31, 2022. 
Notwithstanding the existence of this material weakness, management believes that the consolidated financial statements 
in this Annual Report on Form 10-K present, in all material aspects, the company’s financial condition as reported, in 
conformity with U.S. Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (“US GAAP”).
MANAGEMENT’S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING
Management of the Company is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over 
financial reporting as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act. Our internal control over 
financial reporting is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the 
preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with GAAP and includes those policies and 
procedures that: (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that in reasonable detail accurately and fairly reflect our 
transactions and the dispositions of our assets; (2) provide reasonable assurance that our transactions are recorded as 
necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and 
that our receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with appropriate authorizations; and (3) provide 
reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of our assets 
that could have a material effect on our consolidated financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect 
misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls 
may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures 
may deteriorate.
Under the supervision of and with the participation of our management, including our Chief Executive Officer 
and Chief Financial Officer, we assessed the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of March 31, 
2022, using the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”) 
in Internal Control—Integrated Framework (2013). 
A material weakness is a deficiency, or a combinations of deficiencies, within the meaning of Public Company 
Accounting Oversight Board (“PCAOB”) Clarified Audit Standard No. 2201: An audit of internal control over financial 
reporting that is integrated with an audit of financial statements, such that there is a reasonable possibility that a material 
misstatement of our annual or interim financial statements will not be prevented or detected on a timely basis. 
Management identified several deficiencies in the design and operating effectiveness of business process level 
controls in the areas of management review of income tax, consignment stock and capitalization of internally generated 
software costs at the Company’s Africa segment as a result of the lack of senior financial resources to appropriately 
supervise and execute control activities. These deficiencies aggregated with other business process level control 
deficiencies could result in material misstatement in the financial statements and therefore constitute a material weakness. 
Based on this material weakness, the Company’s management concluded that of March 31, 2022, the Company’s internal 
control over financial reporting was not effective. 
The Company’s independent registered public accounting firm, Deloitte & Touche, has audited the consolidated 
financial statements included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, has also audited our internal control over financial 
reporting as of March 31, 2021, as stated in their audit report that follows below.
81

Remediation Plan for the Material Weakness
Management is committed to the remediation of the material weakness described above, as well as the continued 
improvement of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Management has implemented, and continues to 
implement measures designed to ensure that control deficiencies contributing to the material weakness are remediated, 
such that these controls are designed, implemented and operating effectively. 
To address the material weakness, management has completed, or is in the process of:
•
Investigating and understanding the root causes of the control weakness that resulted in the material weakness, is 
currently developing a remediation plan and has already restructured the finance function and appointed 
personnel;
•
Evaluating and redesigning where applicable, management’s review control descriptions to address the design 
and effectiveness of controls over income tax, consignment stock and the capitalization of software costs;
•
Reviewing, identifying and implementing process and  system functionality and automation enhancements;
•
Adopting formal off boarding and onboarding processes for staff in the finance function;
•
Training and cross-training staff in executing finance functional tasks and executing controls; and
•
Reviewing the accountability assigned for fulfilling finance tasks, remediation efforts and for executing controls.
We believe that once these actions have been completed, it will remediate the material weakness. The material 
weakness will not be considered remediated, however, until the applicable controls operate for a sufficient period of time 
and management has concluded, through testing, that controls are operating effectively.
Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
We have implemented a new Enterprise Resource Planning (“ERP”) system in our Middle East operations, and 
plan to roll that out to our other operations. Although we do not believe this implementation have resulted in material 
changes to the control environment, we have implemented some control enhancements such as workflow approval. Except 
for the changes in connection with the implementation of the ERP system discussed above, there have been no other 
changes in our internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the fiscal year ended March 31, 2022 that 
have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial 
reporting. 
REPORT OF  INDEPENDENT  REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
To the stockholders and the Board of Directors of MiX Telematics Limited
Opinion on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of MiX Telematics Limited and its subsidiaries (the 
“Company”) as of March 31, 2022, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) 
issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”). In our opinion, because 
of the effect of the material weakness identified below on the achievement of the objectives of the control criteria, the 
Company has not maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of March 31, 2022, based on criteria 
established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by COSO.
We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board 
(United States) (“PCAOB”), the consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended March 31, 2022, of the 
Company and our report dated June 14, 2022, expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements.
82

Basis for Opinion
The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and 
for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying 
management’s report on internal control over financial reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the 
Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with 
the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities 
laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan 
and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was 
maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial 
reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness 
of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the 
circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance 
regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in 
accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes 
those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly 
reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions 
are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting 
principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of 
management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection 
of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial 
statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect 
misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls 
may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures 
may deteriorate.
Material Weakness
A material weakness is a deficiency, or a combination of deficiencies, in internal control over financial reporting, 
such that there is a reasonable possibility that a material misstatement of the company’s annual or interim financial 
statements will not be prevented or detected on a timely basis. The following material weakness has been identified and 
included in management’s assessment: 
Management identified several deficiencies in the design and operating effectiveness of business process level 
controls in the areas of management review of income tax, consignment stock and capitalization of internally generated 
software costs at the Company’s Africa segment as a result of the lack of sufficient senior financial resources to 
appropriately supervise and execute control activities. These deficiencies aggregated with other transaction level 
deficiencies constitute a material weakness. 
This material weakness was considered in determining the nature, timing, and extent of audit tests applied in our 
audit of the consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended March 31, 2022, of the Company, and this 
report does not affect our report on such financial statements. 
/s/ Deloitte & Touche 
Deloitte & Touche
Registered Auditor 
Johannesburg, South Africa 
June 14, 2022
83

ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION
None. 
ITEM 9C. DISCLOSURE REGARDING FOREIGN JURISDICTIONS THAT PREVENT INSPECTIONS
Not applicable.
84

PART III
ITEM 10. DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
The information required under this item is incorporated herein by reference to our definitive proxy statement 
pursuant to Regulation 14A, to be filed with the Commission not later than 120 days after the close of our fiscal year 
ended March 31, 2022. 
ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
The information required under this item is incorporated herein by reference to our definitive proxy statement 
pursuant to Regulation 14A, to be filed with the Commission not later than 120 days after the close of our fiscal year 
ended March 31, 2022.
85

ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND 
RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS
The information required under this item is incorporated herein by reference to our definitive proxy statement 
pursuant to Regulation 14A, to be filed with the Commission not later than 120 days after the close of our fiscal year 
ended March 31, 2022.
ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR 
INDEPENDENCE
The information required under this item is incorporated herein by reference to our definitive proxy statement 
pursuant to Regulation 14A, to be filed with the Commission not later than 120 days after the close of our fiscal year 
ended March 31, 2022.
ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES
The information required under this item is incorporated herein by reference to our definitive proxy statement 
pursuant to Regulation 14A, to be filed with the Commission not later than 120 days after the close of our fiscal year 
ended March 31, 2022.
86

ITEM 15. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
Financial Statements
 
The information concerning our financial statements, and Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting 
Firm required by this Item is incorporated by reference herein to the section of this Annual Report on Form 10-K in the 
section, entitled “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data”.
Financial Statement Schedules
Schedule II — Valuation and Qualifying Accounts - The information concerning Schedule II — Valuation and 
Qualifying Account required by this Item is incorporated by reference herein to the section of this Annual Report on Form 
10-K in the section entitled “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” on page 129 of that section.
Exhibits
3.1
Memorandum of Incorporation of the Company, as amended, filed as Exhibit 1.1 to the Company’s Annual 
Report on Form 20-F for the year ended March 31, 2014, filed on July 30, 2014 (File No. 001-36027), is 
incorporated herein by reference.
4.1
Description of the Company’s Securities, filed as Exhibit 4.1 with the Company’s Annual Report on Form 
10-K for the year ended March 31, 2020, filed on July 23, 2020 (File No. 001-36027), is incorporated 
herein by reference.
4.2
Form of Deposit Agreement among the Company, The Bank of New York Mellon, as depositary, and the 
holders from time to time of American depositary shares issued thereunder, including the form of American 
depositary receipts, filed as Exhibit 4.1 with the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1, filed on 
July 3, 2013 (Registration No. 333-189799), is incorporated herein by reference.
10.1*
TeliMatrix Group Executive Incentive Scheme, adopted by TeliMatrix Limited, dated October 8, 2007, 
including the Deed of Amendment, dated January 31, 2011, and the Second Deed of Amendment, dated 
September 13, 2011, filed as Exhibit 10.1 with the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1, filed 
on July 3, 2013 (Registration No. 333-189799), is incorporated herein by reference.
10.2*
Updated Terms and Conditions of Employment of Stefan Joselowitz, dated November 18, 2008, filed as 
Exhibit 10.3 with the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1, filed on July 3, 2013 (Registration 
No. 333-189799), is incorporated herein by reference.
10.3*
 Standard Terms and Conditions of Employment, effective October 1, 2016, between the Company and Gert 
Pretorius, filed as Exhibit 4.8 with the Company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended March 
31, 2017, filed on July 14, 2017 (File No. 001-36027), is incorporated herein by reference.
10.4*
 Restraint of Trade, dated January 1, 2012, between the Company and Gert Pretorius, filed as Exhibit 10.12 
with the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1, filed on July 3, 2013 (Registration No. 
333-189799), is incorporated herein by reference.
10.5
 Facility Letter, effective July 23, 2018, between The Standard Bank of South Africa Limited and the 
Company, filed as Exhibit 4.7 with the Company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended March 
31, 2019, filed on July 26, 2019 (File No. 001-36027), is incorporated herein by reference.
10.5.1
 First Amendment to Existing Facility Letter, dated January 24, 2020, between The Standard Bank of South 
Africa Limited and the Company, filed as Exhibit 10.6.1 with the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K 
for the year ended March 31, 2020, filed on July 23, 2020 (File No. 001-36027), is incorporated herein by 
reference. 
10.6
 Facility Letter, dated March 25, 2013, between Nedbank Limited and MiX Telematics Africa Proprietary 
Limited, filed as Exhibit 10.14 with the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1, filed on July 3, 
2013 (Registration No. 333-189799), is incorporated herein by reference.
10.7†
 Provision of Cellular Telephony Network Services Agreement, effective August 1, 2000, between Mobile 
Telephone Networks Proprietary Limited and the Company, as amended by Addendum effective July 10, 
2012, filed as Exhibit 10.21 with the Company’s Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement, filed on 
July 22, 2013, is incorporated herein by reference.
10.8†#
 Agreement, effective October 1, 2017, between MiX Telematics Africa Proprietary Limited and Super 
Group Trading Proprietary Limited, filed as Exhibit 4.13 with the Company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F 
for the year ended March 31, 2018, filed on July 2, 2018 (File No. 001-36027), is incorporated herein by 
reference.
Exhibit
number
 Description
87

10.9*
 Standard Terms and Conditions of Employment, dated December 1, 2013, between the Company and 
Catherine Lewis, filed as Exhibit 4.26 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 
March 31, 2014, filed on July 30, 2014 (File No. 001-36027), is incorporated herein by reference.
10.10*
 MiX Telematics Limited Long-Term Incentive Plan, filed as Exhibit 99.1 with the Company’s Registration 
Statement on Form S-8 on November 6, 2014 (Registration No. 333-199908), is incorporated herein by 
reference.
10.11*
Executive Employment Agreement, dated October 1, 2020, by and between MiX Telematics North 
America Inc., and Paul Dell, filed as Exhibit 10.1 with the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for 
the quarter ended December 31, 2020, filed on February 4, 2021 (File No. 001-36027), is incorporated 
herein by reference.
10.12*
Updated Terms and Conditions of Employment, effective April 1, 2017, between the Company and Charles 
Tasker, filed as Exhibit 4.19 with the Company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended March 
31, 2017, filed on July 14, 2017 (File No. 001-36027), is incorporated herein by reference.
10.13
AWS Customer Agreement, effective October 1, 2014, between Amazon Web Services, Inc. and MiX 
Telematics International Proprietary Limited, filed as Exhibit 4.20 with the Company’s Annual Report on 
Form 20-F for the year ended March 31, 2017, filed on July 14, 2017 (File No. 001-36027), is incorporated 
herein by reference.
10.14*
Executive Employment Agreement entered into between the Company and John Granara, effective July 8, 
2019, filed as Exhibit 14.19 with the Company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended March 
31, 2019, filed on July 26, 2019 (File No. 001-36027), is incorporated herein by reference.
10.15
Lease Agreement (Stellenbosch), effective July 25, 2019, between MiX Telematics Enterprise SA 
Proprietary Limited and Black Industrialists Group Property Management Company Proprietary Limited, 
filed as Exhibit 10.19 with the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended March 31, 
2020, filed on July 23, 2020 (File No. 001-36027), is incorporated herein by reference.
10.16
Lease Agreement (Midrand), effective August 16, 2019, between MiX Telematics Enterprise SA 
Proprietary Limited and Black Industrialists Group Property Management Company Proprietary Limited, 
filed as Exhibit 10.20 with the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended March 31, 
2020, filed on July 23, 2020 (File No. 001-36027), is incorporated herein by reference.
10.17
Form of Indemnification Agreement, effective June 1, 2020, between the Company and each director and 
officer of the company, filed as Exhibit 10.21 with the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the 
year ended March 31, 2020, filed on July 23, 2020 (File No. 001-36027), is incorporated herein by 
reference.
21.1
List of subsidiaries of the Company.
23.1
Consent of Deloitte & Touche, Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.
31.1
Certification of Stefan Joselowitz, Chief Executive Officer of MiX Telematics Limited pursuant to 
Securities Exchange Act Rules 13a-14(a) and 15d-14(a) as adopted pursuant to §302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley 
Act of 2002.
31.2
Certification of John Granara, Chief Financial Officer of MiX Telematics Limited pursuant to Securities 
Exchange Act Rules 13a-14(a) and 15d-14(a) as adopted pursuant to §302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 
2002.
32.1
Certification of Stefan Joselowitz, Chief Executive Officer of MiX Telematics Limited and John Granara, 
Chief Financial Officer of MiX Telematics Limited, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted 
pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
101
The following consolidated financial statements from the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the 
year ended March 31, 2022, formatted in XBRL (Extensible Business Reporting Language): (i) 
Consolidated Balance Sheets (ii) Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss), (iii) Consolidated Statements 
of Comprehensive Income (Loss), (iv) Consolidated Statement of Changes in Redeemable Non-Controlling 
Interests and Stockholders’ Equity, (v) Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows, and (vi) Notes to 
Consolidated Financial Statements.
101.INS
XBRL Instance Document
101.SCH
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document
101.CAL 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document
101.DEF 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document
101.LAB
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document
101.PRE
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document
104
Cover Page Interactive Data File (formatted as inline XBRL and contained in Exhibit 101).
Exhibit
number
 Description
88

    
*
Indicates management contract or compensatory plan.
†
Portions of this exhibit have been omitted pursuant to a request for confidential treatment.
#
Certain locations of recovery teams, other operating details relating to the recovery teams and pricing terms contained in the agreement and 
within Annexure A (Services to be provided by the Contractor), Annexure D (Permitted clients of the Contractor) and Annexure E.1 
(Helicopter Services) have been amended since the original execution of this agreement. The amended agreement and annexures do not 
contain information material to an investment or voting decision and such information is not otherwise disclosed in this exhibit or the Form 
10-K. Accordingly, the amended agreement and annexures have been omitted. The Registrant hereby undertakes to furnish supplemental 
copies of the omitted agreement and annexures to the Securities and Exchange Commission or its staff upon request.
89

ITEM 16. FORM 10-K SUMMARY
None.  
90

SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has 
duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this Annual Report on Form 10-K on its behalf.
MiX Telematics Limited
By: /s/ Stefan Joselowitz
Name: Stefan Joselowitz
Title: President and Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)
Date: June 14, 2022 
POWER OF ATTORNEY
Know all persons by these presents, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints Stefan 
Joselowitz and John Granara, or either of them, as his or her true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power 
of substitution, for him or her and in his or her name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any and all 
amendments to this Annual Report on Form 10-K, and to file the same, with all exhibits thereto, and other documents in 
connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in-fact and agents, full 
power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done in connection 
therewith as fully to all intents and purposes as he or she might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all 
that said attorneys-in-fact and agents, or their substitute or substitutes may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue 
hereof.
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this Annual Report on Form 10-K has been signed 
below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
Signature                                                                            Title                                                                  Date
By: /s/ Stefan Joselowitz                                                President and Chief Executive Officer 
 (Principal Executive Officer)             
      June 14, 2022
     Stefan Joselowitz
     
By: /s/ John Granara                                                      Vice President and Chief Financial Officer 
(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)      June 14, 2022
     John Granara
By: /s/ Robin Frew                                                           Chair of the Board                                             June 14, 2022
     Robin Frew
By: /s/ Richard Bruyns                                                     Director                                                             June 14, 2022
     Richard Bruyns 
91

By: /s/ Charmel Flemming                                                  Director                                                        June 14, 2022
     Charmel Flemming
By: /s/ Fikile Futwa                                                             Director                                                        June 14, 2022
     Fikile Futwa
By: /s/ Ian Jacobs                                                                 Director                                                        June 14, 2022
    Ian Jacobs
By: /s/ Charles Tasker                                                          Chief Operating Officer                              June 14, 2022
    Charles Tasker
92

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
Index to the Consolidated Financial Statements
Page
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm: Deloitte & Touche  (PCAOB ID 1130)
 
 
94
Consolidated Balance Sheets
96
Consolidated Statements of Income
 
 
97
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income
 
 
98
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity
 
 
99
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows 
101
Notes to the Financial Statements
103
93

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
To the stockholders and the Board of Directors of MiX Telematics Limited
Opinion on the Financial Statements
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of MiX Telematics Limited and subsidiaries (the 
“Company”) as of March 31, 2022 and 2021, the related consolidated statements of income, consolidated statements of 
comprehensive income, consolidated statements of changes in stockholders’ equity, and consolidated statements of cash flows, 
for each of the three years in the period ended March 31, 2022, and the related notes and the schedules listed in the Index at 
Item 15 (collectively referred to as the “financial statements”). In our opinion, the financial statements present fairly, in all 
material respects, the financial position of the Company as of March 31, 2022 and 2021, and the results of its operations and its 
cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended March 31, 2022, in conformity with accounting principles generally 
accepted in the United States of America.
We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United 
States) (“PCAOB”), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of March 31, 2022, based on criteria established 
in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway 
Commission and our report dated June 14, 2022, expressed an adverse opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial 
reporting because of a material weakness.
Basis for Opinion
These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an 
opinion on the Company’s financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the 
PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and 
the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and 
perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, 
whether due to error or fraud. Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the 
financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures 
included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also 
included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the 
overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
Critical Audit Matter
The critical audit matter communicated below is a matter arising from the current-period audit of the financial 
statements that was communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that (1) relates to accounts or 
disclosures that are material to the financial statements and (2) involved our especially challenging, subjective, or complex 
judgments. The communication of critical audit matters does not alter in any way our opinion on the financial statements, taken 
as a whole, and we are not, by communicating the critical audit matter below, providing a separate opinion on the critical audit 
matter or on the accounts or disclosures to which it relates.
Goodwill—Refer to Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements
Critical Audit Matter Description
The Company’s evaluation of goodwill for impairment involves the comparison of the fair value of each reporting unit 
to its carrying value. The Company uses the discounted cash flow model to estimate fair value, which requires management to 
make significant estimates and assumptions related to discount rates and forecasts of future revenues and operating cashflows. 
Changes in these assumptions could have a significant impact on either the fair value, the amount of any goodwill impairment 
charge, or both. The Company’s goodwill balance was $44.4 million as of March 31, 2022, of which $8.6 million was allocated 
to the European Reporting Unit (“MiX Europe”). The fair value of MiX Europe exceeded its carrying value by 35% as of the 
measurement date and, therefore, no impairment was recognized.
We identified goodwill for MiX Europe as a critical audit matter because of the significant judgments made by 
management to estimate the fair value of MiX Europe. This required a high degree of auditor judgment, including the need to 
involve our fair value specialists, when performing audit procedures to evaluate the reasonableness of management’s estimates 
94

and assumptions related to selection of the discount rate and forecasts of future revenue and operating cash flow of MiX 
Europe.
How the Critical Audit Matter Was Addressed in the Audit
Our audit procedures related to the discount rate and forecasts of future revenue and operating cashflows used by 
management to estimate the fair value of MiX Europe included the following, among others:
 
a.
We tested the effectiveness of controls over management’s goodwill impairment evaluation, including those over the 
determination of the fair value of MiX Europe, such as controls related to management’s selection of the discount rate 
and forecasts of future revenue and earnings.
b.
We evaluated management’s ability to accurately forecast future revenues and earnings by comparing actual results to 
management’s historical forecasts.
c.
We evaluated the reasonableness of management’s revenue forecasts by comparing the forecasts to historical revenues 
and earnings and internal communications to management and the Board of Directors.
d.
We compared the Company’s actual performance to certain of its peer companies.
e.
We evaluated the reasonableness of the valuation methodology and with the assistance of our fair value specialists, the 
reasonableness of the discount rate by testing the source information underlying the determination of the discount rate. 
We then tested the mathematical accuracy of the calculation.
f.
Developed a range of independent estimates and compared those to the discount rate selected by management.
 
 
/s/ Deloitte & Touche 
Deloitte & Touche
Registered Auditor 
Johannesburg, South Africa 
June 14, 2022 
We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2017.
95

MIX TELEMATICS LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
    (in thousands, except per share data)                                                                                      
As of March 31,
2021
2022
ASSETS
Current assets:
Cash and cash equivalents
$ 
45,489 
$ 
33,738 
Restricted cash
854
981
Accounts receivables, net of allowances for doubtful accounts of $5.6 
million and $5.4 million, respectively
19,265
25,092
Inventory, net
 
3,109 
3,356
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
8,509
11,463
Total current assets
77,226
74,630
Property, plant and equipment, net
23,463
32,274
Goodwill
43,938
44,434
Intangible assets, net
18,303
20,460
Deferred tax assets
 
3,782 
3,768
Other assets
 
4,434 
4,988
Total assets
$ 
171,146 
$ 
180,554 
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
Current liabilities:
Short-term debt
$ 
1,674 
$ 
5,597 
Accounts payables
6,560
8,052
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
17,330
19,610
Deferred revenue
5,788
6,692
Income taxes payable
1,345
590
Total current liabilities
32,697
40,541
Deferred tax liabilities
9,187
8,972
Long-term accrued expenses and other liabilities
5,863
4,344
Total liabilities
47,747
53,857
Stockholders’ equity:
MiX Telematics Limited stockholders’ equity
Preference shares: 100 million shares authorized but not issued
 
— 
 
— 
Ordinary shares: 605.6 million and 605.2 million no-par value shares 
issued and outstanding as of March 31, 2021 and 2022, respectively
67,401
64,390
Less treasury stock at cost: 53.8 million shares as of March, 31, 2021 and 
March 31, 2022
 
(17,315) 
 
(17,315) 
Retained earnings
76,710
79,709
Accumulated other comprehensive income
 
1,924 
3,909
Additional paid-in capital
 
(5,326) 
 
(4,001) 
Total MiX Telematics Limited stockholders’ equity
123,394
126,692
Non-controlling interest
5
5
Total stockholders’ equity
123,399
126,697
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
$ 
171,146 
$ 
180,554 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
96

MIX TELEMATICS LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
(in thousands, except per share data)
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Revenue
Subscription
$ 
127,570 
$ 
113,351 
$ 
123,573 
Hardware and other
 
18,080 
 
13,543 
 
19,721 
Total revenue
 
145,650 
 
126,894 
 
143,294 
Cost of revenue
Subscription
 
39,828 
 
33,414 
 
36,683 
Hardware and other
 
13,187 
 
10,451 
 
15,176 
Total cost of revenue
 
53,015 
 
43,865 
 
51,859 
Gross profit
 
92,635 
 
83,029 
 
91,435 
Operating expenses
Sales and marketing
 
13,324 
 
11,344 
 
15,436 
Administration and other
 
58,263 
 
53,487 
 
61,550 
Total operating expenses
 
71,587 
 
64,831 
 
76,986 
Income from operations
 
21,048 
 
18,198 
 
14,449 
Other expense
 
299 
 
897 
 
574 
Net interest income/(expense)
 
67 
 
(72) 
 
(510) 
Income before income tax expense
 
20,816 
 
17,229 
 
13,365 
Income tax expense
 
9,829 
 
2,634 
 
4,418 
Net income
 
10,987 
 
14,595 
 
8,947 
Less: Net income attributable to non-
controlling interest
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
Net income attributable to MiX Telematics 
Limited
$ 
10,987 
$ 
14,595 
$ 
8,947 
Net income per ordinary share
 Basic
$ 
0.02 
$ 
0.03 
$ 
0.02 
 Diluted
$ 
0.02 
$ 
0.03 
$ 
0.02 
Net income per American Depository Share
 Basic
$ 
0.50 
$ 
0.66 
$ 
0.41 
 Diluted
$ 
0.48 
$ 
0.65 
$ 
0.40 
Ordinary shares
 Weighted average
 
553,653 
 
549,415 
 
551,923 
 Diluted weighted average
 
567,879 
 
560,624 
 
563,958 
American Depository Shares
 Weighted average
 
22,146 
 
21,977 
 
22,077 
 Diluted weighted average
 
22,715 
 
22,425 
 
22,558 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
97

MIX TELEMATICS LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
(in thousands)
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Net income
$ 
10,987 
$ 
14,595 
$ 
8,947 
Other comprehensive (loss)/income
Foreign currency translation (losses)/gains, 
net of tax
 
(13,163) 
 
12,994 
 
1,985 
Total comprehensive (loss)/income
 
(2,176) 
 
27,589 
 
10,932 
Less: Total comprehensive income attributable 
to non-controlling interest
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
Total comprehensive (loss)/income 
attributable to MiX Telematics Limited
$ 
(2,176) 
$ 
27,589 
$ 
10,932 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
98

MIX TELEMATICS LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
(in thousands)
Balance as of April 1, 2019
601,948
$ 
68,200 
$ 
(9,227) 
$ 
2,115 
$ 
(6,902) 
$ 
62,750 
$ 
116,936 
$ 
5 
$ 
116,941 
Adjustment on initial application of 
ASC 326, net of
tax
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
(22) 
 
— 
 
(240) 
 
(262) 
 
— 
 
(262) 
Restated balance as of April 1, 2019
 
601,948 
 
68,200 
 
(9,227) 
 
2,093 
 
(6,902) 
 
62,510 
 
116,674 
 
5 
 
116,679 
Total comprehensive (loss)/income
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
(13,163) 
 
— 
 
10,987 
 
(2,176) 
 
— 
 
(2,176) 
Net income
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
10,987 
 
10,987 
 
— 
 
10,987 
Other comprehensive loss
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
(13,163) 
 
— 
 
— 
 
(13,163) 
 
— 
 
(13,163) 
Issuance of common stock in relation 
to SARs exercised
 
2,026 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
Stock-based compensation
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
303 
 
— 
 
303 
 
— 
 
303 
Dividends declared on ordinary 
shares 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
(6,015) 
 
(6,015) 
 
— 
 
(6,015) 
Ordinary shares repurchased and 
cancelled
 
(3,039) 
 
(1,678) 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
(1,678) 
 
— 
 
(1,678) 
Purchase of treasury stock
 
— 
 
— 
 
(8,088) 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
(8,088) 
 
— 
 
(8,088) 
Balance as of March 31, 2020
 
600,934 
$ 
66,522 
$ 
(17,315) 
$ 
(11,070) 
$ 
(6,599) 
$ 
67,482 
$ 
99,020 
$ 
5 
$ 
99,025 
Common Stock
Treasury 
Stock
Accumulated 
Other 
Comprehensive 
Income/(Loss)
Additional 
Paid-In 
Capital
Retained 
Earnings
Total MiX 
Telematics 
Limited 
Stockholders’ 
Equity
Non-
Controlling 
Interest
Total 
Stockholders’ 
Equity
Shares
Amount
99

Total comprehensive income
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
12,994 
 
— 
 
14,595 
 
27,589 
 
— 
 
27,589 
Net income
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
14,595 
 
14,595 
 
— 
 
14,595 
Other comprehensive income
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
12,994 
 
— 
 
— 
 
12,994 
 
— 
 
12,994 
Issuance of common stock in relation 
to stock options and SARs exercised
 
4,645 
 
879 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
879 
 
— 
 
879 
Stock-based compensation
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
1,273 
 
— 
 
1,273 
 
— 
 
1,273 
Dividends declared on ordinary 
shares
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
(5,367) 
 
(5,367) 
 
— 
 
(5,367) 
Balance as of March 31, 2021
 
605,579 
$ 
67,401 
$ 
(17,315) 
$ 
1,924 
$ 
(5,326) 
$ 
76,710 
$ 
123,394 
$ 
5 
$ 
123,399 
Total comprehensive income
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
1,985 
 
— 
 
8,947 
 
10,932 
 
— 
 
10,932 
Net income
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
8,947 
 
8,947 
 
— 
 
8,947 
Other comprehensive income
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
1,985 
 
— 
 
— 
 
1,985 
 
— 
 
1,984 
Issuance of common stock in relation 
to SARs exercised
 
5,618 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
Stock-based compensation
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
1,325 
 
— 
 
1,325 
 
— 
 
1,325 
Dividends declared on ordinary 
shares 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
(5,948) 
 
(5,948) 
 
— 
 
(5,948) 
Ordinary shares repurchased and 
cancelled
 
(6,020) 
 
(3,011) 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
— 
 
(3,011) 
 
— 
 
(3,011) 
Balance as of March 31, 2022
 
605,177 
$ 
64,390 
$ 
(17,315) 
$ 
3,909 
$ 
(4,001) 
$ 
79,709 
$ 
126,692 
$ 
5 
$ 
126,697 
Common Stock
Treasury 
Stock
Accumulated 
Other 
Comprehensive 
Income/(Loss)
Additional 
Paid-In 
Capital
Retained 
Earnings
Total MiX 
Telematics 
Limited 
Stockholders’ 
Equity
Non-
Controlling 
Interest
Total 
Stockholders’ 
Equity
Shares
Amount
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
100

MIX TELEMATICS LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
(in thousands)
For the year ended March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Cash flows from operating activities:
Net income
$ 
10,987 
$ 
14,595 
$ 
8,947 
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net 
cash provided by operating activities:
Current income taxes
 
5,239 
 
6,953 
 
4,937 
Deferred income taxes
 
4,590 
 
(4,319) 
 
(519) 
(Gain)/loss on disposal of property, plant and 
equipment
 
(270) 
 
13 
 
(36) 
Depreciation 
 
16,149 
 
12,878 
 
10,693 
Amortization of intangible assets
 
3,823 
 
3,681 
 
4,258 
Amortization of deferred commissions
 
3,486 
 
3,533 
 
3,566 
Impairment of long-lived assets
 
6 
 
8 
 
47 
Net interest (income)/expense
 
(67) 
 
72 
 
510 
Stock based compensation expense
 
660 
 
1,273 
 
1,325 
Net foreign exchange loss
 
610 
 
959 
 
648 
Change in allowance for doubtful accounts
 
3,941 
 
2,961 
 
2,559 
Write-down of inventory to net realizable 
value
 
339 
 
660 
 
790 
Net accrued expenses and other liabilities 
raised 
 
3,016 
 
2,535 
 
616 
Other non-cash items
 
(210) 
 
(245) 
 
(223) 
Changes in operating assets and liabilities:
Inventories
 
(74) 
 
(498) 
 
(1,037) 
Accounts receivables
 
(7,309) 
 
1,872 
 
(8,386) 
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
 
(45) 
 
(1,589) 
 
(2,341) 
Accounts payables
 
3,419 
 
(2,529) 
 
1,340 
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
 
(7,662) 
 
959 
 
2,328 
Deferred commissions
 
(3,677) 
 
(2,251) 
 
(3,399) 
Foreign currency translation adjustments on 
operating assets and liabilities
 
(3,478) 
 
2,482 
 
(32) 
Interest received
 
683 
 
641 
 
404 
Interest paid
 
(204) 
 
(311) 
 
(400) 
Income tax paid
 
(5,774) 
 
(5,761) 
 
(7,193) 
Net cash provided by operating activities
 
28,178 
 
38,572 
 
19,402 
Cash flows from investing activities:
Acquisition of property, plant and equipment – 
in-vehicle devices
 
(13,544) 
 
(4,232) 
 
(18,335) 
Acquisition of property, plant and equipment –
other
 
(1,162) 
 
(398) 
 
(1,985) 
Proceeds from the sale of property, plant and 
equipment
 
1,294 
 
4 
 
60 
Acquisition of intangible assets
 
(5,666) 
 
(4,024) 
 
(5,897) 
Loans to external parties
 
(344) 
 
— 
 
— 
Net cash used in investing activities 
 
(19,422) 
 
(8,650) 
 
(26,157) 
Cash flows from financing activities:
101

Proceeds from issuance of ordinary shares in 
relation to stock options and SARs exercised
 
— 
 
879 
 
— 
Cash paid for ordinary shares repurchased
 
(9,764) 
 
— 
 
(3,011) 
Cash paid on dividends to MiX Telematics 
stockholders
 
(5,999) 
 
(5,359) 
 
(5,929) 
Movement in short-term debt
 
312 
 
(729) 
 
3,873 
Net cash used in financing activities
 
(15,451) 
 
(5,209) 
 
(5,067) 
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash 
equivalents, and restricted cash
 
(6,695) 
 
24,713 
 
(11,822) 
Cash and cash equivalents, and restricted cash 
at the beginning of the year
27,838
 
18,652 
 
46,343 
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and 
cash equivalents, and restricted cash
 
(2,491) 
 
2,978 
 
198 
Cash and cash equivalents, and restricted 
cash at the end of the year
 
18,652 
 
46,343 
 
34,719 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
102

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
1. Nature of the Business 
MiX Telematics Limited and its consolidated subsidiaries (“the Company”) is a global provider of connected fleet and mobile 
asset solutions delivered as Software-as-a-Service (“SaaS”). The Company’s solutions enable customers to manage, optimize 
and protect their investments in commercial fleets, mobile assets or personal vehicles. The Company’s solutions enable a wide 
range of customers, from large enterprise fleets to small fleet operators and consumers, to reduce fuel and other operating costs, 
improve efficiency, enhance regulatory compliance, promote driver safety, manage risk and mitigate theft. The Company’s 
solutions mostly rely on our proprietary, highly scalable technology platforms, which allows it to collect, analyze and deliver 
information based on data from customers’ vehicles. Using intuitive, web-based interfaces, reports or mobile applications, the 
Company’s fleet customers can access large volumes of real-time and historical data, monitor the location and status of their 
drivers and vehicles and analyze a wide number of key metrics across their fleet operations.
MiX Telematics Limited is a public company incorporated and domiciled in South Africa. The Company’s ordinary shares are 
publicly traded on the Johannesburg Stock Exchange (JSE: MIX) and its American Depositary Shares are listed on the New 
York Stock Exchange (NYSE: MIXT). The address of the Company’s principal executive office is 750 Park of Commerce 
Boulevard, Suite 100, Boca Raton, Florida, 33487.
2. Summary of significant accounting policies 
The principal accounting policies applied in the preparation of these consolidated financial statements are set out below. These 
accounting policies have been consistently applied to all the years presented, unless otherwise stated.
Basis of preparation and consolidation
The Company’s consolidated financial statements for the year ended March 31, 2022 are prepared in accordance with generally 
accepted accounting principles in the United States (“GAAP”) and should be read in conjunction with the accompanying notes 
thereto. All subsidiaries have been consolidated, including variable interest entities (“VIEs”) of which the Company is deemed 
to be the primary beneficiary. Inter-company transactions, balances and unrealized gains on transactions between group 
companies are eliminated. Unrealized losses are also eliminated except to the extent the transaction provides evidence of an 
impairment of the transferred asset. Accounting policies of subsidiaries have been adjusted to ensure consistency with the 
policies adopted by the Company. All subsidiaries have the same reporting dates as the Company.
Use of estimates 
The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires the use of estimates and assumptions 
that affect the amounts reported and disclosed. Significant estimates include, but are not limited to, allowances for doubtful 
accounts, the assessment of expected cash flows used in evaluating goodwill and long-lived assets for impairment, the 
amortization period for deferred commissions, the determination of useful lives of the Company’s customer relationships, 
contingencies, the classification of devices and other hardware as in-vehicle devices (equipment) versus inventory based on the 
future expectation of the different types of customer contracts, income and deferred taxes, unrecognized tax benefits and 
valuation allowances on deferred tax assets. Actual results could differ from those estimates, and such differences may be 
material to the consolidated financial statements.
We have considered the impact of COVID-19 on the estimates and assumptions used. As of March 31, 2022, we have taken 
into account the impact of COVID-19 on expected credit losses. We do not expect a significant impact on goodwill sensitivities 
and impairment assessments. However, future changes in economic conditions related to COVID-19 could have an impact on 
future estimates and judgements used.
Revenue from contracts with customers 
Significant judgments 
Revenue is recognized upon transfer of control of distinct promised products and/or services to customers in an amount that 
reflects the consideration that the Company expects to receive in exchange for those products and/or services. The Company 
enters into contracts that include the supply of fleet and mobile asset management equipment. For such contracts, the Company 
utilizes significant judgment to determine whether control of the equipment has transferred to the customer, and in instances 
where it does, it recognizes revenue in accordance with Revenue from Contracts with Customers (“ASC 606”). When control of 
the equipment does not transfer to the customer, which is when legal title does not transfer to the customer, our judgement is 
that the customer does not have the right to direct the use of the equipment when the customer does not operate the equipment 
or make any significant decisions about its use. In these instances the Company uses the equipment to provide fleet and mobile 
103

asset management services to the customer. Accordingly, these arrangements, which comprise virtually all of the transactions in 
which legal title does not pass to the customer, are not within the scope of ASC 842, Leases (“ASC 842”). Instead, for such 
contracts we have concluded that they are service contracts comprising a single performance obligation, and revenue is 
recognized over time pursuant to ASC 606. 
Recognition and measurement 
The Company provides fleet and mobile asset management solutions to its customers, and its principal revenue streams are (1) 
Subscription and (2) Hardware and other. Subscription revenue is recognized over time and hardware and other revenue is 
recognized at a point-in-time.
To provide services to customers, a device is required which collects and transmits information collected from the vehicle or 
other asset. Fleet customers may also obtain other items of hardware, virtually all of which are functionally-dependent on the 
device. Some customers obtain control of the device and other hardware (where legal title transfers to the customer); while 
other customers do not (where legal title remains with the Company). A contract arises on the acceptance of a customer’s 
purchase order, which is typically executed in writing.
In instances where the customer obtains control of the device and other hardware, which is typically upon installation or 
delivery to the customer, the device, the other hardware, the installation thereof and the service are each accounted for as 
separate performance obligations. The total transaction price is allocated to each performance obligation using relative stand-
alone selling prices. Revenue allocated to the device and other hardware is recognized upon delivery, and revenue allocated to 
installation is recognized once the installation is complete, since installation is completed within a day. Revenue related to the 
service performance obligation (subscription) is recognized on a straight-line basis over the expected contractual term, since we 
consistently deliver telematics services on a continuous basis over that period.
In instances where the customer does not obtain control of the device and other hardware, which is functionally-dependent on 
the device, there is only a single performance obligation, namely the service. The customer is not able to direct the use of these 
items, and accordingly these contracts do not contain leases. In these instances, the devices and other hardware are used by the 
Company to provide the services. The total revenue from these contracts is recognized as subscription revenue on a straight-line 
basis over the expected contractual term, since we consistently deliver telematics services on a continuous basis over that 
period. 
Revenue is presented net of discounts, value added tax, returns and after eliminating sales within the Company. 
The Company distributes devices and other hardware to certain small fleet operators and consumers through distributors. 
Distributors act as agents and hardware revenue is only recognized when the distributor sells the hardware unit to the end 
customer. Once a unit is sold to a customer, the customer enters into a service agreement directly with the Company. The 
obligation to supply the service and the credit risk rests with the Company. The subscription revenue is recognized when the 
service is rendered.
The Company also sells hardware to motor vehicle dealerships for fitment into their vehicle trading stock. These dealerships 
purchase the hardware from the Company and are considered to act as a principal in the contract because they obtain title to the 
hardware, bear the risks and rewards of ownership and accordingly control the hardware purchased. The buyer of the vehicle 
then enters into a service-only contract with the Company. Revenue is recognized upon sale of the hardware to the dealership 
and subscription revenue is recognized as the services are provided to the customer. 
The Company distributes devices and other hardware to enterprise fleet customers through value-added resellers. Value-added 
resellers are considered to act as a principal for the sale of hardware to the end customer, and revenue is recognized by the 
Company upon sale of the hardware unit to the resellers. Value-added resellers are also considered to act as a principal for the 
provision of the service to end customers because, even though the resellers do not provide the service themselves, the resellers 
control the right to receive the service before that right is transferred to the end customer, the resellers have the primary 
responsibility for fulfilling the promise to provide the service to the end customer, and the resellers have full discretion in 
establishing the prices charged to the end customer. Accordingly, subscription revenue is recognized as the service is provided 
to the resellers. 
Contract liabilities (deferred revenue)
Timing of revenue recognition may differ from the timing of invoicing customers or collecting payments from customers. 
Typically, corporate customers pay in arrears, while consumer customers pay in advance.
When customers are invoiced in advance for subscription services that will be provided over periods of more than one month, 
or pay in advance of service periods of more than one month, deferred revenue liabilities, or contract liabilities, are recorded. 
104

In all other instances, the Company has a right to consideration for subscription services from customers in an amount that 
corresponds directly with the value to customers of the Company’s performance completed to date. Therefore, revenue is 
recognized for the amount to which the Company has a right to invoice. The future subscription services will be provided over 
varying periods from 1 to 60 months.
Contracts for which the Company receives a payment for a time period which is more than 12 months in advance are 
considered to comprise a significant financing component. Interest expense is accrued on the deferred revenue liability. This 
results in the revenue being measured at the future value of the payments received. 
Deferred commissions
Commissions incurred to acquire contracts are capitalized and amortized, unless the amortization period is 12 months or less. 
The commission capitalized is attributed to the specific performance obligations in the related contract. Commission is 
considered commensurate with respect to a particular contract when equivalent/comparable commission is payable upon the 
extension or renewal of such a contract or upon the customer entering into a new contract. To the extent commission capitalized 
is commensurate, the commission attributable to service will be amortized over the minimum contractual period or, if shorter, 
the expected life of the contract. To the extent it is not commensurate, the commission capitalized that is attributable to service 
is amortized over the expected life of the contract. Typically, with regard to month-to-month contracts, commission payable is 
not considered commensurate for such contracts because no commission is payable as and when the customer extends each 
month by not giving notice. Accordingly, commission incurred on such contracts that is attributable to service is amortized over 
the expected life of the contract taking account of expected extensions/renewals. Commission capitalized that is attributable to 
hardware or installation is amortized in full at the time the related hardware, or installation, revenue is recognized. 
Recurring commission is commission which is payable for each month the customer remains with the Company. The amount 
capitalized reflects the total commission payable over the minimum contractual period or, if shorter, the expected life of the 
contract, together with the effect of the time value of money, where significant. 
As of March 31, 2021 and 2022, deferred commissions amounted to $3.7 million and $4.1 million respectively, which are 
included within Other assets on the Balance Sheet.
Amortization expense of external commissions capitalized is recognized in cost of sales, while that of internal commissions 
earned by the Company’s sales personnel is recognized in sales and marketing costs. Commissions not capitalized under the 12-
month practical expedient are also classified in the same manner.
 
Foreign currency 
Functional and reporting currency 
Each subsidiary is consolidated by translating its assets, liabilities and results into the functional currency of its immediate 
parent company, and subsequently the consolidated position, determined in South African Rand, is translated into U.S. Dollars 
(reporting currency). Assets and liabilities are translated into U.S. Dollars using the exchange rates in effect at the balance sheet 
date. Equity items are translated at historical exchange rates, while income and expense items are translated using average 
exchange rates for the period. Foreign currency translation adjustments are reported in stockholders’ equity as a component of 
accumulated other comprehensive income/loss until disposal. 
The movement in the foreign currency translation adjustments is as follows (in thousands):
As of March 31,
2021
2022
Cumulative foreign currency translation adjustments, beginning of year
$ 
(11,070) 
$ 
1,924 
Foreign currency translation gains for the year, net of tax
 
12,994 
 
1,985 
Cumulative foreign currency translation adjustments, end of year
$ 
1,924 
$ 
3,909 
Transactions and balances 
Transactions in foreign currencies are initially recorded by the Company and its subsidiaries in their respective functional 
currencies using the exchange rates at the dates of the transactions. Foreign currency monetary assets and liabilities are 
translated at exchange rates in effect at the balance sheet date. All resulting foreign exchange gains and losses are recognized in 
in Other income/expense in the Statement of Income, except for those gains and losses arising on long-term monetary assets 
held by a group entity in a foreign subsidiary for which settlement is neither planned nor anticipated within the foreseeable 
future, which forms part of the net investment of the foreign operation. These foreign exchange gains and losses are recognized 
as part of the foreign currency translation adjustments in accumulated other comprehensive income/loss until disposal.
105

Financial Assets 
Cash and cash equivalents 
Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash on hand and deposits held on call with banks; all of which are available for use by the 
Company and have an original maturity of less than three months. 
Restricted cash 
Restricted cash comprises deposits backing guarantees issued by financial institutions on behalf of the Company in respect of 
the Company’s obligations under certain lease, supply and other agreements, and cash held by MiX Telematics Enterprise BEE 
Trust (a VIE which is consolidated). Cash held by the Trust is to be used solely for the benefit of its beneficiaries. As at    
March 31, 2021 and 2022, the cash held by the Trust comprised $0.5 million and $0.7 million, respectively.
 
Accounts receivables 
Accounts receivables are amounts due from customers for goods sold or services performed in the ordinary course of business. 
Since the terms of payment are not more than 12 months, accounts receivables are recognized initially at their transaction price. 
Subsequent to initial recognition, accounts receivables are measured at amortized cost using the effective interest method, less 
an allowance for doubtful accounts, which reflects expected credit losses.
Allowance for doubtful accounts 
The allowance for doubtful accounts on accounts receivables is calculated by considering all relevant information, internal and 
external about the collectability of cash flows, including information about past events, current conditions, and reasonable and 
supportable forecasts of future economic conditions to appropriately reflect the risk of losses over the remaining contractual 
lives of the assets. Historical loss rates, calculated as actual losses over a period as a percentage of revenue, are adjusted for 
current conditions and management’s expectations about future economic conditions.
The allowance is measured on a collective basis where management groups their customers appropriately based on their credit 
risk characteristics. 
The allowance for doubtful accounts is a valuation account and the asset’s carrying amount is reduced and the amount of the 
loss is recognized in the consolidated statements of income. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance. Actual 
write-downs are recorded when the asset is deemed uncollectible after all efforts to recover have yielded no results. 
 
Loans to external parties
Loans to external parties are recognized initially at fair value, and subsequently at amortized cost using the effective interest 
method, less expected credit losses over the lifetime of the loan. 
Expected credit losses are determined using management’s estimate of the probability of default and the value of the underlying 
security. Loans to external parties are included within Other assets on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
Concentration of Credit Risk 
Credit risk arises from restricted cash, cash and cash equivalents as well as credit exposures to customers and loans to external 
parties. The Company analyses the credit risk for each of its new customers based on predefined requirements before standard 
payment and delivery terms and conditions are offered. An allowance for doubtful accounts is provided for individual accounts. 
Cash investments are only placed with reputable financial institutions. Management believes that financial institutions that hold 
the Company’s deposits are financially credit worthy and, accordingly, minimal credit risk exists with respect to those balances. 
Fair value measurements 
The Company has no financial assets or liabilities that are measured at fair value on a recurring basis. The carrying amounts of 
the Company’s financial instruments, except for loans to external parties, approximate their fair values due to their short-term 
nature. The fair value of the loans to external parties is determined using unobservable market data (Level 3 inputs), that 
represent management’s estimate of current interest rates that a commercial lender would charge the borrowers.
When certain triggering events occur, the Company is required to assess non-financial assets for impairment. When impaired, 
non-financial assets are written down to fair value. The Company uses valuation approaches that maximize the use of 
observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs to the extent possible. The Company determines fair value based 
on assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset in the principal or most advantageous market. 
106

Fair value is determined in accordance with ASC 820, Fair Value Measurement and is categorized as follows:
Level 1: Quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities; 
Level 2: Inputs other than quoted prices included within level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly (that 
is, as prices) or indirectly (that is, derived from prices); and 
Level 3: Inputs for the asset or liability that are not based on observable market data (that is, unobservable inputs). 
Inventories 
Inventories comprise finished goods which are stated at the lower of cost and net realizable value. Cost is determined using a 
first-in, first-out (“FIFO”), actual cost or weighted average cost basis. The cost of inventories includes the cost of 
manufacturing as charged by third parties and excludes borrowing costs. Net realizable value is the estimated selling price in 
the ordinary course of business less reasonably predictable costs of completion, disposal and transportation, and is based upon 
assumptions about future demand and market conditions. Impairments of inventory are not subsequently reversed. During the 
years ended March 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, $0.3 million, $0.7 million and $0.8 million was recognized, respectively, as a 
charge in cost of sales as a result of the write-down of inventory to net realizable value.
Property, plant and equipment 
Property, plant and equipment are stated at historical cost less accumulated depreciation and any accumulated impairment 
losses. Historical cost includes all expenditure directly attributable to the acquisition of the items of property, plant and 
equipment. Subsequent costs are included in the asset’s carrying amount or recognized as a separate asset, as appropriate, only 
when it is probable that future economic benefits associated with the item will flow to the Company and the cost of the item can 
be measured reliably. Repairs and maintenance are charged to the consolidated statements of income in the reporting period in 
which they are incurred. 
The cost of in-vehicle devices installed in vehicles (including installation and shipping costs) as well as the cost of uninstalled 
in-vehicle devices, are capitalized as property, plant and equipment. The Company depreciates installed in-vehicle devices on a 
straight-line basis over their expected useful lives, commencing upon installation, whereas uninstalled in-vehicle devices are not 
depreciated until installed. The related depreciation expense is recorded as part of cost of sales in the consolidated statements of 
income. Depreciation is calculated using the straight-line method to reduce the cost of the asset to its residual value over its 
estimated useful life, as follows: 
Plant and equipment
1 - 8 years
Motor vehicles
3 - 7 years
Furniture, fixtures and equipment
1 - 10 years
Computer and radio equipment
1 - 7 years
In-vehicle devices installed
1 - 8 years
The assets’ residual values and useful lives are reviewed, and adjusted if appropriate, at the end of each reporting period. 
Gains or losses on disposal or retirement are recognized within Other income/expenses in the consolidated statements of 
income. 
Right-of-use assets are included in Property, plant and equipment on the Consolidated Balance Sheets. 
Leases
The Company as a lessee
The Company recognizes a right-of-use asset and a lease liability at the lease commencement date for all leases except for those 
that have a lease term of 12 months or less and do not contain a purchase option that is reasonably certain to be exercised. The 
lease payments associated with these leases are recognized as an expense on a straight-line basis over the lease term.
Right-of use assets are initially measured at cost, which comprises the initial amount of the related lease liability adjusted for 
any lease payments made at or before the commencement date, plus any initial direct costs incurred, less any lease incentives 
received.
All of the Company’s leases which are capitalized are classified as operating leases. This means that the right-of-use asset is 
depreciated in such a manner, that together with the interest charge on the lease liability, the Company achieves a straight-line 
total lease expense over the lease period. 
107

Lease payments included in the measurement of the lease liability comprise the following:
•
fixed payments; and
•
lease payments in an optional renewal period if the Company is reasonably certain to exercise an extension option.
The lease liability is measured at commencement based on the present value of lease payments over the lease term using the 
relevant group entity’s incremental borrowing rate at inception of the lease. The lease liability is remeasured when the 
Company changes its assessment of whether an extension option will be exercised, when a termination notice is served, or 
when there are other changes to the terms of the lease such as rent concessions or an extension to the lease term that was not 
initially catered for in the lease agreement. 
When the lease liability is remeasured, a corresponding adjustment is made to the carrying amount of the right-of-use asset. The 
adjustment is recorded in the consolidated statements of income once the carrying amount of the right-of-use asset has been 
reduced to zero.
The Company presents right-of-use assets within Property, plant and equipment, and lease liabilities within Accrued expenses 
and other liabilities, on the Consolidated Balance Sheets.
Goodwill
Goodwill is tested for possible impairment at least annually, or when circumstances change that would more likely 
than not reduce the fair value of a reporting unit below its carrying value. Qualitative factors are first assessed to determine 
whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying value. Goodwill is allocated to a 
reporting unit for the purpose of impairment testing. If it is determined that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a 
reporting unit is less than its carrying value, the carrying value of the reporting unit, to which goodwill has been allocated, is 
compared to its fair value, and a goodwill impairment charge is recognized for the amount (if any) by which the carrying value 
exceeds the fair value, limited to the amount of the goodwill. No impairments of goodwill existed as of the most recent testing 
date of March 31, 2022 or the previous testing date of March 31, 2021. The changes in the carrying value of goodwill during 
fiscal year 2021 and fiscal year 2022 are attributable only to foreign currency translation adjustments.
The allocation of goodwill to reporting units is as follows (in thousands):
As of March 31,
2021
2022
Central Services Organization
$ 
6,913 
$ 
7,116 
Europe
 
8,993 
 
8,591 
Middle East and Australasia
 
4,364 
 
4,365 
Africa
 
23,668 
 
24,362 
$ 
43,938 
$ 
44,434 
Sensitivity of goodwill to impairment as of March 31, 2022 was as follows:
Central 
Services 
Organization
Africa
Europe
Middle East 
and 
Australasia
Fair value of reporting unit exceeded its carrying amount by
 315.7 %
 321.0 %
 33.7 %
 300.9 %
Post-tax discount rate used to determine fair value
 14.6 %
 14.6 %
 10.8 %
 8.4 %
Growth rate used to extrapolate cash flow beyond the budget 
period
 4.6 %
 4.6 %
 3.4 %
 2.5 %
The following mutually exclusive changes will result in nil 
headroom
Post-tax discount rate applied to the expected cash flow 
projections
 32.5 %
 39.2 %
 13.1 %
 27.3 %
Decrease in the cash flow projections of
 75.9 %
 76.2 %
 25.2 %
 75.1 %
If the growth rate in any reporting entity is changed to zero, this does not result in any impairment. Although there were no 
impairments of goodwill as of March 31, 2022, significant judgement was exercised in determining the fair value of each 
reporting unit. In particular, to the extent that anticipated new contracts do not materialize and the business strategy does not 
come to fruition, or key personnel are not retained, the forecasts on which the impairment tests were performed could be 
negatively impacted.
108

Intangible assets 
Patents and trademarks 
Patents and trademarks acquired in a business combination are recognized at fair value at the acquisition date. Patents and 
trademarks have a finite useful life and are subsequently carried at cost less accumulated amortization and accumulated 
impairment losses. Amortization is calculated using the straight-line method to allocate the cost of patents and trademarks over 
their estimated useful lives which range from 3 to 20 years. 
Customer relationships 
Customer relationships acquired in a business combination are recognized at fair value at the acquisition date. Customer 
relationships have a finite useful life and are subsequently carried at cost less accumulated amortization and accumulated 
impairment losses. Amortization is calculated over the expected useful life of the customer relationship ranging from 2 to 15 
years and reflects the pattern in which future economic benefits of the customer relationship are expected to be generated. The 
useful life principally reflects management’s view of the average economic life of the customer base and is assessed by 
reference to factors such as customer churn rates. 
Internal-use software and technology
The Company capitalizes as intangible assets, internal-use software acquired or developed solely to meet the Company’s 
internal needs. Costs, excluding general and administrative costs such as general overheads, legal, research, business process 
engineering and data conversion costs, are capitalized from the date on which management implicitly or explicitly authorizes, or 
commits to fund, the project, and it is probable that the project will be completed and the software will perform the intended 
function (application development stage). All costs incurred during the preliminary development stage are expensed. 
Capitalization ceases when the project is substantially complete and the software is ready for its intended use.
Costs, including annual licenses, associated with maintaining computer software programs, and training costs are expensed as 
incurred. Costs incurred for upgrades and enhancements (modifications to existing internal-use software that provides 
additional functionality) are capitalized during the application development stage. 
Software capitalized is amortized on a straight line basis over its estimated useful life ranging from 1 to 18 years, commencing 
on the date when the software is ready for its intended use. 
Computer software for external use 
Computer software for external use refers to the firmware that is developed by the Company for the devices and other hardware 
provided to its customers. The costs of developing firmware are expensed as incurred prior to the establishment of its 
technological feasibility, from which point the development costs are capitalized and recognized as intangible assets. For the 
periods presented, technological feasibility could only be demonstrated shortly before the release of the firmware, and as a 
result, the development costs that meet the requirements for capitalization are not material. 
Impairment of long-lived assets
Intangible assets that are not ready for use are not subject to amortization but are assessed annually for impairment or more 
frequently if events or changes in circumstances indicate that they might be impaired. 
Long-lived assets that are subject to amortization or depreciation are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in 
circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. 
An asset is written down immediately to its fair value if its carrying amount is greater than its future undiscounted cash flows. 
Recognized impairment losses are not reversed.
For the purposes of assessing impairment, long-lived assets are grouped with other assets and liabilities at the lowest level for 
which identifiable cash flows are largely independent of the cash flows of other assets and liabilities.
Impairment losses recognized during the years ended March 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 were less than $0.1 million for each year. 
Common stock 
Incremental external costs directly attributable to the issuance of new shares or the exercise of stock options are shown in equity 
as a deduction, net of tax, from the proceeds.
If a Group company purchases the Company’s equity instruments (treasury stock), then the consideration paid, including any 
directly attributable incremental costs (net of income taxes) is deducted from equity attributable to ordinary shareholders of the 
Company as treasury stock until the shares are canceled or reissued. If such ordinary shares are subsequently reissued, then any 
consideration received, net of any directly attributable incremental transaction costs and the related income tax effects, is 
109

included in equity attributable to ordinary shareholders of the Company. MiX Telematics Investments Proprietary Ltd (“MiX 
Investments”), a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, holds 53,816,750 of the Company’s ordinary shares of no par value. 
These shares are held as treasury stock.
Share repurchases
On May 23, 2017, the Company’s Board of Directors approved a share repurchase program of up to R270 million (equivalent 
of $18.6 million as of March 31, 2022) under which the Company may repurchase its ordinary shares, including American 
Depositary Shares (“ADSs”). On December 3, 2021, our Board approved an increase to the share repurchase program under 
which the Company may repurchase ordinary shares, including ADSs. Post this increase, and after giving effect to shares 
already purchased under the program as at December 2, 2021, the Company could repurchase additional shares with a 
cumulative value of R160 million (the equivalent of $11.0 million as of March 31, 2022). The total value of the whole share 
repurchase program post the December 3, 2021 increase is R396.5 million (the equivalent of $27.4 million as of March 31, 
2022). Subsequent to the approved increase in the share repurchase program shares with a value of R44.7 million (the 
equivalent of $3.1 million as of March 31, 2022) were repurchased. At March 31, 2022, additional shares to the value of R115.3 
million (the equivalent of $8.0 million as of March 31, 2022) may still be repurchased.
The Company may repurchase its shares from time to time at its discretion through open market transactions and block trades, 
based on ongoing assessments of the capital needs of the Company, the market price of its securities and general market 
conditions. This share repurchase program may be discontinued at any time by the Board of Directors, and the Company has no 
obligation to repurchase any amount of its securities under the program. The repurchase program will be funded out of existing 
cash resources.
During the years ended March 31, 2020 and 2022, the Company repurchased 16,856,001 and 6,020,085 shares, respectively, for 
an aggregate repurchase consideration of $9.8 million and $3.0 million respectively. Subsequent to the repurchases during fiscal 
year 2022, the shares were de-listed and now form part of the authorized unissued share capital of the Company. MiX 
Investments holds 13,816,750 of the shares repurchased during fiscal year 2020, and the balance of the shares repurchased 
during fiscal year 2020 of 3,039,251 were de-listed and now form part of the authorized unissued share capital of the Company. 
No share repurchases were made during fiscal year 2021. The maximum value of shares that may still be repurchased under the 
program is R115.3 million (equivalent of $8.0 million as of March 31, 2022). The authority to repurchase shares will expire at 
the upcoming annual general meeting. 
Taxation 
Income taxes are accounted for under the asset and liability method. Income tax expense is recognized in the consolidated 
statements of income, except to the extent that it relates to items recognized in other comprehensive income or directly in 
equity. The Company uses the portfolio approach for releasing income tax effects from accumulated other comprehensive 
income.
The current income tax charge is calculated on the basis of the tax laws and tax rates enacted by the reporting date in the 
countries where the Company and its subsidiaries operate and generate taxable income. Interest, and penalties, incurred on the 
underpayment of income taxes is classified as interest expense, and administration expenses, respectively.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the 
financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases and operating loss and tax 
credit carryforwards. Deferred tax is measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which 
those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. Valuation allowances are provided when necessary to 
reduce deferred tax assets to the extent it is more likely than not that some portion of the deferred tax asset will not be realized.
Management periodically evaluates its tax positions with respect to situations in which applicable tax regulation is subject to 
interpretation. For uncertainties in income tax positions if it is more likely than not that some tax benefit will be sustained based 
on the technical merits of the position, then the tax benefit recognized is the largest amount of benefit that is greater than 50% 
likely of being realized upon ultimate settlement. If it is not more likely than not that some tax benefit will be sustained, then 
zero tax benefit is recognized. There were no material uncertain tax positions as of March 31, 2021 and 2022.
Deferred tax liabilities arising on investments in domestic subsidiaries are not recognized to the extent that the investment can 
be recovered on a tax-free basis; and on investments in foreign subsidiaries to the extent that the undistributed earnings will be 
invested indefinitely or will be remitted in a tax-free liquidation.
Stock-based compensation 
The Company operates various stock-based compensation plans, under which the entity receives services from employees as 
consideration for equity instruments of the Company. Settlement has taken place out of a fresh issue of shares. The equity 
110

instruments that may be granted in terms of the plans include stock options, retention shares, performance shares and stock 
appreciation rights, all of which entitle the holder to obtain shares in the Company. The fair value, determined at grant date, of 
the equity instruments granted is recognized as an expense over the vesting period, taking expected forfeiture into account, with 
a corresponding credit to additional paid-in capital. At the end of each reporting period, the Company revises its estimate of the 
number of equity instruments that are expected to vest, using historical and current information, and recognizes the impact of 
any revisions in the consolidated statements of income, with a corresponding adjustment to additional paid-in capital. Expected 
forfeitures relating to service conditions are estimated to be 5%.
Advertising
Advertising costs are expensed as incurred and are classified as sales and marketing expense on the consolidated statements of 
income. For the years ended March 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, $2.0 million, $2.3 million and $4.2 million respectively, were 
expensed.
Recent accounting pronouncements
None of the accounting pronouncements required to be applied by the Company for the first time for the year ended 31 March 
2022 had a significant financial reporting impact. In addition, new accounting pronouncements issued by 31 March 2022, but 
not yet effective for the Company, are not expected to have a significant financial reporting impact.
3. Credit risk related to accounts receivables
As of March 31, 2021 and 2022, the aging analysis of accounts receivables is as follows (in thousands):
Gross
Allowance for 
doubtful accounts 
Net
2021
Not past due
$ 
10,156 
$ 
(513) 
$ 
9,643 
Past due by 1 to 30 days
 
4,769 
 
(436) 
 
4,333 
Past due by 31 to 60 days
 
2,457 
 
(259) 
 
2,198 
Past due by more than 60 days
 
7,458 
 
(4,367) 
 
3,091 
Total
$ 
24,840 
$ 
(5,575) 
$ 
19,265 
Gross
Allowance for 
doubtful accounts 
Net
2022
Not past due
$ 
13,332 
$ 
(533) 
$ 
12,799 
Past due by 1 to 30 days
 
4,124 
 
(841) 
 
3,283 
Past due by 31 to 60 days
 
3,113 
 
(523) 
 
2,590 
Past due by more than 60 days
 
9,949 
 
(3,529) 
 
6,420 
Total
$ 
30,518 
$ 
(5,426) 
$ 
25,092 
The movements in the allowance for doubtful accounts are as follows (in thousands):
2021
2022
Balance at April 1,
$ 
3,602 
$ 
5,575 
Bad debt provision
 
2,961 
 
2,559 
Write-offs, net of recoveries
 
(1,656) 
 
(2,855) 
Foreign currency translation differences
 
668 
 
147 
Balance at March 31,
$ 
5,575 
$ 
5,426 
The measurement of expected credit losses is a function of the probability of default, loss given default (i.e. the magnitude of 
the loss if there is default) and the exposure at default. The assessment of the probability given default and loss given default is 
based on historical data adjusted by relevant forward-looking information. The exposure at default is represented by the asset’s 
gross carrying amount at the reporting date.
111

The Company considers a default to have occurred when a receivable is more than 120 days past due or information determined 
internally or obtained from external sources indicates that the customer is unlikely to pay its creditors, including the Company, 
in full. Amounts provided for are generally written off when there is no expectation of recovering the amount, in accordance 
with the Company’s write-off policy.
Overview of the Company’s exposure to credit risk from customers
The maximum exposure to credit risk at the reporting date is the carrying value of each receivable and loan to external parties, 
net of impairment losses where relevant. As of March 31, 2021 and 2022, the Company has no significant concentration of 
credit risk, due to its spread of customers across various operations and geographical locations.
The Company does not hold any collateral as security.
Net accounts receivables as of March 31, 2021 and 2022 of $2.3 million and $4.1 million, respectively, are pledged as security 
for the Company’s overdraft facilities.
4. Property, plant and equipment
Property, plant and equipment comprises owned and right-of-use assets. The Company leases many assets including property, 
motor vehicles and office equipment.
The cost and accumulated depreciation of owned assets are as follows (in thousands): 
As of March 31,
2021
2022
Owned assets
Plant and equipment
 
719 
 
791 
Motor vehicles
 
993 
 
1,938 
Furniture, fixtures and equipment
1,519
1,553
Computer and radio equipment
3,639
4,036
In-vehicle devices
 
53,448 
 
65,881 
Assets in progress
7
332
Owned assets, gross
 
60,325 
 
74,531 
Less: accumulated depreciation and impairments
 
(42,955) 
 
(46,597) 
Owned assets, net
$ 
17,370 
$ 
27,934 
                                                                                                                                      
Total depreciation expense related to owned assets during the years ended March 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 was $16.1 million, 
$12.9 million and $10.7 million, respectively. Depreciation expense related to in-vehicle devices is included in subscription cost 
of revenue.
The cost and accumulated depreciation of right-of-use assets are as follows (in thousands):
As of March 31,
2021
2022
Right-of-use assets
Property
$ 
8,348 
$ 
7,019 
Equipment, motor vehicles and other
 
226 
 
305 
Less: accumulated depreciation
 
(2,481) 
 
(2,984) 
Right-of-use assets, net
$ 
6,093 
$ 
4,340 
112

5. Intangible assets
Intangible assets comprise the following (in thousands): 
As of March 31, 2021
As of March 31, 2022
Useful 
life (in 
years)
Gross 
Carrying 
amount
Accumulated 
amortization
Net
Gross 
Carrying 
amount
Accumulated 
amortization
Net
Patents and trademarks
3 - 20
$ 
115 $ 
(82) $ 
33 $ 
105 $ 
(70) $ 
35 
Customer relationships
2 - 15
 
2,687  
(2,271)  
416  
2,772  
(2,528)  
244 
Internal-use software, 
technology and other
1 - 18
 
35,618  
(17,764)  
17,854  
42,335  
(22,154)  
20,181 
Total
$ 
38,420 $ 
(20,117) $ 18,303 $ 
45,212 $ 
(24,752) $ 20,460 
For the years ended March 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, amortization expense of $3.8 million, $3.7 million, and $4.3 million has 
been recognized, respectively. 
The weighted average amortization period of intangible assets purchased during the year ended March 31, 2021 and 2022 is 1 
year and 5 years, respectively.
As of March 31, 2021 and 2022, there was internal-use software in progress of $3.8 million, and $5.5 million, respectively.
As of March 31, 2022, the estimated future amortization expense is as follows (in thousands):
Years ending March 31,
2023
$ 
8,115 
2024
 
4,767 
2025
 
4,124 
2026
 
2,521 
2027
 
650 
Thereafter
 
283 
Total
$ 
20,460 
6. Other assets
The following is a summary of other assets (in thousands):
As of March 31,
2021
2022
Deferred commissions
$ 
3,687 
$ 
4,135 
Loans to external parties and other receivables
 
747 
 
853 
Total other assets
$ 
4,434 
$ 
4,988 
113

Deferred commissions
Deferred commissions arise from commissions paid to sales employees and external third parties to obtain contracts with 
customers, unless the amortization period is 12 months or less, in which instance it is expensed immediately. The following is a 
summary of the amortization expense (in thousands): 
As of March 31,
2021
2022
Amortization recognized during the year:
$ 
(3,533) 
$ 
(3,566) 
–
Cost of revenue (external commissions)
 
(2,552) 
 
(2,602) 
–
Sales and marketing (internal commissions)
 
(981) 
 
(964) 
Loans to external parties
The loans to external parties relate to Broad-based Black Economic Empowerment transactions entered to in South Africa.
As of March 31, 2021 and March 31, 2022, the amortized cost of the loans to Black Industrialists Group Property Management 
Company (Pty) Ltd (“BIG”) and HSW Management services CC (“HSW”) amounted to $0.6 million and $0.7 million, 
respectively. All the loans were originated during fiscal year 2020, and are on off-market terms. No interest has been charged 
since origination. The imputed interest rate on the loans to BIG and HSW is 9.65% and 11.65%, respectively. Imputed interest 
rate represents the interest rate that results from a process of approximation required when the present value of a loan must be 
estimated because an established exchange price is not determinable and the loan has no ready market, while effective interest 
rate is the rate of return implicit in the loan, that is, contractual interest rate adjusted for any net deferred loan fees or costs, 
premium, or discount existing at the origination of the loan.
7. Accrued expenses and other liabilities
Accrued expenses comprise the following (in thousands): 
As of March 31,
2021
2022
Current:
Product warranties 
$ 
605 
$ 
630 
Maintenance
 
609 
 
506 
Employee-related accruals
 
6,166 
 
7,621 
Lease liabilities
 
1,395 
 
932 
Accrued commissions
 
2,199 
 
3,017 
Other accruals
 
6,356 
 
6,904 
Total current
$ 
17,330 
$ 
19,610 
Non-current:
Lease liabilities
$ 
4,895 
$ 
3,655 
Other liabilities
 
968 
 
689 
Total non-current
$ 
5,863 
$ 
4,344 
Product warranties
The Company provides warranties on certain products and undertakes to repair or replace items that fail to perform 
satisfactorily. Management estimates the related provision for future warranty claims based on historical warranty claim 
information, the product lifetime, as well as recent trends that might suggest that past cost information may differ from future 
claims. The table below provides details of the movement in the accrual in thousands:
114

As of March 31,
2021
2022
Product warranties
Opening balance
$ 
616 
$ 
612 
Warranty expense
 
102 
 
307 
Utilized
 
(211) 
 
(242) 
Foreign currency translation difference
 
105 
 
6 
Balance as of March 31
$ 
612 
$ 
683 
Non-current portion (included in other liabilities)
$ 
7 
$ 
53 
Current portion
$ 
605 
$ 
630 
8. Deferred revenue
The movement in deferred revenue is as following (in thousands):
As of March 31,
2021
2022
Deferred revenue
Opening balance
$ 
5,077 
$ 
5,788 
Increases during the year
 
33,009 
 
53,267 
Recognized as revenue
 
(33,210) 
 
(52,486) 
Foreign currency translation difference
 
912 
 
123 
Closing balance
$ 
5,788 
$ 
6,692 
During the year ended March 31, 2021 and March 31, 2022, revenue of $3.1 million and $3.8 million, respectively, was 
recognized which was included in the deferred revenue balances as of the beginning of the year. 
9. Development expenditure
Development expenditure incurred comprises the following (in thousands): 
As of March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Costs capitalized (1)
$ 
3,359 
$ 
2,928 
$ 
3,751 
Costs expensed (2)
 
5,467 
 
4,284 
 
5,597 
Total costs incurred
$ 
8,826 
$ 
7,212 
$ 
9,348 
(1) Costs capitalized relate only to the development of internal-use software, which are recognized in accordance with the 
Intangible assets (Internal-use software and technology) accounting policy.
(2) Costs expensed are included in Administration and other expenses in the consolidated statements of income.
115

10. Leases 
The Company leases property, office equipment and vehicles under operating leases. The lease terms vary between 1 month and 
121 months, with many leases providing renewal rights and certain leases with annual escalations of up to 8% per annum. To 
the extent the Company is reasonably certain that it will exercise renewal options, such options have been included in the lease 
terms used for calculating the right-of-use assets and lease liabilities. Right-of-use assets are included in Property, plant and 
equipment in the Consolidated Balance Sheets and lease liabilities related to the Company’s operating leases are included in 
Accrued expenses and other liabilities and Long-term accrued expenses and other liabilities in the Consolidated Balance Sheets.
Where lease terms are 12-months or less, and meet the criteria for short-term lease classification, no right-of-use asset and no 
lease liability are recognized. 
The components of lease cost are as follows (in thousands): 
As of March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Operating lease cost
$ 
1,631 
$ 
1,657 
$ 
1,643 
Short-term lease cost
198
407
 
330 
Total lease cost
$ 
1,829 
$ 
2,064 
$ 
1,973 
Supplemental cash flow information and non-cash activity related to the Company’s operating leases are as follows (in 
thousands):
As of March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Operating cash flow information:
Cash payments included in the measurement of 
lease liabilities
$ 
1,500 
$ 
1,540 
$ 
1,502 
Non-cash activity:
Right-of-use assets obtained in exchange for 
new operating lease liabilities
$ 
4,520 
$ 
110 
$ 
417 
Weighted-average remaining lease term - 
operating leases (months) (1)
 
46 
 
38 
 
25 
Weighted-average discount rate - operating 
leases
 7.2 %
 7.3 %
 8.0 %
(1) Including expected renewals where appropriate.
Maturities of operating lease liabilities as of March 31 were as follows (in thousands):
2023
$ 
1,261 
2024
 
846 
2025
 
748 
2026
 
667 
2027
 
684 
Thereafter
 
1,733 
Total future minimum lease payments
 
5,939 
Less: Imputed interest
 
(1,352) 
Present value of future minimum lease payments
 
4,587 
Less: Current portion of lease liabilities
 
(932) 
Non-current portion of lease liabilities
$ 
3,655 
116

11. Income taxes
The following table presents domestic and foreign components of income/(loss) before income tax expense (in thousands):
As of March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Domestic (South Africa)
$ 
30,464 
$ 
14,443 
$ 
12,254 
Foreign
 
(9,648) 
 
2,786 
 
1,111 
Income before income tax expense
$ 
20,816 
$ 
17,229 
$ 
13,365 
The following is a summary of the Company’s provision for income taxes for the years ended March 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022:
As of March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Current tax
Domestic (South Africa)
$ 
(4,261) 
$ 
(5,768) 
$ 
(4,346) 
Foreign federal
 
— 
 
(165) 
 
(74) 
Foreign state
 
(978) 
 
(1,020) 
 
(517) 
Total Current
 
(5,239) 
 
(6,953) 
 
(4,937) 
Deferred tax
Domestic (South Africa)
 
(4,744) 
 
3,987 
 
573 
Foreign federal
 
55 
 
83 
 
(155) 
Foreign state
 
99 
 
249 
 
101 
Total deferred
 
(4,590) 
 
4,319 
 
519 
Total income tax expense
$ 
(9,829) 
$ 
(2,634) 
$ 
(4,418) 
117

The following table provides a reconciliation of the income tax expense calculated at the South African statutory tax rate, of 28%, to the 
income tax expense:
As of March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Income before income tax expense
$ 
20,816 
$ 
17,229 
$ 
13,365 
Tax at South African statutory rate of 28%
 
5,828 
 
4,824 
 
3,742 
Tax effect of:
– Income not subject to tax
 
— 
 
(35) 
 
(55) 
– Non-deductible expenses (1)
 
235 
 
929 
 
626 
– Non-deductible/(non-taxable) foreign exchange 
movements (2)
 
4,085 
 
(3,401) 
 
(419) 
– Investment in subsidiaries
 
42 
 
217 
 
202 
– Withholding tax
 
— 
 
23 
 
113 
– Utilization of previously unrecognized tax 
losses (3)
 
(195) 
 
(252) 
 
53 
– Foreign tax paid (4)
 
623 
 
425 
 
357 
– Foreign tax rate differential
 
(213) 
 
(241) 
 
(115) 
– Recognition of previously unrecognized tax 
losses 
 
(11) 
 
(73) 
 
35 
– Tax losses not recognized
 
75 
 
92 
 
314 
– Under-provision prior years
 
138 
 
298 
 
(102) 
– Tax incentives in addition to cost incurred (5)
 
(897) 
 
(321) 
 
(253) 
– Transfer pricing imputation
 
65 
 
21 
 
67 
–  Tax rate change(6)
 
— 
 
— 
 
(226) 
– Imputation of controlled foreign company 
income
 
119 
 
100 
 
83 
– Other
 
(65) 
 
28 
 
(4) 
Income tax expense
$ 
9,829 
$ 
2,634 
$ 
4,418 
(1) These non-deductible expenses consist primarily of items of a capital nature and costs attributable to exempt income, primarily 
dividends from subsidiaries.
(2) The non-deductible/(non-taxable) foreign exchange movements arise as a result of the Company’s internal loan structures.
(3) The utilization of assessed losses arises mainly in Europe where historical assessed losses were being utilized.
(4) The foreign tax paid relates primarily to withholding taxes on revenue earned in jurisdictions where the Company does not have a 
jurisdictional presence.
(5) The tax incentives relate mainly to research and development allowances, as well as learnership allowances received in terms of the 
South African tax authorities. MiX Telematics International Proprietary Limited (“MiX International”), a subsidiary of the Company, is 
eligible for a 150% allowance for research and development spend in terms of section 11D of the South African Income Tax Act. 
During fiscal years prior to 2017, the additional 50% tax deduction was disallowed on certain projects because the South African 
Department of Science and Innovation (“DSI”) was of the view that the amounts claimed did not constitute qualifying expenditure. 
After a lengthy legal process, the DSI approved the additional deductions during fiscal year 2020, resulting in the recognition of a tax 
benefit of $0.5 million for fiscal year 2020 that previously was not considered probable.
(6)  The tax rate change relates to MiX Telematics Europe Limited’s corporate tax rate change from 19% to 24%.
The Company’s weighted average tax rate is 33.1% (2021: 15.3%, 2020: 47.2%).
118

The Company’s net deferred tax liabilities consist of the following (in thousands):
As of March 31,
2021
2022
Deferred tax assets
Deferred revenue
 
1,224 
 
1,432 
Capital allowances for tax purposes
 
823 
 
1,010 
Accruals
 
5,037 
 
4,936 
Tax losses
 
1,456 
 
2,000 
Stock based compensation
 
540 
 
554 
Deferred foreign currency losses
 
407 
 
338 
Recurring commission liability
 
186 
 
241 
Lease liabilities
 
552 
 
517 
Other
 
166 
 
39 
Gross deferred tax assets
 
10,391 
 
11,067 
Set-off of deferred tax balances
 
(6,098) 
 
(6,652) 
Net deferred tax assets before valuation allowance
 
4,293 
 
4,415 
Less valuation allowance
 
(511) 
 
(647) 
Net deferred tax assets
 
3,782 
 
3,768 
Deferred tax liabilities
Capital allowances for tax purposes
 
3,494 
 
3,629 
Intangible assets
 
3,559 
 
3,735 
Prepaid expenses
 
133 
 
232 
Deferred foreign currency gains
 
6,186 
 
5,673 
Investment in subsidiaries
 
427 
 
646 
Deferred commissions 
 
802 
 
719 
Lease assets
 
482 
 
638 
Other
 
202 
 
352 
Gross deferred tax liabilities
 
15,285 
 
15,624 
Set-off of deferred tax balances
 
(6,098) 
 
(6,652) 
Net deferred tax liabilities
 
9,187 
 
8,972 
Net deferred tax liability
 
(5,405) 
 
(5,204) 
The gross movement in net deferred tax assets/(liabilities) is as follows:
Opening balance
 
(8,328) 
 
(5,405) 
Foreign currency translation
 
(1,415) 
 
(268) 
Other comprehensive income
 
19 
 
(50) 
Statement of Income charge
 
4,319 
 
519 
Closing balance
 
(5,405) 
 
(5,204) 
119

Recognition of deferred tax
Deferred tax at year-end has been recognized using the following corporate tax rates:
Region
2021
2022
South Africa
 28 %
 28 %
Australia
 30 %
 30 %
Brazil
 34 %
 34 %
Romania
 16 %
 16 %
Thailand
 20 %
 20 %
Uganda
 30 %
 30 %
United Arab Emirates
 — %
 — %
United Kingdom
 19 %
 24 %
United States of America
 21 %
 21 %
Realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of future taxable income, if any, the timing and amount of which are 
uncertain. As of March 31, 2021 and 2022, the Company believes that it is not more likely than not that deferred tax assets of $0.5 
million and $0.6 million, respectively, will be realized in respect of cumulative tax losses amounting to $2.0 million and $2.5 million, 
respectively. Accordingly, the Company has recorded a valuation allowance on such deferred tax assets. 
For the year ended March 31, 2021, the valuation allowance decreased by $0.3 million primarily as a result of utilizing previously 
unrecognized tax losses. For the year ended March 31, 2022, the valuation allowance increased by 0.3 million as a result of an increase 
in deferred tax assets not recognized on current year tax losses.
As at March 31, 2021 and 2022, the Company had tax loss carryforwards of $11.7 million and $5.1 million. respectively. The tax loss 
carryforwards can be carried forward indefinitely, except for tax losses of $0.3 million in Thailand, which expire between 2023 and 
2025.
120

12. Earnings per share
Basic
Basic earnings per share is calculated by dividing the income attributable to ordinary shareholders of the parent by the weighted 
average number of ordinary shares in issue during the year.
The net income and weighted average number of shares used in the calculation of basic and diluted earnings per share are as 
follows (in thousands, except per share data):
As of March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Numerator (basic)
Net income attributable to MiX Telematics 
Limited stockholders
$ 
10,987 
$ 
14,595 
$ 
8,947 
Denominator (basic)
Weighted average number of ordinary shares in 
issue and outstanding
 
553,653 
 
549,415 
 
551,923 
Basic earnings per share 
$ 
0.02 
$ 
0.03 
$ 
0.02 
American Depository Shares (1):
Net income attributable to MiX Telematics 
Limited stockholders
$ 
10,987 
$ 
14,595 
$ 
8,947 
Weighted average number of American 
Depository Shares in issue and outstanding
 
22,146 
 
21,977 
 
22,077 
Basic earnings per American Depository Share
$ 
0.50 
$ 
0.66 
$ 
0.41 
(1) One American Depository Share is the equivalent of 25 ordinary shares.
Diluted
Diluted earnings per share is calculated by dividing the diluted income attributable to ordinary shareholders by the diluted 
weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue during the year. Stock options, retention shares and stock appreciation 
rights granted to employees under the TeliMatrix Group Executive Incentive Scheme and the MiX Telematics Long-Term 
Incentive Plan (“LTIP”) are considered to be potential ordinary shares. They have been included in the determination of diluted 
earnings per share if the required target share price or annual shareholder return hurdles (as applicable) would have been met 
based on the performance up to the reporting date, and to the extent to which they are dilutive. No further awards will be made 
in terms of the TeliMatrix Group Executive Incentive Scheme going forward.
 
121

As of March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Numerator (diluted)
Diluted net income attributable to MiX Telematics 
Limited stockholders
$ 
10,987 
$ 
14,595 
$ 
8,947 
Denominator (diluted)
Weighted average number of ordinary shares in 
issue and outstanding
 
553,653 
 
549,415 
 
551,923 
Adjusted for:
– potentially dilutive effect of stock 
appreciation rights
 
12,560 
 
9,872 
 
10,531 
– potentially dilutive effect of restricted share 
units
 
— 
 
774 
 
1,504 
– potentially dilutive effect of stock options
 
1,666 
 
562 
 
— 
Diluted weighted average number of ordinary 
shares in issue and outstanding
 
567,879 
 
560,624 
 
563,958 
Diluted earnings per share
$ 
0.02 
$ 
0.03 
$ 
0.02 
American Depository Shares (1):
Diluted net income attributable to MiX Telematics 
Limited stockholders
$ 
10,987 
$ 
14,595 
$ 
8,947 
Diluted weighted average number of American 
Depository Shares in issue and outstanding
 
22,715 
 
22,425 
 
22,558 
Diluted earnings per American Depository 
Share
$ 
0.48 
$ 
0.65 
$ 
0.40 
(1) One American Depository Share is the equivalent of 25 ordinary shares.
13. Dividends
The following dividends were declared (in thousands):
As of March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Dividends declared
$ 
6,015 
$ 
5,367 
$ 
5,948 
14. Segment information
The Company has 6 reportable segments, which are based on the geographical location of the 5 Regional Sales Offices 
(“RSOs”) and also includes the Central Services Organization (“CSO”). CSO is the central services organization that 
wholesales products and services to RSOs who, in turn, interface with our end-customers, distributors and dealers. CSO is also 
responsible for the development of hardware and software platforms and provides common marketing, product management, 
technical and distribution support to each of the other reportable segments. CSO is a reportable segment because it produces 
discrete financial information which is reviewed by the chief operating decision maker (“CODM”) and has the ability to 
generate external revenues.
The CODM has been identified as the Chief Executive Officer who makes strategic decisions for the Company. The 
performance of the reportable segments has been measured and evaluated by the CODM using Segment Adjusted EBITDA, 
which is a measure that uses income before income tax expense excluding net interest income/expense, net foreign exchange 
gains/losses, net loss/profit on sale of property, plant and equipment, depreciation, amortization, operating lease costs, stock–
based compensation costs, restructuring costs, legal costs associated with patent infringement, gains or losses on the disposal or 
impairments of long-lived assets and corporate and consolidation entries. Product development costs are capitalized and 
amortized and this amortization is excluded from Segment Adjusted EBITDA.
122

In determining Segment Adjusted EBITDA, the margin generated by CSO, net of any unrealized intercompany profit, is 
allocated to the geographic region where the external revenue is recorded by our RSOs. The costs remaining in CSO relate 
mainly to research and development of hardware and software platforms, common marketing, product management and 
technical and distribution support to each of the RSOs. 
Each RSO’s results therefore reflects the external revenue earned, as well as its performance before the remaining CSO and 
corporate costs allocations. 
The segment information provided to the CODM is as follows (in thousands):
As of March 31, 2020
Subscription
revenue (1)
Hardware
and other
revenue (2)
Total
revenue
Segment Adjusted
EBITDA
Regional Sales Offices
Africa
$ 
70,886 
$ 
5,870 
$ 
76,756 
$ 
33,103 
Europe
 
11,682 
 
3,345 
 
15,027 
 
5,603 
Americas
 
22,322 
 
2,207 
 
24,529 
 
10,370 
Middle East and Australasia
 
17,389 
 
5,741 
 
23,130 
 
11,031 
Brazil
 
5,181 
 
614 
 
5,795 
 
2,366 
Total Regional Sales Offices
 
127,460 
 
17,777 
 
145,237 
 
62,473 
Central Services Organization
 
110 
 
303 
 
413 
 
(9,175) 
Total Segment Results
$ 
127,570 
$ 
18,080 
$ 
145,650 
$ 
53,298 
(1) Subscription revenue is recognized over time.
(2) Hardware and other revenue is recognized at a point in time.
As of March 31, 2021
Subscription
revenue (1)
Hardware
and other
revenue (2)
Total revenue
Segment Adjusted 
EBITDA
Regional Sales Offices
Africa
$ 
62,453 
$ 
5,495 
$ 
67,948 
$ 
31,781 
Europe
 
12,138 
 
2,441 
 
14,579 
 
6,260 
Americas
 
18,211 
 
770 
 
18,981 
 
7,077 
Middle East and Australasia
 
16,558 
 
4,679 
 
21,237 
 
9,751 
Brazil
 
3,922 
 
142 
 
4,064 
 
1,495 
Total Regional Sales Offices
 
113,282 
 
13,527 
 
126,809 
 
56,364 
Central Services Organization
 
69 
 
16 
 
85 
 
(7,553) 
Total Segment Results
$ 
113,351 
$ 
13,543 
$ 
126,894 
$ 
48,811 
(1) Subscription revenue is recognized over time.
(2) Hardware and other revenue is recognized at a point in time.
123

As of March 31, 2022
Subscription
revenue (1)
Hardware
and other
revenue (2)
Total revenue
Segment Adjusted 
EBITDA
Regional Sales Offices
Africa
$ 
74,778 
$ 
8,398 
$ 
83,176 
$ 
36,467 
Europe
 
13,509 
 
3,745 
 
17,254 
 
6,337 
Americas
 
14,036 
 
1,538 
 
15,574 
 
842 
Middle East and Australasia
 
16,950 
 
5,604 
 
22,554 
 
10,034 
Brazil
 
4,253 
 
401 
 
4,654 
 
1,260 
Total Regional Sales Offices
 
123,526 
 
19,686 
 
143,212 
 
54,940 
Central Services Organization
 
47 
 
35 
 
82 
 
(10,168) 
Total Segment Results
$ 
123,573 
$ 
19,721 
$ 
143,294 
$ 
44,772 
(1) Subscription revenue is recognized over time.
(2) Hardware and other revenue is recognized at a point in time.
The revenue from external parties reported to the Company’s CODM is recognized and measured in a manner consistent with 
that in the consolidated statements of income. Revenue generated by the South African-based operating segments of the 
Company (i.e. Central Services Organization and Africa, excluding East Africa) to its local and foreign-based customers for 
fiscal years 2020, 2021 and 2022, amounted to $76.0 million, $67.1 million and $82.3 million, respectively. Revenue generated 
by the foreign-based segments (i.e. Europe, Americas, East Africa, Middle East, Brazil and Australasia) to its local and foreign-
based customers for fiscal years 2020, 2021 and 2022, amounted to $69.7 million, $59.8 million and $61.0 million.
A reconciliation of the segment results to income before income tax expense for the year is disclosed below (in thousands).
As of March 31,
2020
2021
2022
Segment Adjusted EBITDA
$ 
53,298 
$ 
48,811 
$ 
44,772 
Corporate and consolidation entries
 
(8,366) 
 
(8,879) 
 
(10,243) 
Loss contingency (1)
 
(233) 
 
— 
 
— 
Operating lease costs (2)
 
(1,610) 
 
(1,652) 
 
(1,611) 
Product development costs (3)
 
(1,363) 
 
(1,112) 
 
(1,353) 
Depreciation and amortization
 
(19,972) 
 
(16,559) 
 
(14,951) 
Impairment of long-lived assets
 
(6) 
 
(8) 
 
(47) 
Stock-based compensation costs
 
(660) 
 
(1,273) 
 
(1,325) 
Restructuring costs (4)
 
1 
 
(1,055) 
 
(164) 
Net profit/(loss) on sale of property, plant and 
equipment
 
270 
 
(13) 
 
36 
Net foreign exchange losses
 
(610) 
 
(959) 
 
(648) 
Net interest income/(expense)
 
67 
 
(72) 
 
(510) 
Legal costs associated with patent 
infringement
 
— 
 
— 
 
(591) 
Income before income tax expense
$ 
20,816 
$ 
17,229 
$ 
13,365 
(1) For segment reporting purposes, a loss contingency (51% probability), had been raised prior to fiscal year 2019. As of March 
31, 2020, the loss contingency was no longer needed because an outflow was considered remote. In order to reconcile Segment 
Adjusted EBITDA to income before income tax expense, the increases/decreases to the loss contingency, recognized for 
segment reporting purposes, needed to be added/deducted.
124

(2) For the purposes of calculating Segment Adjusted EBITDA, operating leases have been capitalized, except for leases with a 
term of no more than 12 months or leases of low value assets. Where operating leases are capitalized for segment reporting 
purposes, the amortization of the right-of-use asset and the interest on the operating lease liability are excluded from the 
Segment Adjusted EBITDA. Therefore, in order to reconcile Segment Adjusted EBITDA to income before income tax expense, 
the total lease expense in respect of operating leases needs to be deducted.
(3) For segment reporting purposes, product development costs, which do not meet the capitalization requirements under ASC 
730 Research and Development or under ASC 985 Software, are capitalized and amortized. The amortization is excluded from 
Segment Adjusted EBITDA. In order to reconcile Segment Adjusted EBITDA to income before income tax expense, product 
development costs capitalized for segment reporting purposes need to be deducted.
(4) During fiscal year 2021, the Company incurred $1.1 million of restructuring costs which comprise of employee termination 
benefits, as a result of measures to minimize the adverse economic and business effect of the COVID-19 pandemic and to re-
align resources with the Company’s current business outlook and cost structure. $0.7 million, $0.2 million, $0.1 million and 
$0.1 million of the restructuring costs related to the CSO, Africa, North America and Middle East and Australasia reporting 
segments, respectively. As of March 31, 2022, all of the restructuring costs had been paid. Restructuring costs are included in 
Administration and other expenses in the consolidated statements of income.
Segment assets are not disclosed because such information is not reviewed by the CODM. The following table depicts the 
geographical location of the Company’s long-lived assets (in thousands) other than financial instruments, deferred commissions 
and deferred tax assets:
As of March 31,
2021
2022
South Africa
$ 
63,832 
$ 
75,621 
Europe
 
10,366 
 
10,161 
America
 
5,178 
 
5,192 
Middle East and Australia
 
5,474 
 
5,099 
Brazil
 
854 
 
1,095 
Total
$ 
85,704 
$ 
97,168 
These assets are allocated based on the physical location of the asset.
No single customer accounted for 10% or more of the Company’s total revenue in fiscal years 2020, 2021 and 2022. No single 
customer accounted for 10% or more of the Company’s accounts receivable as of fiscal years ended 2021 and 2022.
15. Stock-based compensation plan
The Company has issued share incentives to directors and certain key employees within the Company under the MiX 
Telematics Long-Term Incentive Plan (“LTIP”), an equity-classified incentive plan.
The LTIP provides for three types of grants to be issued, namely performance shares, restricted share units (“RSUs”) and stock 
appreciation rights (“SARs”). 
As of March 31, 2022, there were 34,965,000 shares reserved for future issuance under the LTIP. 
The total stock-based compensation expense recognized during the years ended March 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, was $0.7 
million, $1.3 million and $1.3 million, respectively. Net deferred tax benefits recognized/(reversed) on total stock-based 
compensation expense in the Statement of Income for the years ended March 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, was $0.4 million, $0.1 
million and $(0.1) million, respectively. Tax benefits realized on awards exercised during the years ended March 31, 2020, 
2021 and 2022, was $0.2 million, $0.1 million and $0.6 million, respectively.
Stock appreciation rights granted under the LTIP
Under the LTIP, SARs may be issued to certain directors and key employees. The exercise price of the SARs granted is equal to 
the closing market value of ordinary shares on the day preceding the date of grant. The SARs granted vest in tranches of 25% 
125

per annum, commencing on the second anniversary of the grant date and expire 6 years after the grant date. Vesting is 
contingent upon employment within the Company and an annual total shareholder return in excess of 10% being achieved, 
taking into account any dividends paid during the vesting period. Management estimates forfeiture to be approximately 5%. 
Upon exercise, the Company will settle the value of the difference, between the closing market value of the ordinary shares on 
the day of settlement and the award price (if positive), by delivering shares. The Company has no legal or constructive 
obligation to settle the SARs in cash.
The following table summarizes the Company’s SARs for the year ended March 31, 2022:
Number of
SARs
Weighted-
Average
Exercise Price in 
U.S. Cents*
Weighted-
Average 
Remaining 
Contractual 
Term (years)
Aggregate 
Intrinsic Value* 
(in thousands)
Outstanding as of April 1, 2021
 
40,567,917 
38
Granted on December 9, 2021
11,625,000
51
Granted on March 24, 2022
 
500,000 
50
Exercised
 
(9,692,917) 
22
Forfeited
 
(2,028,125) 
46
Outstanding as of March 31, 2022
 
40,971,875  
45 
3.73
Vested and expected to vest as of March 31, 
2022
 
39,407,969  
45 
3.71
$ 
2,569 
Vested as of March 31, 2022
 
9,693,750  
35 
1.70
$ 
1,583 
* The exercise price is denominated in South African cents. U.S. currency amounts are based on a ZAR:USD exchange rate of 
14.4916 as of March 31, 2022.
The weighted-average grant-date fair value of SARs granted during the years ended March 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, was 22 
U.S. cents, 16 U.S. cents and 22 U.S. cents, respectively. The grant-date fair value was determined using a combination of the 
Monte Carlo Simulation option pricing model and the Binomial Tree option pricing model. U.S. currency amounts are based on 
a ZAR:USD exchange rate of 14.4916 as of March 31, 2022. The key drivers and assumptions input into the valuation models 
used to determine these values are disclosed below. The volatility was calculated using a mixture of the Company’s historical 
data as well as the share data of comparable companies for grants made in all financial years preceding 2022 and the 
Company’s historical share data for grants made in the 2022 fiscal year and the current year.
The total intrinsic value of SARs exercised during fiscal years 2020, 2021 and 2022 was $1.25 million, $0.57 million, and $3.01 
million, respectively. U.S. Dollar amounts are based on a ZAR:USD exchange rate of 14.4916 as of March 31, 2022.
The following table summarizes the Company’s unvested SARs for the year ended March 31, 2022:
Number of SARs
Weighted- Average 
Grant-Date Fair 
Value in U.S. 
Cents*
Unvested as of April 1, 2021
 
28,512,500 
17
Granted on December 9, 2021
11,625,000
22
Granted on March 24, 2022
 
500,000 
22
Vested
 
(7,331,250) 
13
Forfeited
 
(2,028,125) 
18
Unvested as of March 31, 2022
 
31,278,125 
20
* The exercise price used to determine the grant date fair value is denominated in South African cents. U.S. currency amounts 
are based on a ZAR:USD exchange rate of 14.4916 as of March 31, 2022.
126

As of March 31, 2022, there was $2.81 million of unrecognized compensation cost related to unvested SARs. This amount is 
expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 4.07 years.
Restricted share units granted under the LTIP
Under the LTIP, RSUs may be issued to certain directors and key employees. The scheme rules allow for a maximum of 
2 million RSUs to be granted in any financial year and for a maximum of 12 million RSUs to be granted in aggregate over the 
life of the plan.
2 million time-based RSUs were granted on June 1, 2020, and will vest in tranches of 50% per annum, commencing on the 
second anniversary of the grant date. Vesting is conditional upon the continued employment of the recipient with the Company. 
Management estimates forfeiture to be approximately 5%. Settlement will take place in the Company’s shares. The Company 
has no legal or constructive obligation to settle the RSUs in cash. The weighted average grant date fair value per RSU granted 
was 35 U.S. cents. U.S. currency amounts are based on a ZAR:USD exchange rate of 14.4916 as of March 31, 2022. The grant 
date fair value was determined by deducting the present value of expected dividends to be paid per share prior to vesting from 
the closing market price of the Company’s shares on the grant date. The unrecognized compensation cost related to unvested 
RSUs as of March 31, 2022 was $0.2 million, which will be recognized over a weighted average period of 1 year, which is also 
the weighted average remaining contractual period.
16. Debt
As of March 31, 2021 and 2022, debt comprises bank overdrafts of $1.7 million and $5.6 million, respectively. Details of 
undrawn facilities are shown below:
As of March 31,
Interest rate
2021
2022
Undrawn borrowing facilities at floating rates 
include:
– Standard Bank Limited:
Overdraft
SA prime* less 1.2%
$ 
2,616 
$ 
— 
Vehicle and asset finance
SA prime* less 1.2%
 
570 
587
Working capital facility
SA prime* less 
0.25%
 
1,676 
 
544 
– Nedbank Limited overdraft
SA prime* less 2%
 
670 
690
$ 
5,532 
$ 
1,821 
*South African prime interest rate
As of March 31, 2021 and 2022, the South African prime interest rate was 7.00% and 7.75%, respectively. The Standard Bank 
and Nedbank facilities have no fixed renewal date and are repayable on demand. The facility from Nedbank Limited is 
unsecured. The Standard Bank overdraft facility was fully utilized as at March 31, 2022. 
17. Commitments and contingencies
Capital commitments
As of March 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, the Company had approved, and contracted, capital commitments for property, plant and 
equipment of $1.8 million, $1.2 million and $14.8 million, respectively; and for intangible assets of $0.9 million, $1.3 million 
and $1.6 million, respectively. 
Capital commitments will be funded out of a mixture of working capital and cash and cash equivalents.
Contingencies
Service agreement
In terms of an amended network services agreement with Mobile Telephone Networks Proprietary Limited (“MTN”), MTN is 
entitled to claw back payments from MiX Telematics Africa Proprietary Limited, a subsidiary of the Company, in the event of 
127

early cancellation of the agreement or certain base connections not being maintained over the term of the agreement. No 
connection incentives will be received in terms of the amended network services agreement. The maximum potential liability 
under the arrangement as of March 31, 2021 and 2022 was $2.0 million and $1.7 million, respectively. No loss is considered 
probable under this arrangement.
Competition Commission of South Africa matter
On April 15, 2019, the Competition Commission of South Africa (the “Commission”) referred a matter to the Competition 
Tribunal of South Africa (“Tribunal”). The Commission contends that the Company and a number of its channel partners have 
engaged in market division. Should the Tribunal rule against MiX Telematics, the Company may be liable to an administrative 
penalty in terms of the Competition Act, No. 89 of 1998. The Company cooperated fully with the Commission during its 
preliminary investigation.
The Commission’s lawyer recently approached the Tribunal to secure a pre-hearing date. The pre-hearing will be used to set a 
timetable for the further process towards a hearing in due course. The parties expect the pre-hearing (once held) to result in 
dates for a hearing being established (along with a timeline for the production of documents such as the Commission’s 
investigative record, discovery, exchange of factual witness statements etc). The Tribunal has not yet reverted on the pre-
hearing date.
We cannot predict the timing of a resolution or the ultimate outcome of the matter. However, the Company and its external 
legal advisers continue to believe that we have consistently adhered to all applicable laws and regulations and that the referral 
from the Commission is without merit. We have therefore currently not made any provisions for this matter.
The Ugandan Income Tax matter 
A claim has been raised by the Uganda Revenue Authority (“URA”) for Income Tax against MiX Telematics East Africa 
Limited based in Uganda. The initial assessment was received on July 20, 2020. We formally objected to the initial assessment 
raised by the URA. The objection letter is clear in its presentation of financial information and the application of tax legislation 
and concludes that no further assessment is justified. On December 15, 2020 the URA rejected our objection and proceeded to 
raise an additional assessment. 
We are currently investigating the basis for this additional tax. We have engaged an in-country legal counsel and tax advisors 
with the objective of having these additional assessments reversed. The potential liability as of March 31, 2022 was 
$1.0 million. No loss is considered probable, we have therefore currently not made any provisions for this matter.
18. Retirement benefits
It is the policy of the Company to provide retirement benefits to all its South African, United Kingdom, United States, 
Brazilian, Romanian and Australian employees. All these retirement benefits are defined contribution plans and are held in 
separate trustee-administered funds. These plans are funded by members as well as company contributions. The South African 
plan is subject to the Pension Funds Act of 1956, the UK plan is subject to the United Kingdom Pensions Act 2008 and the 
Australian plan is subject to the Superannuation Guarantee Administration Act of 1992. In Brazil, the Company contributes to a 
mandatory state social contribution plan known as Regime Geral de Previdência Social. In Romania there is a mandatory social 
security contribution paid to the state budget, as defined by the Pension Law (Law 263/2010) and the Fiscal Code (Law 
227/2015). For the United States employees, a voluntary Internal Revenue Service section 401(k) tax-deferred as well as a Roth 
IRA post-tax defined contribution schemes are offered. The full extent of the Company’s liability, in respect of the retirement 
benefits offered, is the contributions made, which are charged to the consolidated statements of income as they are incurred. 
The total Company contribution to such schemes for the years ended March 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 were $2.2 million, 
$1.9 million and $2.1 million, respectively. 
19. Related party transactions
Prior to July 2019 the Company leased premises from TPF Investments Proprietary Limited (“TPF”), a company over which 
Robin Frew (non-executive Chairperson of the Company) exercised significant influence. A lease expense of $0.2 million was 
recognized during the year ended March 31, 2020. During fiscal year 2020 the Company acquired the property from TPF and 
sold it immediately to Black Industrialists Group Property Management Company (Pty) Ltd (“BIG”), a non-related party, as 
part of a Broad-Based Black Economic Empowerment transaction. The Company now leases the property from BIG.
128

20. Subsequent events
Other than the items below, the directors are not aware of any matter material or otherwise arising since March 31, 2022 and up 
to the date of this report, not otherwise dealt with herein.
Dividend declared
The Board of Directors declared in respect of the fourth quarter of fiscal year 2022 which ended on March 31, 2022, a dividend 
of 4 South African cents per ordinary share and 1 South African Rand per ADS that will be paid on June 30, 2022.
21. Exchange rates
The Company is subject to fluctuations in exchange rates between the ZAR and foreign currencies, primarily the U.S. Dollar 
and the British Pound Sterling. The following major rates of exchange were used in the preparation of the consolidated financial 
statements:
As of March 31,
2020
2021
2022
USD:ZAR
– closing
 
17.92 
 
14.92 
 
14.49 
– average
 
14.78 
 
16.37 
 
14.86 
USD:GBP
– closing
 
0.81 
 
0.73 
 
0.76 
– average
 
0.79 
 
0.77 
 
0.73 
129

Schedule II - Valuation and Qualifying Accounts
(Amounts in thousands)
Description
Balance at 
beginning of 
the year
Net 
additions / 
(decreases) - 
charged to 
costs and 
expenses
Net 
additions / 
(decreases) - 
charged to 
other 
accounts 1
Deductions
Balance at 
end of the 
year
Year ended March 31, 2020
Allowance for doubtful accounts 
$ 
2,719 
$ 
3,941 
$ 
(403) 4 $ 
(2,655) 2 $ 
3,602 
Deferred taxation valuation 
allowance
 
1,010 
 
64 
 
(131)  
(195) 
3
 
748 
Year ended March 31, 2021
Allowance for doubtful accounts
 
3,602 
 
2,961 
 
670 
 
(1,656) 2  
5,577 
Deferred taxation valuation 
allowance
 
748 
 
19 
 
(4)  
(252) 
3
 
511 
Year ended March 31, 2022
Allowance for doubtful accounts
 
5,577 
 
2,559 
 
145 
 
(2,855) 2  
5,426 
Deferred taxation valuation 
allowance
$ 
511 
$ 
349 
$ 
(266) $ 
53 
3
$ 
647 
1    Foreign currency translation adjustments. 
2   Amounts relate to write-offs of uncollectible accounts, net of recoveries.
3   Amounts relate to utilization of previously unrecognized tax losses.
4    Net amount comprises the effect of adopting ASU 2016-13 as of April 1, 2019, an increase of $0.3 million in the allowance, 
as well as a foreign currency translation gain of  $0.7 million.
130

Notes
MiX Telematics Limited | Annual Report on Form 10-K 2022

MiX Telematics Limited
Incorporated in the Republic of South Africa
Registration number: 1995/013858/06
JSE share code: MiX 
NYSE code: MiXT
ISIN code: ZAE000125316
JSE Sponsor
Java Capital
6th Floor, 1 Park Lane, Wierda Valley
Sandton, 2196
South Africa 
Transfer Secretaries
Computershare Investor Services  
Proprietary Limited
Rosebank Towers
15 Biermann Avenue 
Rosebank, 2196
South Africa
Investor relations
ICR Inc.
685 Third Avenue
2nd Floor
New York
NY, 10017
ir@mixtelematics.com
Company Secretary
Statucor Proprietary Limited
Summit Place Office Park
221 Garsfontein Road, Menlyn
Pretoria, 0181
South Africa
United States ADR Depository
BNY Mellon Depositary Receipts
PO Box 43006
Providence, RI 02940-3006 
www.bnymellon.com/dr
Auditors
Deloitte & Touche
5 Magwa Crescent
Waterfall City
Johannesburg
Gauteng, 2090
South Africa
Administration  
as at March 31, 2022
MiX Telematics Limited | Annual Report on Form 10-K 2022

www.mixtelematics.com
750 Park of Commerce Blvd, Ste 100,
Boca Raton, FL, 33487
United States of America
Howick Close, Waterfall 
Park, Bekker Road, Midrand
South Africa, 1686